summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/docs/htmldocs/manpages
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorbubulle <bubulle@alioth.debian.org>2008-05-28 03:56:49 +0000
committerbubulle <bubulle@alioth.debian.org>2008-05-28 03:56:49 +0000
commit0381e1741f55a5691275f8df62da9fcc8818db3d (patch)
tree3424758d8df73604eca5d787a6cb50964da7f665 /docs/htmldocs/manpages
parentbba625b04e0d12c2c03a345554d98b8575f4f380 (diff)
downloadsamba-0381e1741f55a5691275f8df62da9fcc8818db3d.tar.gz
Load samba-3.2.0rc1 into branches/samba/upstream-3.2.upstream/3.2.0_rc1
git-svn-id: svn://svn.debian.org/svn/pkg-samba/branches/samba/upstream-3.2@1898 fc4039ab-9d04-0410-8cac-899223bdd6b0
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/htmldocs/manpages')
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/eventlogadm.8.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/findsmb.1.html30
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ad.8.html8
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.html10
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_nss.8.html6
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_rid.8.html8
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.html10
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/index.html138
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldb.3.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbadd.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbdel.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbedit.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbmodify.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbsearch.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/libsmbclient.7.html16
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/lmhosts.5.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/log2pcap.1.html10
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/mount.cifs.8.html94
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/net.8.html192
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmbd.8.html44
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmblookup.1.html24
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.html52
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/pam_winbind.7.html6
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/pdbedit.8.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/profiles.1.html10
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/rpcclient.1.html26
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/samba.7.html90
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smb.conf.5.html2918
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcacls.1.html21
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbclient.1.html38
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcontrol.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcquotas.1.html10
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbd.8.html42
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbget.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbgetrc.5.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmnt.8.html24
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmount.8.html110
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.5.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.8.html28
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbsh.1.html24
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbspool.8.html8
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbstatus.1.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtar.1.html22
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtree.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbumount.8.html17
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/swat.8.html26
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbbackup.8.html8
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbdump.8.html4
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbtool.8.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/testparm.1.html26
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/umount.cifs.8.html18
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_audit.8.html22
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.html18
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cap.8.html16
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_catia.8.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_commit.8.html20
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.html18
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.html16
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.html34
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.html22
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.html20
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.html14
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.html22
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.html18
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.html18
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfstest.1.html12
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/wbinfo.1.html43
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/manpages/winbindd.8.html62
72 files changed, 2901 insertions, 1856 deletions
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/eventlogadm.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/eventlogadm.8.html
index f9c6cf859b..2a0ff30ab8 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/eventlogadm.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/eventlogadm.8.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>eventlogadm</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="eventlogadm.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>eventlogadm &#8212; push records into the Samba event log store</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> [<code class="option">-d</code>] [<code class="option">-h</code>] <code class="option">-o</code>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>eventlogadm</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="eventlogadm.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>eventlogadm &#8212; push records into the Samba event log store</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> [<code class="option">-d</code>] [<code class="option">-h</code>] <code class="option">-o</code>
<code class="literal">addsource</code>
<em class="replaceable"><code>EVENTLOG</code></em>
<em class="replaceable"><code>SOURCENAME</code></em>
@@ -6,10 +6,10 @@
</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> [<code class="option">-d</code>] [<code class="option">-h</code>] <code class="option">-o</code>
<code class="literal">write</code>
<em class="replaceable"><code>EVENTLOG</code></em>
- </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299251"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> is a filter that accepts
+ </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507236"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> is a filter that accepts
formatted event log records on standard input and writes them
to the Samba event log store. Windows client can then manipulate
- these record using the usual administration tools.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266714"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">-d</code></span></dt><dd><p>
+ these record using the usual administration tools.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507266"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">-d</code></span></dt><dd><p>
The <code class="literal">-d</code> option causes <code class="literal">eventlogadm</code> to emit debugging
information.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">
@@ -31,7 +31,7 @@
event log store named by EVENTLOG.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">-h</code></span></dt><dd><p>
Print usage information.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266828"></a><h2>EVENTLOG RECORD FORMAT</h2><p>For the write operation, <code class="literal">eventlogadm</code>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507382"></a><h2>EVENTLOG RECORD FORMAT</h2><p>For the write operation, <code class="literal">eventlogadm</code>
expects to be able to read structured records from standard
input. These records are a sequence of lines, with the record key
and data separated by a colon character. Records are separated
@@ -80,7 +80,7 @@
eventlog. There may be more than one string in a record.
</p></li><li><p>
<code class="literal">DAT</code> - This field should be left unset.
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307897"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>An example of the record format accepted by <code class="literal">eventlogadm</code>:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506299"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>An example of the record format accepted by <code class="literal">eventlogadm</code>:</p><pre class="programlisting">
LEN: 0
RS1: 1699505740
RCN: 0
@@ -103,7 +103,7 @@
tail -f /var/log/messages | \\
my_program_to_parse_into_eventlog_records | \\
eventlogadm SystemLogEvents
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307938"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307948"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> The original Samba software and related utilities were
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506349"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506360"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> The original Samba software and related utilities were
created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the
Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/findsmb.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/findsmb.1.html
index 84c97977b8..6f5b459d28 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/findsmb.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/findsmb.1.html
@@ -1,22 +1,22 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>findsmb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="findsmb.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>findsmb &#8212; list info about machines that respond to SMB
- name queries on a subnet</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">findsmb</code> [subnet broadcast address]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267679"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This perl script is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>findsmb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="findsmb.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>findsmb &#8212; list info about machines that respond to SMB
+ name queries on a subnet</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">findsmb</code> [subnet broadcast address]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544128"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This perl script is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>
suite.</p><p><code class="literal">findsmb</code> is a perl script that
prints out several pieces of information about machines
on a subnet that respond to SMB name query requests.
- It uses <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
- and <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>
+ It uses <a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ and <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>
to obtain this information.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299210"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Controls whether <code class="literal">findsmb</code> takes
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507188"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Controls whether <code class="literal">findsmb</code> takes
bugs in Windows95 into account when trying to find a Netbios name
registered of the remote machine. This option is disabled by default
because it is specific to Windows 95 and Windows 95 machines only.
- If set, <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ If set, <a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
will be called with <code class="constant">-B</code> option.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">subnet broadcast address</span></dt><dd><p>Without this option, <code class="literal">findsmb
</code> will probe the subnet of the machine where
- <a href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a>
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a>
is run. This value is passed to
- <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
- as part of the <code class="constant">-B</code> option.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266719"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>The output of <code class="literal">findsmb</code> lists the following
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ as part of the <code class="constant">-B</code> option.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507265"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>The output of <code class="literal">findsmb</code> lists the following
information for all machines that respond to the initial
<code class="literal">nmblookup</code> for any name: IP address, NetBIOS name,
Workgroup name, operating system, and SMB server version.</p><p>There will be a '+' in front of the workgroup name for
@@ -27,7 +27,7 @@
Windows 98 will
not show any information about the operating system or server
version.</p><p>The command with <code class="constant">-r</code> option
- must be run on a system without <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> running.
+ must be run on a system without <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> running.
If <code class="literal">nmbd</code> is running on the system, you will
only get the IP address and the DNS name of the machine. To
@@ -48,15 +48,15 @@ IP ADDR NETBIOS NAME WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION
192.168.35.88 SCNT2 +[MVENGR] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
192.168.35.93 FROGSTAR-PC [MVENGR] [Windows 5.0] [Windows 2000 LAN Manager]
192.168.35.97 HERBNT1 *[HERB-NT] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266812"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266822"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>,
- <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, and <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266878"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507367"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507378"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>,
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, and <a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507411"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>)
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>)
and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ad.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ad.8.html
index 14477cc5fc..c9a07d2bf7 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ad.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ad.8.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_ad</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_ad.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_ad &#8212; Samba's idmap_ad Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_ad plugin provides a way for Winbind to read
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_ad</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_ad.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_ad &#8212; Samba's idmap_ad Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_ad plugin provides a way for Winbind to read
id mappings from an AD server that uses RFC2307/SFU schema
extensions. This module implements only the "idmap"
API, and is READONLY. Mappings must be provided in advance
by the administrator by adding the posixAccount/posixGroup
classess and relative attribute/value pairs to the users and
- groups objects in AD</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267675"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
+ groups objects in AD</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544121"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
backend is authoritative. Note that the range acts as a filter.
If specified any UID or GID stored in AD that fall outside the
@@ -16,7 +16,7 @@
Active Directory regarding user and group information.
This can either the RFC2307 schema support included
in Windows 2003 R2 or the Service for Unix (SFU) schema.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299200"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507182"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
The following example shows how to retrieve idmappings from our principal and
and trusted AD domains. All is needed is to set default to yes. If trusted
domains are present id conflicts must be resolved beforehand, there is no
@@ -33,7 +33,7 @@
idmap alloc backend = tdb
idmap alloc config:range = 5000 - 9999
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299221"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507209"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.html
index 9510f2a7ac..726aa3510b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_ldap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_ldap.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_ldap &#8212; Samba's idmap_ldap Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_ldap plugin provides a means for Winbind to
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_ldap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_ldap.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_ldap &#8212; Samba's idmap_ldap Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_ldap plugin provides a means for Winbind to
store and retrieve SID/uid/gid mapping tables in an LDAP directory
service. The module implements both the "idmap" and
"idmap alloc" APIs.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">ldap_base_dn = DN</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">ldap_base_dn = DN</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the directory base suffix to use when searching for
SID/uid/gid mapping entries. If not defined, idmap_ldap will default
to using the "ldap idmap suffix" option from smb.conf.
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
store and retrieve SID/uid/gid mapping entries. If the parameter
is absent, Winbind fail over to use the "idmap uid" and
"idmap gid" options from smb.conf.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299222"></a><h2>IDMAP ALLOC OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">ldap_base_dn = DN</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507217"></a><h2>IDMAP ALLOC OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">ldap_base_dn = DN</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the directory base suffix under which new SID/uid/gid mapping
entries should be stored. If not defined, idmap_ldap will default
to using the "ldap idmap suffix" option from smb.conf.
@@ -36,7 +36,7 @@
winbindd can allocate for users and groups. If the parameter
is absent, Winbind fail over to use the "idmap uid"
and "idmap gid" options from smb.conf.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266718"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507284"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
The follow sets of a LDAP configuration which uses a slave server
running on localhost for fast fetching SID/gid/uid mappings, it
implies correct configuration of referrals.
@@ -61,7 +61,7 @@
in plain text in the configuration file we store it into a security
store. The "net idmap " command is used to store a secret
for the DN specified in a specific idmap domain.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266753"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507328"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_nss.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_nss.8.html
index b1aedf900b..7c82ab10f6 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_nss.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_nss.8.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_nss</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_nss.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_nss &#8212; Samba's idmap_nss Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_nss plugin provides a means to map Unix users and groups
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_nss</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_nss.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_nss &#8212; Samba's idmap_nss Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_nss plugin provides a means to map Unix users and groups
to Windows accounts and obseletes the "winbind trusted domains only"
smb.conf option. This provides a simple means of ensuring that the SID
for a Unix user named jsmith is reported as the one assigned to
DOMAIN\jsmith which is necessary for reporting ACLs on files and printers
stored on a Samba member server.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267675"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544121"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
This example shows how to use idmap_nss to check the local accounts for its
own domain while using allocation to create new mappings for trusted domains
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
idmap alloc backend = tdb
idmap alloc config:range = 10000 - 50000
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267694"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544146"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_rid.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_rid.8.html
index dbab83a449..6a1edcd9a2 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_rid.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_rid.8.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_rid</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_rid.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_rid &#8212; Samba's idmap_rid Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_rid backend provides a way to use an algorithmic
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_rid</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_rid.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_rid &#8212; Samba's idmap_rid Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_rid backend provides a way to use an algorithmic
mapping scheme to map UIDs/GIDs and SIDs. No database is required
- in this case as the mapping is deterministic.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
+ in this case as the mapping is deterministic.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544118"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
backend is authoritative. Note that the range acts as a filter.
If algorithmically determined UID or GID fall outside the
@@ -13,7 +13,7 @@
by default start at 1000 (512 hexadecimal), this means a good value
for base_rid can be 1000 as the resulting ID is calculated this way:
ID = RID - BASE_RID + LOW RANGE ID.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299199"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>This example shows how to configure 2 domains with idmap_rid</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544161"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>This example shows how to configure 2 domains with idmap_rid</p><pre class="programlisting">
[global]
idmap domains = MAIN TRUSTED1
@@ -24,7 +24,7 @@
idmap config TRUSTED1:backend = rid
idmap config TRUSTED1:base_rid = 1000
idmap config TRUSTED1:range = 50000 - 99999
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299217"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507201"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.html
index 6ab21584f9..4e450e08e6 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.html
@@ -1,19 +1,19 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_tdb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_tdb.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_tdb &#8212; Samba's idmap_tdb Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_tdb plugin is the default backend used by winbindd
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>idmap_tdb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="idmap_tdb.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>idmap_tdb &#8212; Samba's idmap_tdb Backend for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The idmap_tdb plugin is the default backend used by winbindd
for storing SID/uid/gid mapping tables and implements
both the "idmap" and "idmap alloc" APIs.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544118"></a><h2>IDMAP OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
backend is authoritative. Note that the range commonly matches
the allocation range due to the fact that the same backend will
store and retrieve SID/uid/gid mapping entries. If the parameter
is absent, Winbind fail over to use the "idmap uid" and
"idmap gid" options from smb.conf.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267696"></a><h2>IDMAP ALLOC OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544144"></a><h2>IDMAP ALLOC OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">range = low - high</span></dt><dd><p>
Defines the available matching uid and gid range from which
winbindd can allocate for users and groups. If the parameter
is absent, Winbind fail over to use the "idmap uid"
and "idmap gid" options from smb.conf.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299208"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507190"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>
The following example is equivalent to the pre-3.0.25 default idmap
configuration using the "idmap backend = tdb" setting.
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@
idmap alloc backend = tdb
idmap alloc config:range = 10000 - 50000
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299226"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507210"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/index.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/index.html
index ca031be3eb..c3f377ba36 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/index.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/index.html
@@ -1,84 +1,82 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title></title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="article" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><hr></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="eventlogadm.8.html" target="_top">eventlogadm(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>push records into the Samba event log store
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="findsmb.1.html" target="_top">findsmb(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>list info about machines that respond to SMB
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title></title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="article" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><hr></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="eventlogadm.8.html" target="_top">eventlogadm(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>push records into the Samba event log store
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="findsmb.1.html" target="_top">findsmb(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>list info about machines that respond to SMB
name queries on a subnet
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="idmap_ad.8.html" target="_top">idmap_ad(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_ad Backend for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="idmap_ldap.8.html" target="_top">idmap_ldap(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_ldap Backend for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="idmap_nss.8.html" target="_top">idmap_nss(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_nss Backend for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="idmap_rid.8.html" target="_top">idmap_rid(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_rid Backend for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="idmap_tdb.8.html" target="_top">idmap_tdb(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_tdb Backend for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldb.3.html" target="_top">ldb(3)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A light-weight database library
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldbadd.1.html" target="_top">ldbadd(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Command-line utility for adding records to an LDB
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldbdel.1.html" target="_top">ldbdel(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Command-line program for deleting LDB records
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldbedit.1.html" target="_top">ldbedit(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Edit LDB databases using your preferred editor
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldbmodify.1.html" target="_top">ldbmodify(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Modify records in a LDB database
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ldbsearch.1.html" target="_top">ldbsearch(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Search for records in a LDB database
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="libsmbclient.7.html" target="_top">libsmbclient(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>An extension library for browsers and that can be used as a generic browsing API.
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="lmhosts.5.html" target="_top">lmhosts(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The Samba NetBIOS hosts file
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="log2pcap.1.html" target="_top">log2pcap(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Extract network traces from Samba log files
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="mount.cifs.8.html" target="_top">mount.cifs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>mount using the Common Internet File System (CIFS)
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="net.8.html" target="_top">net(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Tool for administration of Samba and remote
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="idmap_ad.8.html" target="_top">idmap_ad(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_ad Backend for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="idmap_ldap.8.html" target="_top">idmap_ldap(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_ldap Backend for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="idmap_nss.8.html" target="_top">idmap_nss(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_nss Backend for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="idmap_rid.8.html" target="_top">idmap_rid(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_rid Backend for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="idmap_tdb.8.html" target="_top">idmap_tdb(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba's idmap_tdb Backend for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldb.3.html" target="_top">ldb(3)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A light-weight database library
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldbadd.1.html" target="_top">ldbadd(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Command-line utility for adding records to an LDB
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldbdel.1.html" target="_top">ldbdel(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Command-line program for deleting LDB records
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldbedit.1.html" target="_top">ldbedit(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Edit LDB databases using your preferred editor
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldbmodify.1.html" target="_top">ldbmodify(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Modify records in a LDB database
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ldbsearch.1.html" target="_top">ldbsearch(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Search for records in a LDB database
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="libsmbclient.7.html" target="_top">libsmbclient(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>An extension library for browsers and that can be used as a generic browsing API.
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="lmhosts.5.html" target="_top">lmhosts(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The Samba NetBIOS hosts file
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="log2pcap.1.html" target="_top">log2pcap(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Extract network traces from Samba log files
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="mount.cifs.8.html" target="_top">mount.cifs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>mount using the Common Internet File System (CIFS)
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="net.8.html" target="_top">net(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Tool for administration of Samba and remote
CIFS servers.
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmbd.8.html" target="_top">nmbd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="nmbd.8.html" target="_top">nmbd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
over IP naming services to clients
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmblookup.1.html" target="_top">nmblookup(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="nmblookup.1.html" target="_top">nmblookup(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
names
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ntlm_auth.1.html" target="_top">ntlm_auth(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool to allow external access to Winbind's NTLM authentication function
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="pam_winbind.7.html" target="_top">pam_winbind(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>PAM module for Winbind
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="pdbedit.8.html" target="_top">pdbedit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>manage the SAM database (Database of Samba Users)
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="profiles.1.html" target="_top">profiles(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A utility to report and change SIDs in registry files
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="ntlm_auth.1.html" target="_top">ntlm_auth(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool to allow external access to Winbind's NTLM authentication function
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="pam_winbind.7.html" target="_top">pam_winbind(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>PAM module for Winbind
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="pdbedit.8.html" target="_top">pdbedit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>manage the SAM database (Database of Samba Users)
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="profiles.1.html" target="_top">profiles(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A utility to report and change SIDs in registry files
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="rpcclient.1.html" target="_top">rpcclient(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for executing client side
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="rpcclient.1.html" target="_top">rpcclient(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for executing client side
MS-RPC functions
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="samba.7.html" target="_top">samba(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The configuration file for the Samba suite
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcacls.1.html" target="_top">smbcacls(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbclient.1.html" target="_top">smbclient(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="samba.7.html" target="_top">samba(7)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbcacls.1.html" target="_top">smbcacls(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbclient.1.html" target="_top">smbclient(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
on servers
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcontrol.1.html" target="_top">smbcontrol(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcquotas.1.html" target="_top">smbcquotas(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Set or get QUOTAs of NTFS 5 shares
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbd.8.html" target="_top">smbd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbget.1.html" target="_top">smbget(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>wget-like utility for download files over SMB
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbgetrc.5.html" target="_top">smbgetrc(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>configuration file for smbget
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbmnt.8.html" target="_top">smbmnt(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>helper utility for mounting SMB filesystems
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbmount.8.html" target="_top">smbmount(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>mount an smbfs filesystem
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbpasswd.5.html" target="_top">smbpasswd(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The Samba encrypted password file
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbpasswd.8.html" target="_top">smbpasswd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>change a user's SMB password
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbsh.1.html" target="_top">smbsh(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Allows access to remote SMB shares
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The configuration file for the Samba suite
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbcontrol.1.html" target="_top">smbcontrol(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbcquotas.1.html" target="_top">smbcquotas(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Set or get QUOTAs of NTFS 5 shares
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbd.8.html" target="_top">smbd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbget.1.html" target="_top">smbget(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>wget-like utility for download files over SMB
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbgetrc.5.html" target="_top">smbgetrc(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>configuration file for smbget
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbpasswd.5.html" target="_top">smbpasswd(5)</a></span></dt><dd><p>The Samba encrypted password file
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbpasswd.8.html" target="_top">smbpasswd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>change a user's SMB password
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbsh.1.html" target="_top">smbsh(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Allows access to remote SMB shares
using UNIX commands
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbspool.8.html" target="_top">smbspool(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>send a print file to an SMB printer
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbstatus.1.html" target="_top">smbstatus(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>report on current Samba connections
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtar.1.html" target="_top">smbtar(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbspool.8.html" target="_top">smbspool(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>send a print file to an SMB printer
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbstatus.1.html" target="_top">smbstatus(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>report on current Samba connections
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbtar.1.html" target="_top">smbtar(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
directly to UNIX tape drives
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtree.1.html" target="_top">smbtree(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A text based smb network browser
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="smbtree.1.html" target="_top">smbtree(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>A text based smb network browser
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbumount.8.html" target="_top">smbumount(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>smbfs umount for normal users
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="swat.8.html" target="_top">swat(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba Web Administration Tool
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="tdbbackup.8.html" target="_top">tdbbackup(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for backing up and for validating the integrity of samba .tdb files
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="tdbdump.8.html" target="_top">tdbdump(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for printing the contents of a TDB file
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="tdbtool.8.html" target="_top">tdbtool(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>manipulate the contents TDB files
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="testparm.1.html" target="_top">testparm(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>check an smb.conf configuration file for
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="swat.8.html" target="_top">swat(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba Web Administration Tool
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="tdbbackup.8.html" target="_top">tdbbackup(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for backing up and for validating the integrity of samba .tdb files
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="tdbdump.8.html" target="_top">tdbdump(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for printing the contents of a TDB file
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="tdbtool.8.html" target="_top">tdbtool(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>manipulate the contents TDB files
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="testparm.1.html" target="_top">testparm(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>check an smb.conf configuration file for
internal correctness
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="umount.cifs.8.html" target="_top">umount.cifs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>for normal, non-root users, to unmount their own Common Internet File System (CIFS) mounts
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record selected Samba VFS operations in the system log
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_cacheprime.8.html" target="_top">vfs_cacheprime(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>prime the kernel file data cache
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_cap.8.html" target="_top">vfs_cap(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>CAP encode filenames
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_catia.8.html" target="_top">vfs_catia(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>translate illegal characters in Catia filenames
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_commit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_commit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>flush dirty data at specified intervals
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_default_quota.8.html" target="_top">vfs_default_quota(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>store default quota records for Windows clients
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_extd_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_extd_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record selected Samba VFS operations
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_fake_perms.8.html" target="_top">vfs_fake_perms(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>enable read only Roaming Profiles
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_full_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_full_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record Samba VFS operations in the system log
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_gpfs.8.html" target="_top">vfs_gpfs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>gpfs specific samba extensions like acls and prealloc
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_netatalk.8.html" target="_top">vfs_netatalk(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>hide .AppleDouble files from CIFS clients
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_notify_fam.8.html" target="_top">vfs_notify_fam(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>FAM support for file change notifications
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_prealloc.8.html" target="_top">vfs_prealloc(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>preallocate matching files to a predetermined size
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_readahead.8.html" target="_top">vfs_readahead(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>pre-load the kernel buffer cache
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_readonly.8.html" target="_top">vfs_readonly(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>make a Samba share read only for a specified time period
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_recycle.8.html" target="_top">vfs_recycle(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba VFS recycle bin
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfs_shadow_copy.8.html" target="_top">vfs_shadow_copy(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Make a Samba share read only for a specified time period
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfstest.1.html" target="_top">vfstest(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for testing samba VFS modules
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="wbinfo.1.html" target="_top">wbinfo(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Query information from winbind daemon
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="winbindd.8.html" target="_top">winbindd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="umount.cifs.8.html" target="_top">umount.cifs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>for normal, non-root users, to unmount their own Common Internet File System (CIFS) mounts
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record selected Samba VFS operations in the system log
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_cacheprime.8.html" target="_top">vfs_cacheprime(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>prime the kernel file data cache
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_cap.8.html" target="_top">vfs_cap(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>CAP encode filenames
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_catia.8.html" target="_top">vfs_catia(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>translate illegal characters in Catia filenames
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_commit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_commit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>flush dirty data at specified intervals
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_default_quota.8.html" target="_top">vfs_default_quota(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>store default quota records for Windows clients
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_extd_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_extd_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record selected Samba VFS operations
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_fake_perms.8.html" target="_top">vfs_fake_perms(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>enable read only Roaming Profiles
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_full_audit.8.html" target="_top">vfs_full_audit(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>record Samba VFS operations in the system log
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_gpfs.8.html" target="_top">vfs_gpfs(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>gpfs specific samba extensions like acls and prealloc
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_netatalk.8.html" target="_top">vfs_netatalk(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>hide .AppleDouble files from CIFS clients
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_notify_fam.8.html" target="_top">vfs_notify_fam(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>FAM support for file change notifications
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_prealloc.8.html" target="_top">vfs_prealloc(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>preallocate matching files to a predetermined size
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_readahead.8.html" target="_top">vfs_readahead(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>pre-load the kernel buffer cache
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_readonly.8.html" target="_top">vfs_readonly(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>make a Samba share read only for a specified time period
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_recycle.8.html" target="_top">vfs_recycle(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Samba VFS recycle bin
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_shadow_copy.8.html" target="_top">vfs_shadow_copy(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Make a Samba share read only for a specified time period
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfstest.1.html" target="_top">vfstest(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>tool for testing samba VFS modules
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="vfs_xattr_tdb.8.html" target="_top">vfs_xattr_tdb(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Save Extended Attributes (EAs) in a tdb file
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="wbinfo.1.html" target="_top">wbinfo(1)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Query information from winbind daemon
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="ulink" href="winbindd.8.html" target="_top">winbindd(8)</a></span></dt><dd><p>Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
from NT servers
</p></dd></dl></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldb.3.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldb.3.html
index dbf44dd31e..10d03bd40c 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldb.3.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldb.3.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldb.3"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldb<p><b>The Samba Project</b></p> &#8212; A light-weight database library</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><pre class="synopsis">#include &lt;ldb.h&gt;</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267383"></a><h2>description</h2><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldb.3"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldb<p><b>The Samba Project</b></p> &#8212; A light-weight database library</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><pre class="synopsis">#include &lt;ldb.h&gt;</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544115"></a><h2>description</h2><p>
ldb is a light weight embedded database library and API. With a
programming interface that is very similar to LDAP, ldb can store its
data either in a tdb(3) database or in a real LDAP database.
@@ -34,7 +34,7 @@ If you are new to ldb, then I suggest starting with the manual pages
for ldbsearch(1) and ldbedit(1), and experimenting with a local
database. Then I suggest you look at the ldb_connect(3) and
ldb_search(3) manual pages.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267706"></a><h2>TOOLS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507198"></a><h2>TOOLS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
<span class="application">ldbsearch(1)</span>
- command line ldb search utility
</p></li><li><p>
@@ -49,7 +49,7 @@ ldb_search(3) manual pages.
</p></li><li><p>
<span class="application">ldbmodify(1)</span>
- modify records in a ldb database using LDIF formatted input
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267087"></a><h2>FUNCTIONS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507263"></a><h2>FUNCTIONS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
<code class="function">ldb_connect(3)</code>
- connect to a ldb backend
</p></li><li><p>
@@ -124,12 +124,12 @@ ldb_search(3) manual pages.
</p></li><li><p>
<code class="function">ldb_set_debug_stderr(3)</code>
- set a debug handler for stderr output
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266894"></a><h2>Author</h2><p>
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506259"></a><h2>Author</h2><p>
ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
-the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>
ldb is released under the GNU Lesser General Public License version 2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbadd.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbadd.1.html
index d2b1b7f7be..d20be69636 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbadd.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbadd.1.html
@@ -1,16 +1,16 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbadd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbadd.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbadd &#8212; Command-line utility for adding records to an LDB</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbadd</code> [-h] [-H LDB-URL] [ldif-file1] [ldif-file2] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299200"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbadd adds records to an ldb(7) database. It reads
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbadd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbadd.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbadd &#8212; Command-line utility for adding records to an LDB</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbadd</code> [-h] [-H LDB-URL] [ldif-file1] [ldif-file2] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544156"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbadd adds records to an ldb(7) database. It reads
the ldif(5) files specified on the command line and adds
the records from these files to the LDB database, which is specified
by the -H option or the LDB_URL environment variable.
</p><p>If - is specified as a ldb file, the ldif input is read from
- standard input.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299215"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
+ standard input.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507195"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
Show list of available options.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299247"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
- -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299267"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266712"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbdel, ldif(5)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266722"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507228"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507249"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507260"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbdel, ldif(5)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507270"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
-the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbdel.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbdel.1.html
index 5d9b9165ea..c43a7fc44d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbdel.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbdel.1.html
@@ -1,15 +1,15 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbdel</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbdel.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbdel &#8212; Command-line program for deleting LDB records</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbdel</code> [-h] [-H LDB-URL] [dn] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267702"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbdel deletes records from an ldb(7) database.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbdel</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbdel.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbdel &#8212; Command-line program for deleting LDB records</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbdel</code> [-h] [-H LDB-URL] [dn] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544148"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbdel deletes records from an ldb(7) database.
It deletes the records identified by the dn's specified
on the command-line. </p><p>ldbdel uses either the database that is specified with
the -H option or the database specified by the LDB_URL environment
- variable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299208"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
+ variable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507185"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
Show list of available options.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299240"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
- -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299259"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299270"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbadd, ldif(5)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266716"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507218"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507240"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507251"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbadd, ldif(5)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507260"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
-the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>ldbdel was written by Andrew Tridgell.</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbedit.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbedit.1.html
index eda5125f48..00f62ec397 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbedit.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbedit.1.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbedit.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbedit &#8212; Edit LDB databases using your preferred editor</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbedit</code> [-?] [--usage] [-s base|one|sub] [-b basedn] [-a] [-e editor] [-H LDB-URL] [expression] [attributes...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299231"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbedit is a utility that allows you to edit LDB entries (in
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbedit.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbedit &#8212; Edit LDB databases using your preferred editor</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbedit</code> [-?] [--usage] [-s base|one|sub] [-b basedn] [-a] [-e editor] [-H LDB-URL] [expression] [attributes...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507207"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbedit is a utility that allows you to edit LDB entries (in
tdb files, sqlite files or LDAP servers) using your preferred editor.
ldbedit generates an LDIF file based on your query, allows you to edit
the LDIF, and then merges that LDIF back into the LDB backend.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299243"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-?, </span><span class="term">--help</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507222"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-?, </span><span class="term">--help</span></dt><dd><p>
Show list of available options, and a phrase describing what that option
does.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--usage</span></dt><dd><p>
@@ -34,19 +34,19 @@
operations that are being performed. Without
this option, ldbedit will only provide a
summary change line.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266826"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to. This can be
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507382"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to. This can be
overridden by using the -H command-line option.)
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VISUAL and EDITOR</span></dt><dd><p>
Environment variables used to determine what
editor to use. VISUAL takes precedence over
EDITOR, and both are overridden by the
-e command-line option.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266886"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266896"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify(1), ldbdel(1), ldif(5), vi(1)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266906"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507423"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507434"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbmodify(1), ldbdel(1), ldif(5), vi(1)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507445"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
- the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+ the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>
This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and updated
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbmodify.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbmodify.1.html
index 7f079f0942..a8d213de91 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbmodify.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbmodify.1.html
@@ -1,14 +1,14 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbmodify</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbmodify.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbmodify &#8212; Modify records in a LDB database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbmodify</code> [-H LDB-URL] [ldif-file]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267687"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbmodify</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbmodify.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbmodify &#8212; Modify records in a LDB database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbmodify</code> [-H LDB-URL] [ldif-file]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544134"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
ldbmodify changes, adds and deletes records in a LDB database.
The changes that should be made to the LDB database are read from
the specified LDIF-file. If - is specified as the filename, input is read from stdin.
- </p><p>For now, see ldapmodify(1) for details on the LDIF file format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267703"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><p>For now, see ldapmodify(1) for details on the LDIF file format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544152"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299214"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
- -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299234"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299245"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbedit</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299255"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507193"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507214"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507225"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbedit</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507235"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
-the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbsearch.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbsearch.1.html
index 3a4969b9a0..0ed2253a0d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbsearch.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ldbsearch.1.html
@@ -1,15 +1,15 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbsearch</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbsearch.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbsearch &#8212; Search for records in a LDB database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbsearch</code> [-h] [-s base|one|sub] [-b basedn] [-i] [-H LDB-URL] [expression] [attributes]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299218"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbsearch searches a LDB database for records matching the
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ldbsearch</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ldbsearch.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ldbsearch &#8212; Search for records in a LDB database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ldbsearch</code> [-h] [-s base|one|sub] [-b basedn] [-i] [-H LDB-URL] [expression] [attributes]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507192"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>ldbsearch searches a LDB database for records matching the
specified expression (see the ldapsearch(1) manpage for
a description of the expression format). For each
record, the specified attributes are printed.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299230"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507206"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
Show list of available options.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s one|sub|base</span></dt><dd><p>Search scope to use. One-level, subtree or base.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Read search expressions from stdin. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b basedn</span></dt><dd><p>Specify Base DN to use.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266729"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
- -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266749"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266760"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbedit(1)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266770"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
- <a href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s one|sub|base</span></dt><dd><p>Search scope to use. One-level, subtree or base.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Read search expressions from stdin. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b basedn</span></dt><dd><p>Specify Base DN to use.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507273"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LDB_URL</span></dt><dd><p>LDB URL to connect to (can be overrided by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507294"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507305"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>ldb(7), ldbedit(1)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507316"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> ldb was written by
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/~tridge/" target="_top">Andrew Tridgell</a>.
</p><p>
If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
-the <a href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
+the <a class="ulink" href="http://ldb.samba.org/" target="_top">http://ldb.samba.org/</a> web site for
current contact and maintainer information.
</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/libsmbclient.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/libsmbclient.7.html
index 703bdf7eb7..5c2f6cbb37 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/libsmbclient.7.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/libsmbclient.7.html
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>libsmbclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="libsmbclient.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>libsmbclient &#8212; An extension library for browsers and that can be used as a generic browsing API.</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">Browser URL:</code><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>libsmbclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="libsmbclient.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>libsmbclient &#8212; An extension library for browsers and that can be used as a generic browsing API.</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">Browser URL:</code><p>
smb://[[[domain:]user[:password@]]server[/share[/path[/file]]]] [?options]
- </p></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267676"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
- This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.
+ </p></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544131"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
+ This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.
</p><p>
<code class="literal">libsmbclient</code> is a library toolset that permits applications to manipulate CIFS/SMB network
resources using many of the standards POSIX functions available for manipulating local UNIX/Linux files. It
@@ -12,7 +12,7 @@
<code class="literal">libsmbclient</code> can not be used directly from the command line, instead it provides an
extension of the capabilities of tools such as file managers and browsers. This man page describes the
configuration options for this tool so that the user may obtain greatest utility of use.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299208"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507200"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
What the URLs mean:
</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">smb://</span></dt><dd><p>
Shows all workgroups or domains that are visible in the network. The behavior matches
@@ -44,11 +44,11 @@
<code class="literal">libsmbclient</code> will check the users shell environment for the <code class="literal">USER</code>
parameter and will use its value when if the <code class="literal">user</code> parameter was not included
in the URL.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266763"></a><h2>PROGRAMMERS GUIDE</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507341"></a><h2>PROGRAMMERS GUIDE</h2><p>
Watch this space for future updates.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266773"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>
- This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266784"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507352"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>
+ This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507363"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
the Linux kernel is developed.
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/lmhosts.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/lmhosts.5.html
index 8915e7d3d8..f428ef3026 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/lmhosts.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/lmhosts.5.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>lmhosts</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="lmhosts.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>lmhosts &#8212; The Samba NetBIOS hosts file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">lmhosts</code> is the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267678"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This file is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="filename">lmhosts</code> is the <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>lmhosts</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="lmhosts.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>lmhosts &#8212; The Samba NetBIOS hosts file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">lmhosts</code> is the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544123"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This file is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="filename">lmhosts</code> is the <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba
</em></span> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
is very similar to the <code class="filename">/etc/hosts</code> file
format, except that the hostname component must correspond
- to the NetBIOS naming format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299203"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.
+ to the NetBIOS naming format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544162"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.
The two fields on each line are separated from each other by
white space. Any entry beginning with '#' is ignored. Each line
in the lmhosts file contains the following information:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>IP Address - in dotted decimal format.</p></li><li><p>NetBIOS Name - This name format is a
@@ -25,16 +25,16 @@
the NetBIOS name requested.</p><p>The second mapping will be returned only when the "0x20" name
type for a name "NTSERVER" is queried. Any other name type will not
be resolved.</p><p>The default location of the <code class="filename">lmhosts</code> file
- is in the same directory as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299273"></a><h2>FILES</h2><p>lmhosts is loaded from the configuration directory. This is
+ is in the same directory as the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507259"></a><h2>FILES</h2><p>lmhosts is loaded from the configuration directory. This is
usually <code class="filename">/etc/samba</code> or <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib</code>.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266730"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266740"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, and <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266774"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507282"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507293"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, and <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507327"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
- <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/log2pcap.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/log2pcap.1.html
index 59de004aa8..cee6ed82aa 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/log2pcap.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/log2pcap.1.html
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>log2pcap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="log2pcap.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>log2pcap &#8212; Extract network traces from Samba log files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> [-h] [-q] [logfile] [pcap_file]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267702"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> reads in a
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>log2pcap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="log2pcap.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>log2pcap &#8212; Extract network traces from Samba log files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> [-h] [-q] [logfile] [pcap_file]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544149"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> reads in a
samba log file and generates a pcap file (readable
by most sniffers, such as ethereal or tcpdump) based on the packet
dumps in the log file.</p><p>The log file must have a <em class="parameter"><code>log level</code></em>
of at least <code class="constant">5</code> to get the SMB header/parameters
right, <code class="constant">10</code> to get the first 512 data bytes of the
packet and <code class="constant">50</code> to get the whole packet.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299240"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507217"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is
specified the output file will be a
hex dump, in a format that is readable
by the <span class="application">text2pcap</span> utility.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-q</span></dt><dd><p>Be quiet. No warning messages about missing
@@ -17,13 +17,13 @@
If this argument is not specified, output data will be written
to stdout.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266749"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Extract all network traffic from all samba log files:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507296"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Extract all network traffic from all samba log files:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<code class="prompt">$</code> log2pcap &lt; /var/log/* &gt; trace.pcap
</pre><p>Convert to pcap using text2pcap:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<code class="prompt">$</code> log2pcap -h samba.log | text2pcap -T 139,139 - trace.pcap
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266787"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266798"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Only SMB data is extracted from the samba logs, no LDAP,
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507336"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507347"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Only SMB data is extracted from the samba logs, no LDAP,
NetBIOS lookup or other data.</p><p>The generated TCP and IP headers don't contain a valid
- checksum.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266813"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="text2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">text2pcap</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="ethereal.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ethereal</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266835"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ checksum.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507363"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="text2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">text2pcap</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="ethereal.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ethereal</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507386"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/mount.cifs.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/mount.cifs.8.html
index b9498dfa5f..089e01e761 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/mount.cifs.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/mount.cifs.8.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>mount.cifs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="mount.cifs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>mount.cifs &#8212; mount using the Common Internet File System (CIFS)</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">mount.cifs</code> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267695"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>mount.cifs mounts a Linux CIFS filesystem. It
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>mount.cifs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="mount.cifs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>mount.cifs &#8212; mount using the Common Internet File System (CIFS)</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">mount.cifs</code> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544149"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>mount.cifs mounts a Linux CIFS filesystem. It
is usually invoked indirectly by
-the <a href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the
+the <a class="citerefentry" href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the
"-t cifs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must
support the cifs filesystem. The CIFS protocol is the successor to the
SMB protocol and is supported by most Windows servers and many other
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ kernel log.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> causes the cifs vfs to launch a thread named cifsd. After mounting it keeps running until
the mounted resource is unmounted (usually via the umount utility).
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299241"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">user=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the username to connect as. If
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507238"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">user=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the username to connect as. If
this is not given, then the environment variable <span class="emphasis"><em>USER</em></span> is used. This option can also take the
form "user%password" or "workgroup/user" or
"workgroup/user%password" to allow the password and workgroup
@@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ to be specified as part of the username.
</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term">password=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the CIFS password. If this
option is not given then the environment variable
<span class="emphasis"><em>PASSWD</em></span> is used. If the password is not specified
-directly or indirectly via an argument to mount <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> will prompt
+directly or indirectly via an argument to mount, <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> will prompt
for a password, unless the guest option is specified.
</p><p>Note that a password which contains the delimiter
character (i.e. a comma ',') will fail to be parsed correctly
@@ -50,22 +50,57 @@ credentials file properly.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">uid=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the uid that will own all files on
the mounted filesystem.
It may be specified as either a username or a numeric uid.
- This parameter is ignored when the target server supports
- the CIFS Unix extensions.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">gid=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the gid that will own all files on
-the mounted filesystem.
-It may be specified as either a groupname or a numeric
-gid. This parameter is ignored when the target server supports
-the CIFS Unix extensions.
+ For mounts to servers which do support the CIFS Unix extensions,
+ such as a properly configured Samba server, the server provides
+ the uid, gid and mode so this parameter should not be
+ specified unless the server and client uid and gid
+ numbering differ. If the server and client are in the
+ same domain (e.g. running winbind or nss_ldap) and
+ the server supports the Unix Extensions then the uid
+ and gid can be retrieved from the server (and uid
+ and gid would not have to be specifed on the mount.
+ For servers which do not support the CIFS Unix
+ extensions, the default uid (and gid) returned on lookup
+ of existing files will be the uid (gid) of the person
+ who executed the mount (root, except when mount.cifs
+ is configured setuid for user mounts) unless the "uid="
+ (gid) mount option is specified. For the uid (gid) of newly
+ created files and directories, ie files created since
+ the last mount of the server share, the expected uid
+ (gid) is cached as long as the inode remains in
+ memory on the client. Also note that permission
+ checks (authorization checks) on accesses to a file occur
+ at the server, but there are cases in which an administrator
+ may want to restrict at the client as well. For those
+ servers which do not report a uid/gid owner
+ (such as Windows), permissions can also be checked at the
+ client, and a crude form of client side permission checking
+ can be enabled by specifying file_mode and dir_mode on
+ the client. Note that the mount.cifs helper must be
+ at version 1.10 or higher to support specifying the uid
+ (or gid) in non-numeric form.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">gid=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the gid that will own all files on
+the mounted filesystem. It may be specified as either a groupname or a numeric
+gid. For other considerations see the description of uid above.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">port=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the port number on the server to attempt to contact to negotiate
CIFS support. If the CIFS server is not listening on this port or
if it is not specified, the default ports will be tried i.e.
port 445 is tried and if no response then port 139 is tried.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">netbiosname=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>When mounting to servers via port 139, specifies the RFC1001
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">servern=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>
+ Specify the server netbios name (RFC1001 name) to use
+ when attempting to setup a session to the server. Although
+ rarely needed for mounting to newer servers, this option
+ is needed for mounting to some older servers (such
+ as OS/2 or Windows 98 and Windows ME) since when connecting
+ over port 139 they, unlike most newer servers, do not
+ support a default server name. A server name can be up
+ to 15 characters long and is usually uppercased.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">netbiosname=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>When mounting to servers via port 139, specifies the RFC1001
source name to use to represent the client netbios machine
name when doing the RFC1001 netbios session initialize.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">file_mode=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>If the server does not support the CIFS Unix extensions this
overrides the default file mode.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dir_mode=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>If the server does not support the CIFS Unix extensions this
- overrides the default mode for directories. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ip=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the destination IP address.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">domain=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the domain (workgroup) of the user </p></dd><dt><span class="term">guest</span></dt><dd><p>don't prompt for a password </p></dd><dt><span class="term">iocharset</span></dt><dd><p>Charset used to convert local path names to and from
+ overrides the default mode for directories. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ip=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the destination IP address. This option is set automatically if the server name portion of the requested UNC name can be resolved so rarely needs to be specified by the user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">domain=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>sets the domain (workgroup) of the user </p></dd><dt><span class="term">guest</span></dt><dd><p>don't prompt for a password </p></dd><dt><span class="term">iocharset</span></dt><dd><p>Charset used to convert local path names to and from
Unicode. Unicode is used by default for network path
names if the server supports it. If iocharset is
not specified then the nls_default specified
@@ -163,7 +198,26 @@ port 445 is tried and if no response then port 139 is tried.
the server lacks support for returning inode numbers or equivalent.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">noserverino</span></dt><dd><p>client generates inode numbers (rather than using the actual one
from the server) by default.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">nouser_xattr</span></dt><dd><p>(default) Do not allow getfattr/setfattr to get/set xattrs, even if server would support it otherwise. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rsize=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>default network read size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">wsize=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>default network write size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Print additional debugging information for the mount. Note that this parameter must be specified before the -o. For example:</p><p>mount -t cifs //server/share /mnt --verbose -o user=username</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308221"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">nouser_xattr</span></dt><dd><p>(default) Do not allow getfattr/setfattr to get/set xattrs, even if server would support it otherwise. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rsize=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>default network read size (usually 16K). The client currently
+ can not use rsize larger than CIFSMaxBufSize. CIFSMaxBufSize
+ defaults to 16K and may be changed (from 8K to the maximum
+ kmalloc size allowed by your kernel) at module install time
+ for cifs.ko. Setting CIFSMaxBufSize to a very large value
+ will cause cifs to use more memory and may reduce performance
+ in some cases. To use rsize greater than 127K (the original
+ cifs protocol maximum) also requires that the server support
+ a new Unix Capability flag (for very large read) which some
+ newer servers (e.g. Samba 3.0.26 or later) do. rsize can be
+ set from a minimum of 2048 to a maximum of 130048 (127K or
+ CIFSMaxBufSize, whichever is smaller)
+
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">wsize=<em class="replaceable"><code>arg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>default network write size (default 57344)
+ maximum wsize currently allowed by CIFS is 57344 (fourteen
+ 4096 byte pages)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Print additional debugging information for the mount. Note that this parameter must be specified before the -o. For example:</p><p>mount -t cifs //server/share /mnt --verbose -o user=username</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553630"></a><h2>SERVICE FORMATTING AND DELIMITERS</h2><p>
+ It's generally preferred to use forward slashes (/) as a delimiter in service names. They are considered to be the "universal delimiter" since they are generally not allowed to be embedded within path components on Windows machines and the client can convert them to blackslashes (\) unconditionally. Conversely, backslash characters are allowed by POSIX to be part of a path component, and can't be automatically converted in the same way.
+ </p><p>
+ mount.cifs will attempt to convert backslashes to forward slashes where it's able to do so, but it cannot do so in any path component following the sharename.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553654"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>
The variable <span class="emphasis"><em>USER</em></span> may contain the username of the
person to be used to authenticate to the server.
The variable can be used to set both username and
@@ -175,7 +229,7 @@ person using the client.
The variable <span class="emphasis"><em>PASSWD_FILE</em></span> may contain the pathname
of a file to read the password from. A single line of input is
read and used as the password.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308252"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root, unless installed setuid, in which case the noeexec and nosuid mount flags are enabled.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308263"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553689"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root, unless installed setuid, in which case the noeexec and nosuid mount flags are enabled.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553701"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
The primary mechanism for making configuration changes and for reading
debug information for the cifs vfs is via the Linux /proc filesystem.
In the directory <code class="filename">/proc/fs/cifs</code> are various
@@ -186,7 +240,7 @@ loaded. These can be seen by running the modinfo utility against the file
cifs.ko which will list the options that may be passed to cifs during module
installation (device driver load).
For more information see the kernel file <code class="filename">fs/cifs/README</code>.
-</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308290"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Mounting using the CIFS URL specification is currently not supported.
+</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553733"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Mounting using the CIFS URL specification is currently not supported.
</p><p>The credentials file does not handle usernames or passwords with
leading space.</p><p>
Note that the typical response to a bug report is a suggestion
@@ -194,13 +248,13 @@ to try the latest version first. So please try doing that first,
and always include which versions you use of relevant software
when reporting bugs (minimum: mount.cifs (try mount.cifs -V), kernel (see /proc/version) and
server type you are trying to contact.
-</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308311"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 1.39 of
- the cifs vfs filesystem (roughly Linux kernel 2.6.15).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308322"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553758"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 1.52 of
+ the cifs vfs filesystem (roughly Linux kernel 2.6.24).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553770"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
Documentation/filesystems/cifs.txt and fs/cifs/README in the linux kernel
source tree may contain additional options and information.
-</p><p><a href="umount.cifs.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">umount.cifs</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308342"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Steve French</p><p>The syntax and manpage were loosely based on that of smbmount. It
+</p><p><a class="citerefentry" href="umount.cifs.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">umount.cifs</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553791"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Steve French</p><p>The syntax and manpage were loosely based on that of smbmount. It
was converted to Docbook/XML by Jelmer Vernooij.</p><p>The maintainer of the Linux cifs vfs and the userspace
- tool <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> is <a href="mailto:sfrench@samba.org" target="_top">Steve French</a>.
- The <a href="mailto:linux-cifs-client@lists.samba.org" target="_top">Linux CIFS Mailing list</a>
+ tool <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> is <a class="ulink" href="mailto:sfrench@samba.org" target="_top">Steve French</a>.
+ The <a class="ulink" href="mailto:linux-cifs-client@lists.samba.org" target="_top">Linux CIFS Mailing list</a>
is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/net.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/net.8.html
index 76fbae251b..7314735ed7 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/net.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/net.8.html
@@ -1,13 +1,13 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>net</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="net.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>net &#8212; Tool for administration of Samba and remote
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>net</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="net.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>net &#8212; Tool for administration of Samba and remote
CIFS servers.
- </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">net</code> {&lt;ads|rap|rpc&gt;} [-h] [-w workgroup] [-W myworkgroup] [-U user] [-I ip-address] [-p port] [-n myname] [-s conffile] [-S server] [-l] [-P] [-d debuglevel] [-V]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267094"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The Samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility
+ </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">net</code> {&lt;ads|rap|rpc&gt;} [-h] [-w workgroup] [-W myworkgroup] [-U user] [-I ip-address] [-p port] [-n myname] [-s conffile] [-S server] [-l] [-P] [-d debuglevel] [-V]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507246"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The Samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility
available for windows and DOS. The first argument should be used
to specify the protocol to use when executing a certain command.
ADS is used for ActiveDirectory, RAP is using for old (Win9x/NT3)
clients and RPC can be used for NT4 and Windows 2000. If this
argument is omitted, net will try to determine it automatically.
Not all commands are available on all protocols.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299215"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507275"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w target-workgroup</span></dt><dd><p>
Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify
either this option or the IP address or the name of a server.
@@ -24,7 +24,7 @@
Defaults to trying 445 first, then 139.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
-to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id266742"></a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
+to setting the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
However, a command
line setting will take precedence over settings in
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
@@ -53,19 +53,19 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266844"></a> parameter
-in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266861"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id266866"></a><h3>CHANGESECRETPW</h3><p>This command allows the Samba machine account password to be set from an external application
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
+in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506333"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506338"></a><h3>CHANGESECRETPW</h3><p>This command allows the Samba machine account password to be set from an external application
to a machine account password that has already been stored in Active Directory. DO NOT USE this command
unless you know exactly what you are doing. The use of this command requires that the force flag (-f)
be used also. There will be NO command prompt. Whatever information is piped into stdin, either by
typing at the command line or otherwise, will be stored as the literal machine password. Do NOT use
this without care and attention as it will overwrite a legitimate machine password without warning.
YOU HAVE BEEN WARNED.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id266882"></a><h3>TIME</h3><p>The <code class="literal">NET TIME</code> command allows you to view the time on a remote server
- or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id266898"></a><h4>TIME</h4><p>Without any options, the <code class="literal">NET TIME</code> command
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506359"></a><h3>TIME</h3><p>The <code class="literal">NET TIME</code> command allows you to view the time on a remote server
+ or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506376"></a><h4>TIME</h4><p>Without any options, the <code class="literal">NET TIME</code> command
displays the time on the remote server.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id266914"></a><h4>TIME SYSTEM</h4><p>Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <code class="literal">/bin/date</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307883"></a><h4>TIME SET</h4><p>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on
-the remote server using <code class="literal">/bin/date</code>. </p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307898"></a><h4>TIME ZONE</h4><p>Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id307909"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] JOIN [TYPE] [-U username[%password]] [createupn=UPN] [createcomputer=OU] [options]</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506393"></a><h4>TIME SYSTEM</h4><p>Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <code class="literal">/bin/date</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506410"></a><h4>TIME SET</h4><p>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on
+the remote server using <code class="literal">/bin/date</code>. </p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506427"></a><h4>TIME ZONE</h4><p>Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506440"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] JOIN [TYPE] [-U username[%password]] [createupn=UPN] [createcomputer=OU] [options]</h3><p>
Join a domain. If the account already exists on the server, and
[TYPE] is MEMBER, the machine will attempt to join automatically.
(Assuming that the machine has been created in server manager)
@@ -82,81 +82,81 @@ OU string reads from top to bottom without RDNs, and is delimited by
a '/'. Please note that '\' is used for escape by both the shell
and ldap, so it may need to be doubled or quadrupled to pass through,
and it is not used as a delimiter.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id307939"></a><h3>[RPC] OLDJOIN [options]</h3><p>Join a domain. Use the OLDJOIN option to join the domain
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506474"></a><h3>[RPC] OLDJOIN [options]</h3><p>Join a domain. Use the OLDJOIN option to join the domain
using the old style of domain joining - you need to create a trust
-account in server manager first.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id307950"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] USER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307956"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER</h4><p>List all users</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307966"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>target</code></em></h4><p>Delete specified user</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307978"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>target</code></em></h4><p>List the domain groups of the specified user.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id307991"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER RENAME <em class="replaceable"><code>oldname</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>newname</code></em></h4><p>Rename specified user.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308007"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [password] [-F user flags] [-C comment]</h4><p>Add specified user.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308022"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] GROUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308028"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP [misc options] [targets]</h4><p>List user groups.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308038"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [misc. options]</h4><p>Delete specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308052"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [-C comment]</h4><p>Create specified group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308067"></a><h3>[RAP|RPC] SHARE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308073"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE [misc. options] [targets]</h4><p>Enumerates all exported resources (network shares) on target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308084"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name=serverpath</code></em> [-C comment] [-M maxusers] [targets]</h4><p>Adds a share from a server (makes the export active). Maxusers
+account in server manager first.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506487"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] USER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506493"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER</h4><p>List all users</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506503"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>target</code></em></h4><p>Delete specified user</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506516"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>target</code></em></h4><p>List the domain groups of the specified user.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506530"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER RENAME <em class="replaceable"><code>oldname</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>newname</code></em></h4><p>Rename specified user.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506546"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] USER ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [password] [-F user flags] [-C comment]</h4><p>Add specified user.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506561"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] GROUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506567"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP [misc options] [targets]</h4><p>List user groups.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506578"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [misc. options]</h4><p>Delete specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506592"></a><h4>[RPC|ADS] GROUP ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> [-C comment]</h4><p>Create specified group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506608"></a><h3>[RAP|RPC] SHARE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506614"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE [misc. options] [targets]</h4><p>Enumerates all exported resources (network shares) on target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506625"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] SHARE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>name=serverpath</code></em> [-C comment] [-M maxusers] [targets]</h4><p>Adds a share from a server (makes the export active). Maxusers
specifies the number of users that can be connected to the
-share simultaneously.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308099"></a><h4>SHARE DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>Delete specified share.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308112"></a><h3>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308118"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h4><p>List all open files on remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308128"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE CLOSE <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em></h4><p>Close file with specified <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em> on
-remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308145"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em></h4><p>
+share simultaneously.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506642"></a><h4>SHARE DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>Delete specified share.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506656"></a><h3>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506662"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE</h4><p>List all open files on remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506673"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE CLOSE <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em></h4><p>Close file with specified <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em> on
+remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506690"></a><h4>[RPC|RAP] FILE INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em></h4><p>
Print information on specified <em class="replaceable"><code>fileid</code></em>.
Currently listed are: file-id, username, locks, path, permissions.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308161"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] FILE USER <em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506707"></a><h4>[RAP|RPC] FILE USER <em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em></h4><p>
List files opened by specified <em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em>.
Please note that <code class="literal">net rap file user</code> does not work
against Samba servers.
-</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308185"></a><h3>SESSION</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308191"></a><h4>RAP SESSION</h4><p>Without any other options, SESSION enumerates all active SMB/CIFS
-sessions on the target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308201"></a><h4>RAP SESSION DELETE|CLOSE <em class="replaceable"><code>CLIENT_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Close the specified sessions.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308214"></a><h4>RAP SESSION INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>CLIENT_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Give a list with all the open files in specified session.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308228"></a><h3>RAP SERVER <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h3><p>List all servers in specified domain or workgroup. Defaults
-to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308241"></a><h3>RAP DOMAIN</h3><p>Lists all domains and workgroups visible on the
-current network.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308252"></a><h3>RAP PRINTQ</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308257"></a><h4>RAP PRINTQ LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>QUEUE_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Lists the specified print queue and print jobs on the server.
+</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506731"></a><h3>SESSION</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506737"></a><h4>RAP SESSION</h4><p>Without any other options, SESSION enumerates all active SMB/CIFS
+sessions on the target server.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506748"></a><h4>RAP SESSION DELETE|CLOSE <em class="replaceable"><code>CLIENT_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Close the specified sessions.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2506762"></a><h4>RAP SESSION INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>CLIENT_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Give a list with all the open files in specified session.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506776"></a><h3>RAP SERVER <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h3><p>List all servers in specified domain or workgroup. Defaults
+to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506790"></a><h3>RAP DOMAIN</h3><p>Lists all domains and workgroups visible on the
+current network.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506801"></a><h3>RAP PRINTQ</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553510"></a><h4>RAP PRINTQ LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>QUEUE_NAME</code></em></h4><p>Lists the specified print queue and print jobs on the server.
If the <em class="replaceable"><code>QUEUE_NAME</code></em> is omitted, all
-queues are listed.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308274"></a><h4>RAP PRINTQ DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>JOBID</code></em></h4><p>Delete job with specified id.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308288"></a><h3>RAP VALIDATE <em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>password</code></em>]</h3><p>
+queues are listed.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553528"></a><h4>RAP PRINTQ DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>JOBID</code></em></h4><p>Delete job with specified id.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553542"></a><h3>RAP VALIDATE <em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>password</code></em>]</h3><p>
Validate whether the specified user can log in to the
remote server. If the password is not specified on the commandline, it
will be prompted.
-</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308311"></a><h3>RAP GROUPMEMBER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308316"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em></h4><p>List all members of the specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308329"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em></h4><p>Delete member from group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308345"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em></h4><p>Add member to group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308362"></a><h3>RAP ADMIN <em class="replaceable"><code>command</code></em></h3><p>Execute the specified <em class="replaceable"><code>command</code></em> on
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553566"></a><h3>RAP GROUPMEMBER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553572"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em></h4><p>List all members of the specified group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553585"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em></h4><p>Delete member from group.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553602"></a><h4>RAP GROUPMEMBER ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>GROUP</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em></h4><p>Add member to group.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553620"></a><h3>RAP ADMIN <em class="replaceable"><code>command</code></em></h3><p>Execute the specified <em class="replaceable"><code>command</code></em> on
the remote server. Only works with OS/2 servers.
-</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308384"></a><h3>RAP SERVICE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308389"></a><h4>RAP SERVICE START <em class="replaceable"><code>NAME</code></em> [arguments...]</h4><p>Start the specified service on the remote server. Not implemented yet.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308408"></a><h4>RAP SERVICE STOP</h4><p>Stop the specified service on the remote server.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308424"></a><h3>RAP PASSWORD <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>OLDPASS</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>NEWPASS</code></em></h3><p>
+</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553642"></a><h3>RAP SERVICE</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553647"></a><h4>RAP SERVICE START <em class="replaceable"><code>NAME</code></em> [arguments...]</h4><p>Start the specified service on the remote server. Not implemented yet.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553667"></a><h4>RAP SERVICE STOP</h4><p>Stop the specified service on the remote server.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Currently NOT implemented.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553684"></a><h3>RAP PASSWORD <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>OLDPASS</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>NEWPASS</code></em></h3><p>
Change password of <em class="replaceable"><code>USER</code></em> from <em class="replaceable"><code>OLDPASS</code></em> to <em class="replaceable"><code>NEWPASS</code></em>.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308455"></a><h3>LOOKUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308460"></a><h4>LOOKUP HOST <em class="replaceable"><code>HOSTNAME</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>TYPE</code></em>]</h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553715"></a><h3>LOOKUP</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553720"></a><h4>LOOKUP HOST <em class="replaceable"><code>HOSTNAME</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>TYPE</code></em>]</h4><p>
Lookup the IP address of the given host with the specified type (netbios suffix).
The type defaults to 0x20 (workstation).
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308478"></a><h4>LOOKUP LDAP [<em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP address of LDAP server of specified <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308496"></a><h4>LOOKUP KDC [<em class="replaceable"><code>REALM</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP address of KDC for the specified <em class="replaceable"><code>REALM</code></em>.
-Defaults to local realm.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308514"></a><h4>LOOKUP DC [<em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP's of Domain Controllers for specified <em class="replaceable"><code>
-DOMAIN</code></em>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308531"></a><h4>LOOKUP MASTER <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Give IP of master browser for specified <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>
-or workgroup. Defaults to local domain.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308549"></a><h3>CACHE</h3><p>Samba uses a general caching interface called 'gencache'. It
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553740"></a><h4>LOOKUP LDAP [<em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP address of LDAP server of specified <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553758"></a><h4>LOOKUP KDC [<em class="replaceable"><code>REALM</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP address of KDC for the specified <em class="replaceable"><code>REALM</code></em>.
+Defaults to local realm.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553776"></a><h4>LOOKUP DC [<em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>]</h4><p>Give IP's of Domain Controllers for specified <em class="replaceable"><code>
+DOMAIN</code></em>. Defaults to local domain.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553795"></a><h4>LOOKUP MASTER <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Give IP of master browser for specified <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>
+or workgroup. Defaults to local domain.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553813"></a><h3>CACHE</h3><p>Samba uses a general caching interface called 'gencache'. It
can be controlled using 'NET CACHE'.</p><p>All the timeout parameters support the suffixes:
</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>s - Seconds</td></tr><tr><td>m - Minutes</td></tr><tr><td>h - Hours</td></tr><tr><td>d - Days</td></tr><tr><td>w - Weeks</td></tr></table><p>
-</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308586"></a><h4>CACHE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>data</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>time-out</code></em></h4><p>Add specified key+data to the cache with the given timeout.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308605"></a><h4>CACHE DEL <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em></h4><p>Delete key from the cache.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308618"></a><h4>CACHE SET <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>data</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>time-out</code></em></h4><p>Update data of existing cache entry.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308637"></a><h4>CACHE SEARCH <em class="replaceable"><code>PATTERN</code></em></h4><p>Search for the specified pattern in the cache data.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308650"></a><h4>CACHE LIST</h4><p>
+</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553851"></a><h4>CACHE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>data</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>time-out</code></em></h4><p>Add specified key+data to the cache with the given timeout.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553871"></a><h4>CACHE DEL <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em></h4><p>Delete key from the cache.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553883"></a><h4>CACHE SET <em class="replaceable"><code>key</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>data</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>time-out</code></em></h4><p>Update data of existing cache entry.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553903"></a><h4>CACHE SEARCH <em class="replaceable"><code>PATTERN</code></em></h4><p>Search for the specified pattern in the cache data.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553916"></a><h4>CACHE LIST</h4><p>
List all current items in the cache.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308660"></a><h4>CACHE FLUSH</h4><p>Remove all the current items from the cache.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308671"></a><h3>GETLOCALSID [DOMAIN]</h3><p>Prints the SID of the specified domain, or if the parameter is
-omitted, the SID of the local server.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308682"></a><h3>SETLOCALSID S-1-5-21-x-y-z</h3><p>Sets SID for the local server to the specified SID.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308693"></a><h3>GETDOMAINSID</h3><p>Prints the local machine SID and the SID of the current
-domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308703"></a><h3>SETDOMAINSID</h3><p>Sets the SID of the current domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308714"></a><h3>GROUPMAP</h3><p>Manage the mappings between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2553927"></a><h4>CACHE FLUSH</h4><p>Remove all the current items from the cache.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553939"></a><h3>GETLOCALSID [DOMAIN]</h3><p>Prints the SID of the specified domain, or if the parameter is
+omitted, the SID of the local server.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553951"></a><h3>SETLOCALSID S-1-5-21-x-y-z</h3><p>Sets SID for the local server to the specified SID.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553962"></a><h3>GETDOMAINSID</h3><p>Prints the local machine SID and the SID of the current
+domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553973"></a><h3>SETDOMAINSID</h3><p>Sets the SID of the current domain.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553984"></a><h3>GROUPMAP</h3><p>Manage the mappings between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups.
Common options include:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>unixgroup - Name of the UNIX group</p></li><li><p>ntgroup - Name of the Windows NT group (must be
resolvable to a SID</p></li><li><p>rid - Unsigned 32-bit integer</p></li><li><p>sid - Full SID in the form of "S-1-..."</p></li><li><p>type - Type of the group; either 'domain', 'local',
- or 'builtin'</p></li><li><p>comment - Freeform text description of the group</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308755"></a><h4>GROUPMAP ADD</h4><p>
+ or 'builtin'</p></li><li><p>comment - Freeform text description of the group</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554028"></a><h4>GROUPMAP ADD</h4><p>
Add a new group mapping entry:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
net groupmap add {rid=int|sid=string} unixgroup=string \
[type={domain|local}] [ntgroup=string] [comment=string]
</pre><p>
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308772"></a><h4>GROUPMAP DELETE</h4><p>Delete a group mapping entry. If more than one group name matches, the first entry found is deleted.</p><p>net groupmap delete {ntgroup=string|sid=SID}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308786"></a><h4>GROUPMAP MODIFY</h4><p>Update en existing group entry.</p><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554047"></a><h4>GROUPMAP DELETE</h4><p>Delete a group mapping entry. If more than one group name matches, the first entry found is deleted.</p><p>net groupmap delete {ntgroup=string|sid=SID}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554063"></a><h4>GROUPMAP MODIFY</h4><p>Update en existing group entry.</p><p>
</p><pre class="programlisting">
net groupmap modify {ntgroup=string|sid=SID} [unixgroup=string] \
[comment=string] [type={domain|local}]
</pre><p>
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308806"></a><h4>GROUPMAP LIST</h4><p>List existing group mapping entries.</p><p>net groupmap list [verbose] [ntgroup=string] [sid=SID]</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308821"></a><h3>MAXRID</h3><p>Prints out the highest RID currently in use on the local
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554084"></a><h4>GROUPMAP LIST</h4><p>List existing group mapping entries.</p><p>net groupmap list [verbose] [ntgroup=string] [sid=SID]</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554100"></a><h3>MAXRID</h3><p>Prints out the highest RID currently in use on the local
server (by the active 'passdb backend').
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308832"></a><h3>RPC INFO</h3><p>Print information about the domain of the remote server,
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554112"></a><h3>RPC INFO</h3><p>Print information about the domain of the remote server,
such as domain name, domain sid and number of users and groups.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308843"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] TESTJOIN</h3><p>Check whether participation in a domain is still valid.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308854"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] CHANGETRUSTPW</h3><p>Force change of domain trust password.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308864"></a><h3>RPC TRUSTDOM</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308870"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Add a interdomain trust account for <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554124"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] TESTJOIN</h3><p>Check whether participation in a domain is still valid.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554135"></a><h3>[RPC|ADS] CHANGETRUSTPW</h3><p>Force change of domain trust password.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554146"></a><h3>RPC TRUSTDOM</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554152"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Add a interdomain trust account for <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>.
This is in fact a Samba account named <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN$</code></em>
with the account flag <code class="constant">'I'</code> (interdomain trust account).
If the command is used against localhost it has the same effect as
<code class="literal">smbpasswd -a -i DOMAIN</code>. Please note that both commands
expect a appropriate UNIX account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308901"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM DEL <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Remove interdomain trust account for
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554185"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM DEL <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Remove interdomain trust account for
<em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em>. If it is used against localhost
it has the same effect as <code class="literal">smbpasswd -x DOMAIN$</code>.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308923"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ESTABLISH <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554209"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM ESTABLISH <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>
Establish a trust relationship to a trusting domain.
Interdomain account must already be created on the remote PDC.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308936"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM REVOKE <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Abandon relationship to trusted domain</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308949"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM LIST</h4><p>List all current interdomain trust relationships.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id308960"></a><h4>RPC RIGHTS</h4><p>This subcommand is used to view and manage Samba's rights assignments (also
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554224"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM REVOKE <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN</code></em></h4><p>Abandon relationship to trusted domain</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554237"></a><h4>RPC TRUSTDOM LIST</h4><p>List all current interdomain trust relationships.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554248"></a><h4>RPC RIGHTS</h4><p>This subcommand is used to view and manage Samba's rights assignments (also
referred to as privileges). There are three options currently available:
<em class="parameter"><code>list</code></em>, <em class="parameter"><code>grant</code></em>, and
<em class="parameter"><code>revoke</code></em>. More details on Samba's privilege model and its use
-can be found in the Samba-HOWTO-Collection.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308991"></a><h3>RPC ABORTSHUTDOWN</h3><p>Abort the shutdown of a remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309001"></a><h3>RPC SHUTDOWN [-t timeout] [-r] [-f] [-C message]</h3><p>Shut down the remote server.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>
+can be found in the Samba-HOWTO-Collection.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554281"></a><h3>RPC ABORTSHUTDOWN</h3><p>Abort the shutdown of a remote server.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554292"></a><h3>RPC SHUTDOWN [-t timeout] [-r] [-f] [-C message]</h3><p>Shut down the remote server.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>
Reboot after shutdown.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f</span></dt><dd><p>
Force shutting down all applications.
@@ -164,21 +164,21 @@ Force shutting down all applications.
Timeout before system will be shut down. An interactive
user of the system can use this time to cancel the shutdown.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C message</span></dt><dd><p>Display the specified message on the screen to
-announce the shutdown.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309061"></a><h3>RPC SAMDUMP</h3><p>Print out sam database of remote server. You need
-to run this against the PDC, from a Samba machine joined as a BDC. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309072"></a><h3>RPC VAMPIRE</h3><p>Export users, aliases and groups from remote server to
+announce the shutdown.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554355"></a><h3>RPC SAMDUMP</h3><p>Print out sam database of remote server. You need
+to run this against the PDC, from a Samba machine joined as a BDC. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554367"></a><h3>RPC VAMPIRE</h3><p>Export users, aliases and groups from remote server to
local server. You need to run this against the PDC, from a Samba machine joined as a BDC.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309083"></a><h3>RPC GETSID</h3><p>Fetch domain SID and store it in the local <code class="filename">secrets.tdb</code>. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309099"></a><h3>ADS LEAVE</h3><p>Make the remote host leave the domain it is part of. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309109"></a><h3>ADS STATUS</h3><p>Print out status of machine account of the local machine in ADS.
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554379"></a><h3>RPC GETSID</h3><p>Fetch domain SID and store it in the local <code class="filename">secrets.tdb</code>. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554396"></a><h3>ADS LEAVE</h3><p>Make the remote host leave the domain it is part of. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554407"></a><h3>ADS STATUS</h3><p>Print out status of machine account of the local machine in ADS.
Prints out quite some debug info. Aimed at developers, regular
-users should use <code class="literal">NET ADS TESTJOIN</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309126"></a><h3>ADS PRINTER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309132"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER INFO [<em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em>] [<em class="replaceable"><code>SERVER</code></em>]</h4><p>
+users should use <code class="literal">NET ADS TESTJOIN</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554425"></a><h3>ADS PRINTER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554431"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER INFO [<em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em>] [<em class="replaceable"><code>SERVER</code></em>]</h4><p>
Lookup info for <em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em> on <em class="replaceable"><code>SERVER</code></em>. The printer name defaults to "*", the
-server name defaults to the local host.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309157"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER PUBLISH <em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em></h4><p>Publish specified printer using ADS.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309170"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER REMOVE <em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em></h4><p>Remove specified printer from ADS directory.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309183"></a><h3>ADS SEARCH <em class="replaceable"><code>EXPRESSION</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>ATTRIBUTES...</code></em></h3><p>Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
+server name defaults to the local host.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554457"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER PUBLISH <em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em></h4><p>Publish specified printer using ADS.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554470"></a><h4>ADS PRINTER REMOVE <em class="replaceable"><code>PRINTER</code></em></h4><p>Remove specified printer from ADS directory.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554484"></a><h3>ADS SEARCH <em class="replaceable"><code>EXPRESSION</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>ATTRIBUTES...</code></em></h3><p>Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
expression is a standard LDAP search expression, and the
attributes are a list of LDAP fields to show in the results.</p><p>Example: <strong class="userinput"><code>net ads search '(objectCategory=group)' sAMAccountName</code></strong>
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309210"></a><h3>ADS DN <em class="replaceable"><code>DN</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>(attributes)</code></em></h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554513"></a><h3>ADS DN <em class="replaceable"><code>DN</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>(attributes)</code></em></h3><p>
Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
DN standard LDAP DN, and the attributes are a list of LDAP fields
to show in the result.
-</p><p>Example: <strong class="userinput"><code>net ads dn 'CN=administrator,CN=Users,DC=my,DC=domain' SAMAccountName</code></strong></p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309236"></a><h3>ADS WORKGROUP</h3><p>Print out workgroup name for specified kerberos realm.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309246"></a><h3>SAM CREATEBUILTINGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p><p>Example: <strong class="userinput"><code>net ads dn 'CN=administrator,CN=Users,DC=my,DC=domain' SAMAccountName</code></strong></p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554541"></a><h3>ADS WORKGROUP</h3><p>Print out workgroup name for specified kerberos realm.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554552"></a><h3>SAM CREATEBUILTINGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
(Re)Create a BUILTIN group.
Only a wellknown set of BUILTIN groups can be created with this command.
This is the list of currently recognized group names: Administrators,
@@ -188,78 +188,78 @@ compatible Access.
This command requires a running Winbindd with idmap allocation properly
configured. The group gid will be allocated out of the winbindd range.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309260"></a><h3>SAM CREATELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554571"></a><h3>SAM CREATELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Create a LOCAL group (also known as Alias).
This command requires a running Winbindd with idmap allocation properly
configured. The group gid will be allocated out of the winbindd range.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309272"></a><h3>SAM DELETELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554585"></a><h3>SAM DELETELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Delete an existing LOCAL group (also known as Alias).
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309283"></a><h3>SAM MAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554596"></a><h3>SAM MAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Map an existing Unix group and make it a Domain Group, the domain group
will have the same name.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309294"></a><h3>SAM UNMAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554608"></a><h3>SAM UNMAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Remove an existing group mapping entry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309305"></a><h3>SAM ADDMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554620"></a><h3>SAM ADDMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</h3><p>
Add a member to a Local group. The group can be specified only by name,
the member can be specified by name or SID.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309316"></a><h3>SAM DELMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554632"></a><h3>SAM DELMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</h3><p>
Remove a member from a Local group. The group and the member must be
specified by name.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309327"></a><h3>SAM LISTMEM &lt;GROUP&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554645"></a><h3>SAM LISTMEM &lt;GROUP&gt;</h3><p>
List Local group members. The group must be specified by name.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309338"></a><h3>SAM LIST &lt;users|groups|localgroups|builtin|workstations&gt; [verbose]</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554656"></a><h3>SAM LIST &lt;users|groups|localgroups|builtin|workstations&gt; [verbose]</h3><p>
List the specified set of accounts by name. If verbose is specified,
the rid and description is also provided for each account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309350"></a><h3>SAM SHOW &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554670"></a><h3>SAM SHOW &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Show the full DOMAIN\\NAME the SID and the type for the corresponding
account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309361"></a><h3>SAM SET HOMEDIR &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DIRECTORY&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554682"></a><h3>SAM SET HOMEDIR &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DIRECTORY&gt;</h3><p>
Set the home directory for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309371"></a><h3>SAM SET PROFILEPATH &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;PATH&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554693"></a><h3>SAM SET PROFILEPATH &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;PATH&gt;</h3><p>
Set the profile path for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309382"></a><h3>SAM SET COMMENT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;COMMENT&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554704"></a><h3>SAM SET COMMENT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;COMMENT&gt;</h3><p>
Set the comment for a user or group account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309392"></a><h3>SAM SET FULLNAME &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;FULL NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554716"></a><h3>SAM SET FULLNAME &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;FULL NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Set the full name for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309403"></a><h3>SAM SET LOGONSCRIPT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;SCRIPT&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554727"></a><h3>SAM SET LOGONSCRIPT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;SCRIPT&gt;</h3><p>
Set the logon script for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309413"></a><h3>SAM SET HOMEDRIVE &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DRIVE&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554738"></a><h3>SAM SET HOMEDRIVE &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DRIVE&gt;</h3><p>
Set the home drive for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309424"></a><h3>SAM SET WORKSTATIONS &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;WORKSTATIONS&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554749"></a><h3>SAM SET WORKSTATIONS &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;WORKSTATIONS&gt;</h3><p>
Set the workstations a user account is allowed to log in from.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309435"></a><h3>SAM SET DISABLE &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554761"></a><h3>SAM SET DISABLE &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Set the "disabled" flag for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309445"></a><h3>SAM SET PWNOTREQ &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554772"></a><h3>SAM SET PWNOTREQ &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Set the "password not required" flag for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309456"></a><h3>SAM SET AUTOLOCK &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554784"></a><h3>SAM SET AUTOLOCK &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Set the "autolock" flag for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309466"></a><h3>SAM SET PWNOEXP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554795"></a><h3>SAM SET PWNOEXP &lt;NAME&gt;</h3><p>
Set the "password do not expire" flag for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309477"></a><h3>SAM SET PWDMUSTCHANGENOW &lt;NAME&gt; [yes|no]</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554806"></a><h3>SAM SET PWDMUSTCHANGENOW &lt;NAME&gt; [yes|no]</h3><p>
Set or unset the "password must change" flag for a user account.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309488"></a><h3>SAM POLICY LIST</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554818"></a><h3>SAM POLICY LIST</h3><p>
List the available account policies.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309498"></a><h3>SAM POLICY SHOW &lt;account policy&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554829"></a><h3>SAM POLICY SHOW &lt;account policy&gt;</h3><p>
Show the account policy value.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309509"></a><h3>SAM POLICY SET &lt;account policy&gt; &lt;value&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554840"></a><h3>SAM POLICY SET &lt;account policy&gt; &lt;value&gt;</h3><p>
Set a value for the account policy.
Valid values can be: "forever", "never", "off", or a number.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309520"></a><h3>SAM PROVISION</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554853"></a><h3>SAM PROVISION</h3><p>
Only available if ldapsam:editposix is set and winbindd is running.
Properly populates the ldap tree with the basic accounts (Administrator)
and groups (Domain Users, Domain Admins, Domain Guests) on the ldap tree.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309532"></a><h3>IDMAP DUMP &lt;local tdb file name&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554866"></a><h3>IDMAP DUMP &lt;local tdb file name&gt;</h3><p>
Dumps the mappings contained in the local tdb file specified.
This command is useful to dump only the mappings produced by the idmap_tdb backend.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309544"></a><h3>IDMAP RESTORE [input file]</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554880"></a><h3>IDMAP RESTORE [input file]</h3><p>
Restore the mappings from the specified file or stdin.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309554"></a><h3>IDMAP SECRET &lt;DOMAIN&gt;|ALLOC &lt;secret&gt;</h3><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554891"></a><h3>IDMAP SECRET &lt;DOMAIN&gt;|ALLOC &lt;secret&gt;</h3><p>
Store a secret for the specified domain, used primarily for domains
that use idmap_ldap as a backend. In this case the secret is used
as the password for the user DN used to bind to the ldap server.
-</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309566"></a><h3>USERSHARE</h3><p>Starting with version 3.0.23, a Samba server now supports the ability for
+</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554906"></a><h3>USERSHARE</h3><p>Starting with version 3.0.23, a Samba server now supports the ability for
non-root users to add user defined shares to be exported using the "net usershare"
commands.
</p><p>
@@ -288,7 +288,7 @@ can create user defined shares on demand using the commands below.
</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>net usershare add sharename path [comment] [acl] [guest_ok=[y|n]] - to add or change a user defined share.</td></tr><tr><td>net usershare delete sharename - to delete a user defined share.</td></tr><tr><td>net usershare info [-l|--long] [wildcard sharename] - to print info about a user defined share.</td></tr><tr><td>net usershare list [-l|--long] [wildcard sharename] - to list user defined shares.</td></tr></table><p>
-</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309613"></a><h4>USERSHARE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>path</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[comment]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[acl]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[guest_ok=[y|n]]</code></em></h4><p>
+</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2554964"></a><h4>USERSHARE ADD <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>path</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[comment]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[acl]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[guest_ok=[y|n]]</code></em></h4><p>
Add or replace a new user defined share, with name "sharename".
</p><p>
"path" specifies the absolute pathname on the system to be exported.
@@ -325,11 +325,11 @@ sharename as the one you wish to modify and specify the new options
you wish. The Samba smbd daemon notices user defined share modifications
at connect time so will see the change immediately, there is no need
to restart smbd on adding, deleting or changing a user defined share.
-</div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309671"></a><h4>USERSHARE DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
+</div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555038"></a><h4>USERSHARE DELETE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
Deletes the user defined share by name. The Samba smbd daemon
immediately notices this change, although it will not disconnect
any users currently connected to the deleted share.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309685"></a><h4>USERSHARE INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>[-l|--long]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[wildcard sharename]</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555054"></a><h4>USERSHARE INFO <em class="replaceable"><code>[-l|--long]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[wildcard sharename]</code></em></h4><p>
Get info on user defined shares owned by the current user matching the given pattern, or all users.
</p><p>
net usershare info on its own dumps out info on the user defined shares that were
@@ -348,7 +348,7 @@ guest_ok=n
And is a list of the current settings of the user defined share that can be
modified by the "net usershare add" command.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309714"></a><h4>USERSHARE LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>[-l|--long]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>wildcard sharename</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555089"></a><h4>USERSHARE LIST <em class="replaceable"><code>[-l|--long]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>wildcard sharename</code></em></h4><p>
List all the user defined shares owned by the current user matching the given pattern, or all users.
</p><p>
net usershare list on its own list out the names of the user defined shares that were
@@ -356,7 +356,7 @@ created by the current user, or restricts the list to share names that match the
wildcard pattern ('*' matches one or more characters, '?' matches only one character).
If the '-l' or '--long' option is also given, it includes the names of user defined
shares created by other users.
-</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id309738"></a><h3>CONF</h3><p>Starting with version 3.2.0, a Samba server can be configured by data
+</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2555123"></a><h3>CONF</h3><p>Starting with version 3.2.0, a Samba server can be configured by data
stored in registry. This configuration data can be edited with the new "net
conf" commands.
</p><p>
@@ -364,18 +364,18 @@ The deployment of this configuration data can be activated in two levels from th
<span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span> file: Share definitions from registry are
activated by setting <em class="parameter"><code>registry shares</code></em> to
&#8220;<span class="quote">yes</span>&#8221; in the [global] section and global configuration options are
-activated by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id309765"></a>include = registry in
+activated by setting <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INCLUDE">include = registry</a> in
the [global] section.
-See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manpage for details.
+See the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manpage for details.
</p><p>The conf commands are:
</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>net conf list - Dump the complete configuration in smb.conf like
format.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf import - Import configuration from file in smb.conf
format.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf listshares - List the registry shares.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf drop - Delete the complete configuration from
registry.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf showshare - Show the definition of a registry share.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf addshare - Create a new registry share.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf delshare - Delete a registry share.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf setparm - Store a parameter.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf getparm - Retrieve the value of a parameter.</td></tr><tr><td>net conf delparm - Delete a parameter.</td></tr></table><p>
-</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309828"></a><h4>CONF LIST</h4><p>
+</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555228"></a><h4>CONF LIST</h4><p>
Print the configuration data stored in the registry in a smb.conf-like format to
standard output.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309839"></a><h4>CONF IMPORT <em class="replaceable"><code>[--test|-T]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>filename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[section]</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555239"></a><h4>CONF IMPORT <em class="replaceable"><code>[--test|-T]</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>filename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>[section]</code></em></h4><p>
This command imports configuration from a file in smb.conf format.
If a section encountered in the input file is present in registry,
its contents is replaced. Sections of registry configuration that have
@@ -385,32 +385,32 @@ Optionally, a section may be specified to restrict the effect of the
import command to that specific section. A test mode is enabled by specifying
the parameter "-T" on the commandline. In test mode, no changes are made to the
registry, and the resulting configuration is printed to standard output instead.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309864"></a><h4>CONF LISTSHARES</h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555270"></a><h4>CONF LISTSHARES</h4><p>
List the names of the shares defined in registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309875"></a><h4>CONF DROP</h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555281"></a><h4>CONF DROP</h4><p>
Delete the complete configuration data from registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309885"></a><h4>CONF SHOWSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555292"></a><h4>CONF SHOWSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
Show the definition of the share or section specified. It is valid to specify
"global" as sharename to retrieve the global configuration options from
registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309899"></a><h4>CONF ADDSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>path</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>writeable={y|N}</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>guest_ok={y|N}</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>comment</code></em>]]] </h4><p>Create a new share definition in registry.
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555307"></a><h4>CONF ADDSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>path</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>writeable={y|N}</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>guest_ok={y|N}</code></em> [<em class="replaceable"><code>comment</code></em>]]] </h4><p>Create a new share definition in registry.
The sharename and path have to be given. The share name may
<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be "global". Optionally, values for the very
common options "writeable", "guest ok" and a "comment" may be specified.
The same result may be obtained by a sequence of "net conf setparm"
commands.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309932"></a><h4>CONF DELSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555343"></a><h4>CONF DELSHARE <em class="replaceable"><code>sharename</code></em></h4><p>
Delete a share definition from registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309945"></a><h4>CONF SETPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>value</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555356"></a><h4>CONF SETPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>value</code></em></h4><p>
Store a parameter in registry. The section may be global or a sharename.
The section is created if it does not exist yet.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309965"></a><h4>CONF GETPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555378"></a><h4>CONF GETPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em></h4><p>
Show a parameter stored in registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309981"></a><h4>CONF DELPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em></h4><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555395"></a><h4>CONF DELPARM <em class="replaceable"><code>section</code></em> <em class="replaceable"><code>parameter</code></em></h4><p>
Delete a parameter stored in registry.
-</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id309998"></a><h4></h4><p>
-</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id310007"></a><h3>HELP [COMMAND]</h3><p>Gives usage information for the specified command.</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310019"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is complete for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310029"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><a name="id2555411"></a><h4></h4><p>
+</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2555421"></a><h3>HELP [COMMAND]</h3><p>Gives usage information for the specified command.</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555433"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is complete for version 3.0 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555444"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The net manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmbd.8.html
index 4d8a2f8bf2..33b08267b3 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmbd.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmbd &#8212; NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
- over IP naming services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-a] [-i] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-H &lt;lmhosts file&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-p &lt;port number&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267087"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> is a server that understands
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmbd &#8212; NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
+ over IP naming services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-a] [-i] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-H &lt;lmhosts file&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-p &lt;port number&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507240"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> is a server that understands
and can reply to NetBIOS over IP name service requests, like
those produced by SMB/CIFS clients such as Windows 95/98/ME,
Windows NT, Windows 2000, Windows XP and LanManager clients. It also
@@ -11,18 +11,18 @@
specified it will respond with the IP number of the host it
is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by
default the primary DNS name of the host it is running on,
- but this can be overridden by the <a class="indexterm" name="id299225"></a>netbios name
+ but this can be overridden by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</a>
in <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>. Thus <code class="literal">nmbd</code> will
reply to broadcast queries for its own name(s). Additional
names for <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to respond on can be set
- via parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> can also be used as a WINS
+ via parameters in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p><p><code class="literal">nmbd</code> can also be used as a WINS
(Windows Internet Name Server) server. What this basically means
is that it will act as a WINS database server, creating a
database from name registration requests that it receives and
replying to queries from clients for these names.</p><p>In addition, <code class="literal">nmbd</code> can act as a WINS
proxy, relaying broadcast queries from clients that do
not understand how to talk the WINS protocol to a WINS
- server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266718"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507456"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
<code class="literal">nmbd</code> to operate as a daemon. That is,
it detaches itself and runs in the background, fielding
requests on the appropriate port. By default, <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
@@ -51,7 +51,7 @@
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H &lt;filename&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS lmhosts file. The lmhosts
file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that
is loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name
- resolution mechanism <a class="indexterm" name="id266863"></a>name resolve order described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> to resolve any
+ resolution mechanism <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order</a> described in <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> to resolve any
NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note
that the contents of this file are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
used by <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to answer any name queries.
@@ -60,7 +60,7 @@
Samba as part of the build process. Common defaults
are <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</code>,
<code class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</code> or
- <code class="filename">/etc/samba/lmhosts</code>. See the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> man page for details on the contents of this file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debuglevel=level</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>level</code></em> is an integer
+ <code class="filename">/etc/samba/lmhosts</code>. See the <a class="citerefentry" href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> man page for details on the contents of this file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debuglevel=level</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>level</code></em> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
not specified is 0.</p><p>The higher this value, the more detail will be
logged to the log files about the activities of the
@@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id307906"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137)
that <code class="literal">nmbd</code> responds to name queries on. Don't
use this option unless you are an expert, in which case you
- won't need help!</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307989"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
+ won't need help!</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506533"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
<code class="literal">inetd</code> meta-daemon, this file
must contain suitable startup information for the
meta-daemon.
@@ -100,22 +100,22 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of
- the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server
configuration file. Other common places that systems
install this file are <code class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
and <code class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</p><p>When run as a WINS server (see the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308096"></a>wins support
- parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page),
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT">wins support</a>
+ parameter in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page),
<code class="literal">nmbd</code>
will store the WINS database in the file <code class="filename">wins.dat</code>
in the <code class="filename">var/locks</code> directory configured under
wherever Samba was configured to install itself.</p><p>If <code class="literal">nmbd</code> is acting as a <span class="emphasis"><em>
- browse master</em></span> (see the <a class="indexterm" name="id308143"></a>local master
- parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page, <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
+ browse master</em></span> (see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER">local master</a>
+ parameter in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page, <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
will store the browsing database in the file <code class="filename">browse.dat
</code> in the <code class="filename">var/locks</code> directory
configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308181"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>To shut down an <code class="literal">nmbd</code> process it is recommended
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506744"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>To shut down an <code class="literal">nmbd</code> process it is recommended
that SIGKILL (-9) <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be used, except as a last
resort, as this may leave the name database in an inconsistent state.
The correct way to terminate <code class="literal">nmbd</code> is to send it
@@ -126,21 +126,21 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
under wherever Samba was configured to install itself). This will also
cause <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to dump out its server database in
the <code class="filename">log.nmb</code> file.</p><p>The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered
- using <a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals
+ using <a class="citerefentry" href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals
are no longer used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow
transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running
- at a normally low log level.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308261"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308272"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
- <a href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the Internet
+ at a normally low log level.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553533"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553544"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the Internet
RFC's <code class="filename">rfc1001.txt</code>, <code class="filename">rfc1002.txt</code>.
In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
- as a link from the Web page <a href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
- http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308349"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ as a link from the Web page <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553623"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmblookup.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmblookup.1.html
index d4084372ad..aa64c32094 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmblookup.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/nmblookup.1.html
@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmblookup</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmblookup"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmblookup &#8212; NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
- names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> [-M] [-R] [-S] [-r] [-A] [-h] [-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;] [-U &lt;unicast address&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-i &lt;NetBIOS scope&gt;] [-T] [-f] {name}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299269"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> is used to query NetBIOS names
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>nmblookup</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="nmblookup"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>nmblookup &#8212; NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
+ names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> [-M] [-R] [-S] [-r] [-A] [-h] [-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;] [-U &lt;unicast address&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-i &lt;NetBIOS scope&gt;] [-T] [-f] {name}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507247"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> is used to query NetBIOS names
and map them to IP addresses in a network using NetBIOS over TCP/IP
queries. The options allow the name queries to be directed at a
particular IP broadcast area or to a particular machine. All queries
- are done over UDP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266732"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-M</span></dt><dd><p>Searches for a master browser by looking
+ are done over UDP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507277"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-M</span></dt><dd><p>Searches for a master browser by looking
up the NetBIOS name <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> with a
type of <code class="constant">0x1d</code>. If <em class="replaceable"><code>
name</code></em> is "-" then it does a lookup on the special name
@@ -24,11 +24,11 @@
where it ignores the source port of the requesting packet
and only replies to UDP port 137. Unfortunately, on most UNIX
systems root privilege is needed to bind to this port, and
- in addition, if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.
+ in addition, if the <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A</span></dt><dd><p>Interpret <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> as
an IP Address and do a node status query on this address.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
-to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id266847"></a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
+to setting the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
However, a command
line setting will take precedence over settings in
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
@@ -48,8 +48,8 @@ options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a sum
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Send the query to the given broadcast address. Without
this option the default behavior of nmblookup is to send the
query to the broadcast address of the network interfaces as
- either auto-detected or defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES" target="_top"><em class="parameter"><code>interfaces</code></em>
- </a> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.
+ either auto-detected or defined in the <a class="ulink" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES" target="_top"><em class="parameter"><code>interfaces</code></em>
+ </a> parameter of the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U &lt;unicast address&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Do a unicast query to the specified address or
host <em class="replaceable"><code>unicast address</code></em>. This option
(along with the <em class="parameter"><code>-R</code></em> option) is needed to
@@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id307894"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -88,17 +88,17 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
If a NetBIOS name then the different name types may be specified
by appending '#&lt;type&gt;' to the name. This name may also be
'*', which will return all registered names within a broadcast
- area.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308003"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> can be used to query
+ area.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506545"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p><code class="literal">nmblookup</code> can be used to query
a WINS server (in the same way <code class="literal">nslookup</code> is
used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server, <code class="literal">nmblookup</code>
must be called like this:</p><p><code class="literal">nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</code></p><p>For example, running :</p><p><code class="literal">nmblookup -U samba.org -R 'IRIX#1B'</code></p><p>would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain
- master browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308052"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308063"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308095"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ master browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506598"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506609"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506641"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.html
index 18c77834ed..4a3fee4dc8 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.html
@@ -1,18 +1,18 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ntlm_auth</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ntlm-auth.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ntlm_auth &#8212; tool to allow external access to Winbind's NTLM authentication function</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> [-d debuglevel] [-l logdir] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267695"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> is a helper utility that authenticates
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>ntlm_auth</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="ntlm-auth.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>ntlm_auth &#8212; tool to allow external access to Winbind's NTLM authentication function</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> [-d debuglevel] [-l logdir] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544144"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> is a helper utility that authenticates
users using NT/LM authentication. It returns 0 if the users is authenticated
successfully and 1 if access was denied. ntlm_auth uses winbind to access
the user and authentication data for a domain. This utility
is only indended to be used by other programs (currently
- <a href="http://www.squid-cache.org/" target="_top">Squid</a>
- and <a href="http://download.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/lorikeet/trunk/mod_ntlm_winbind/" target="_top">mod_ntlm_winbind</a>)
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299225"></a><h2>OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS</h2><p>
- The <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be operational
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://www.squid-cache.org/" target="_top">Squid</a>
+ and <a class="ulink" href="http://download.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/lorikeet/trunk/mod_ntlm_winbind/" target="_top">mod_ntlm_winbind</a>)
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507206"></a><h2>OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS</h2><p>
+ The <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be operational
for many of these commands to function.</p><p>Some of these commands also require access to the directory
<code class="filename">winbindd_privileged</code> in
<code class="filename">$LOCKDIR</code>. This should be done either by running
this command as root or providing group access
to the <code class="filename">winbindd_privileged</code> directory. For
- security reasons, this directory should not be world-accessable. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299266"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">--helper-protocol=PROTO</span></dt><dd><p>
+ security reasons, this directory should not be world-accessable. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507252"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">--helper-protocol=PROTO</span></dt><dd><p>
Operate as a stdio-based helper. Valid helper protocols are:
</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">squid-2.4-basic</span></dt><dd><p>
Server-side helper for use with Squid 2.4's basic (plaintext)
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@
authentication. </p><p>Requires access to the directory
<code class="filename">winbindd_privileged</code> in
<code class="filename">$LOCKDIR</code>. The protocol used is
- described here: <a href="http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html" target="_top">http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html</a>.
+ described here: <a class="ulink" href="http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html" target="_top">http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html</a>.
This protocol has been extended to allow the
NTLMSSP Negotiate packet to be included as an argument
to the <code class="literal">YR</code> command. (Thus avoiding
@@ -64,33 +64,33 @@
any data (such as usernames/passwords) that may contain malicous user data, such as
a newline. They may also need to decode strings from
the helper, which likewise may have been base64 encoded.</div><dl><dt><span class="term">Username</span></dt><dd><p>The username, expected to be in
- Samba's <a class="indexterm" name="id266937"></a>unix charset.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id266946"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 1. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Username: bob</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id266950"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Username:: Ym9i</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Username</span></dt><dd><p>The user's domain, expected to be in
- Samba's <a class="indexterm" name="id266964"></a>unix charset.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id266973"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 3. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Domain: WORKGROUP</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id266978"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 4. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Domain:: V09SS0dST1VQ</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Full-Username</span></dt><dd><p>The fully qualified username, expected to be in
- Samba's <a class="indexterm" name="id266991"></a> and qualified with the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266997"></a>winbind separator.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id267007"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Full-Username: WORKGROUP\bob</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id267011"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Full-Username:: V09SS0dST1VQYm9i</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">LANMAN-Challenge</span></dt><dd><p>The 8 byte <code class="literal">LANMAN Challenge</code> value,
+ Samba's <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXCHARSET">unix charset</a>.
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2507503"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 1. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Username: bob</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id2507508"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Username:: Ym9i</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Username</span></dt><dd><p>The user's domain, expected to be in
+ Samba's <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXCHARSET">unix charset</a>.
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506354"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 3. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Domain: WORKGROUP</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id2506359"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 4. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Domain:: V09SS0dST1VQ</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Full-Username</span></dt><dd><p>The fully qualified username, expected to be in
+ Samba's <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXCHARSET">unix charset</a> and qualified with the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR">winbind separator</a>.
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506400"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Full-Username: WORKGROUP\bob</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id2506404"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Full-Username:: V09SS0dST1VQYm9i</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">LANMAN-Challenge</span></dt><dd><p>The 8 byte <code class="literal">LANMAN Challenge</code> value,
generated randomly by the server, or (in cases such as
MSCHAPv2) generated in some way by both the server and
the client.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id307893"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 7. </b></p><div class="example-contents">LANMAN-Challege: 0102030405060708</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">LANMAN-Response</span></dt><dd><p>The 24 byte <code class="literal">LANMAN Response</code> value,
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506429"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 7. </b></p><div class="example-contents">LANMAN-Challege: 0102030405060708</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">LANMAN-Response</span></dt><dd><p>The 24 byte <code class="literal">LANMAN Response</code> value,
calculated from the user's password and the supplied
<code class="literal">LANMAN Challenge</code>. Typically, this
is provided over the network by a client wishing to authenticate.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id307922"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8. </b></p><div class="example-contents">LANMAN-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">NT-Response</span></dt><dd><p>The &gt;= 24 byte <code class="literal">NT Response</code>
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506461"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8. </b></p><div class="example-contents">LANMAN-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">NT-Response</span></dt><dd><p>The &gt;= 24 byte <code class="literal">NT Response</code>
calculated from the user's password and the supplied
<code class="literal">LANMAN Challenge</code>. Typically, this is
provided over the network by a client wishing to authenticate.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id307952"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 9. </b></p><div class="example-contents">NT-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Password</span></dt><dd><p>The user's password. This would be
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506494"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 9. </b></p><div class="example-contents">NT-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Password</span></dt><dd><p>The user's password. This would be
provided by a network client, if the helper is being
used in a legacy situation that exposes plaintext
passwords in this way.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id307970"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Password: samba2</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id307974"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Password:: c2FtYmEy</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Request-User-Session-Key</span></dt><dd><p>Apon sucessful authenticaiton, return
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506514"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Password: samba2</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p><div class="example"><a name="id2506519"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Password:: c2FtYmEy</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Request-User-Session-Key</span></dt><dd><p>Apon sucessful authenticaiton, return
the user session key associated with the login.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id307991"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Request-User-Session-Key: Yes</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Request-LanMan-Session-Key</span></dt><dd><p>Apon sucessful authenticaiton, return
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506537"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Request-User-Session-Key: Yes</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Request-LanMan-Session-Key</span></dt><dd><p>Apon sucessful authenticaiton, return
the LANMAN session key associated with the login.
- </p><div class="example"><a name="id308008"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Request-LanMan-Session-Key: Yes</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd></dl></div></dd></dl></div></dd><dt><span class="term">--username=USERNAME</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><div class="example"><a name="id2506555"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13. </b></p><div class="example-contents">Request-LanMan-Session-Key: Yes</div></div><p><br class="example-break"></p></dd></dl></div></dd></dl></div></dd><dt><span class="term">--username=USERNAME</span></dt><dd><p>
Specify username of user to authenticate
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--domain=DOMAIN</span></dt><dd><p>
Specify domain of user to authenticate
@@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id308198"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</spa
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308275"></a><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>To setup ntlm_auth for use by squid 2.5, with both basic and
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553553"></a><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>To setup ntlm_auth for use by squid 2.5, with both basic and
NTLMSSP authentication, the following
should be placed in the <code class="filename">squid.conf</code> file.
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -144,13 +144,13 @@ auth_param basic credentialsttl 2 hours
</p><pre class="programlisting">
auth_param ntlm program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-ntlmssp --require-membership-of='WORKGROUP\Domain Users'
auth_param basic program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-basic --require-membership-of='WORKGROUP\Domain Users'
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308327"></a><h2>TROUBLESHOOTING</h2><p>If you're experiencing problems with authenticating Internet Explorer running
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553614"></a><h2>TROUBLESHOOTING</h2><p>If you're experiencing problems with authenticating Internet Explorer running
under MS Windows 9X or Millenium Edition against ntlm_auth's NTLMSSP authentication
helper (--helper-protocol=squid-2.5-ntlmssp), then please read
- <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q239/8/69.ASP" target="_top">
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q239/8/69.ASP" target="_top">
the Microsoft Knowledge Base article #239869 and follow instructions described there</a>.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308346"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308356"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553636"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553647"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The ntlm_auth manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pam_winbind.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pam_winbind.7.html
index 697ecbc784..d6f554373b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pam_winbind.7.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pam_winbind.7.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pam_winbind</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pam_winbind.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pam_winbind &#8212; PAM module for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267380"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pam_winbind</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pam_winbind.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pam_winbind &#8212; PAM module for Winbind</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544112"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>
pam_winbind is a PAM module that can authenticate users against the local domain by talking to the Winbind daemon.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267683"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544135"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
pam_winbind supports several options which can either be set in
the PAM configuration files or in the pam_winbind configuration
@@ -55,7 +55,7 @@
</p></dd></dl></div><p>
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266792"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266827"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of Samba.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266837"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507366"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507401"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of Samba.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507411"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by
the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and Guenther Deschner.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pdbedit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pdbedit.8.html
index 15122a414f..688bffcb2f 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pdbedit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/pdbedit.8.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pdbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pdbedit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pdbedit &#8212; manage the SAM database (Database of Samba Users)</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">pdbedit</code> [-L] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-t, --password-from-stdin] [-m] [-r] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-b passdb-backend] [-g] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-C value] [-c account-control] [-y]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266779"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pdbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pdbedit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pdbedit &#8212; manage the SAM database (Database of Samba Users)</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">pdbedit</code> [-L] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-t, --password-from-stdin] [-m] [-r] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-b passdb-backend] [-g] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-C value] [-c account-control] [-y]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507322"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts
stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</p><p>The pdbedit tool uses the passdb modular interface and is
independent from the kind of users database used (currently there
are smbpasswd, ldap, nis+ and tdb based and more can be added
without changing the tool).</p><p>There are five main ways to use pdbedit: adding a user account,
removing a user account, modifing a user account, listing user
- accounts, importing users accounts.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266812"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>This option lists all the user accounts
+ accounts, importing users accounts.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507358"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>This option lists all the user accounts
present in the users database.
This option prints a list of user/uid pairs separated by
the ':' character.</p><p>Example: <code class="literal">pdbedit -L</code></p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
It will make pdbedit list the users in the database, printing
out the account fields in a format compatible with the
<code class="filename">smbpasswd</code> file format. (see the
- <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details)</p><p>Example: <code class="literal">pdbedit -L -w</code></p><pre class="programlisting">
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details)</p><p>Example: <code class="literal">pdbedit -L -w</code></p><pre class="programlisting">
sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:
D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:
[UX ]:LCT-00000000:
@@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:
retype new password
</pre><p>
</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>pdbedit does not call the unix password syncronisation
- script if <a class="indexterm" name="id308083"></a>unix password sync
+ script if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC">unix password sync</a>
has been set. It only updates the data in the Samba
user database.
</p><p>If you wish to add a user and synchronise the password
@@ -132,7 +132,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id308437"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -144,8 +144,8 @@ The default configuration file name is determined at
compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</span></dt><dd><p>Base directory name for log/debug files. The extension
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308501"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308512"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308522"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308546"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553769"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553780"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553791"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553814"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The pdbedit manpage was written by Simo Sorce and Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/profiles.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/profiles.1.html
index c820bcac0f..040a3e0a90 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/profiles.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/profiles.1.html
@@ -1,12 +1,12 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>profiles</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="profiles.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>profiles &#8212; A utility to report and change SIDs in registry files
- </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> [-v] [-c SID] [-n SID] {file}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267702"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> is a utility that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>profiles</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="profiles.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>profiles &#8212; A utility to report and change SIDs in registry files
+ </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> [-v] [-c SID] [-n SID] {file}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544150"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> is a utility that
reports and changes SIDs in windows registry files. It currently only
supports NT.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299219"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">file</span></dt><dd><p>Registry file to view or edit. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v,--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Increases verbosity of messages.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507197"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">file</span></dt><dd><p>Registry file to view or edit. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v,--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Increases verbosity of messages.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c SID1 -n SID2</span></dt><dd><p>Change all occurences of SID1 in <code class="filename">file</code> by SID2.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266714"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266725"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507257"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507268"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The profiles man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij. </p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/rpcclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/rpcclient.1.html
index ef9b4bc532..8fe65f145d 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/rpcclient.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/rpcclient.1.html
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>rpcclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="rpcclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>rpcclient &#8212; tool for executing client side
- MS-RPC functions</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> [-A authfile] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-h] [-l logdir] [-N] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-U username[%password]] [-W workgroup] [-N] [-I destinationIP] {server}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299254"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is a utility initially developed
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>rpcclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="rpcclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>rpcclient &#8212; tool for executing client side
+ MS-RPC functions</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> [-A authfile] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-h] [-l logdir] [-N] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-U username[%password]] [-W workgroup] [-N] [-I destinationIP] {server}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507231"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is a utility initially developed
to test MS-RPC functionality in Samba itself. It has undergone
several stages of development and stability. Many system administrators
have now written scripts around it to manage Windows NT clients from
- their UNIX workstation. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266717"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">server</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.
+ their UNIX workstation. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507262"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">server</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.
The server can be any SMB/CIFS server. The name is
- resolved using the <a class="indexterm" name="id266734"></a>name resolve order line from <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c|--command='command string'</span></dt><dd><p>execute semicolon separated commands (listed
+ resolved using the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order</a> line from <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c|--command='command string'</span></dt><dd><p>execute semicolon separated commands (listed
below)) </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I IP-address</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>IP address</code></em> is the address of the server to connect to.
It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
@@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266823"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ via the <code class="literal">ps</code> command. To be safe always allow
<code class="literal">rpcclient</code> to prompt for a password and type
it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
-to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id307888"></a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
+to setting the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
However, a command
line setting will take precedence over settings in
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
@@ -89,11 +89,11 @@ SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket op
socket. See the socket options parameter in
the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> manual page for the list of valid
options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307973"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id307979"></a><h3>LSARPC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">lsaquery</span></dt><dd><p>Query info policy</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupsids</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506521"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506526"></a><h3>LSARPC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">lsaquery</span></dt><dd><p>Query info policy</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupsids</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list
of SIDs to usernames.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupnames</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list
of usernames to SIDs.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumtrusts</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate trusted domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumprivs</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate privileges</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdispname</span></dt><dd><p>Get the privilege name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumsid</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the LSA SIDS</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumprivsaccount</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the privileges of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the rights of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctwithright</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate accounts with a right</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaaddacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Add rights to an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaremoveacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Remove rights from an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsalookupprivvalue</span></dt><dd><p>Get a privilege value given its name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query LSA security object</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308103"></a><h3>LSARPC-DS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dsroledominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Get Primary Domain Information</p></dd></dl></div><p> </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DFS</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dfsexist</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS support</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsadd</span></dt><dd><p>Add a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsremove</span></dt><dd><p>Remove a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsgetinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS share info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate dfs shares</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308172"></a><h3>REG</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">shutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Remote Shutdown</p></dd><dt><span class="term">abortshutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Abort Shutdown</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308197"></a><h3>SRVSVC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">srvinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Server query info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netshareenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate shares</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netfileenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate open files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netremotetod</span></dt><dd><p>Fetch remote time of day</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308239"></a><h3>SAMR</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">queryuser</span></dt><dd><p>Query user info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroup</span></dt><dd><p>Query group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryusergroups</span></dt><dd><p>Query user groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroupmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query group membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryaliasmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query alias membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydispinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query display info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query domain info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomusers</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain users</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumalsgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate alias groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">createdomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Create domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookupnames</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookuprids</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deletedomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Delete domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query SAMR security object</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdompwinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve domain password info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupdomain</span></dt><dd><p>Look up domain</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308385"></a><h3>SPOOLSS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">adddriver &lt;arch&gt; &lt;config&gt; [&lt;version&gt;]</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumtrusts</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate trusted domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumprivs</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate privileges</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdispname</span></dt><dd><p>Get the privilege name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumsid</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the LSA SIDS</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumprivsaccount</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the privileges of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate the rights of an SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaenumacctwithright</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate accounts with a right</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaaddacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Add rights to an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaremoveacctrights</span></dt><dd><p>Remove rights from an account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsalookupprivvalue</span></dt><dd><p>Get a privilege value given its name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lsaquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query LSA security object</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506655"></a><h3>LSARPC-DS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dsroledominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Get Primary Domain Information</p></dd></dl></div><p> </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DFS</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">dfsexist</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS support</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsadd</span></dt><dd><p>Add a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsremove</span></dt><dd><p>Remove a DFS share</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsgetinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query DFS share info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dfsenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate dfs shares</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506725"></a><h3>REG</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">shutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Remote Shutdown</p></dd><dt><span class="term">abortshutdown</span></dt><dd><p>Abort Shutdown</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506751"></a><h3>SRVSVC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">srvinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Server query info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netshareenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate shares</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netfileenum</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate open files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netremotetod</span></dt><dd><p>Fetch remote time of day</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506794"></a><h3>SAMR</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">queryuser</span></dt><dd><p>Query user info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroup</span></dt><dd><p>Query group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryusergroups</span></dt><dd><p>Query user groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querygroupmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query group membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">queryaliasmem</span></dt><dd><p>Query alias membership</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydispinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query display info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">querydominfo</span></dt><dd><p>Query domain info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomusers</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain users</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumdomgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate domain groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumalsgroups</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate alias groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">createdomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Create domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookupnames</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlookuprids</span></dt><dd><p>Look up names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deletedomuser</span></dt><dd><p>Delete domain user</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samquerysecobj</span></dt><dd><p>Query SAMR security object</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getdompwinfo</span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve domain password info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupdomain</span></dt><dd><p>Look up domain</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2553649"></a><h3>SPOOLSS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">adddriver &lt;arch&gt; &lt;config&gt; [&lt;version&gt;]</span></dt><dd><p>
Execute an AddPrinterDriver() RPC to install the printer driver
information on the server. Note that the driver files should
already exist in the directory returned by
@@ -178,11 +178,11 @@ Comma Separated list of Files
already be correctly installed on the print server. </p><p>See also the <code class="literal">enumprinters</code> and
<code class="literal">enumdrivers</code> commands for obtaining a list of
of installed printers and drivers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">addform</span></dt><dd><p>Add form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setform</span></dt><dd><p>Set form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">getform</span></dt><dd><p>Get form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deleteform</span></dt><dd><p>Delete form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">enumforms</span></dt><dd><p>Enumerate form</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setprinter</span></dt><dd><p>Set printer comment</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setprinterdata</span></dt><dd><p>Set REG_SZ printer data</p></dd><dt><span class="term">setprintername &lt;printername&gt;
- &lt;newprintername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Set printer name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">rffpcnex</span></dt><dd><p>Rffpcnex test</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308764"></a><h3>NETLOGON</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">logonctrl2</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">logonctrl</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samsync</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Synchronisation</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samdeltas</span></dt><dd><p>Query Sam Deltas</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlogon</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Logon</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id308824"></a><h3>GENERAL COMMANDS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>Set the current
+ &lt;newprintername&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Set printer name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">rffpcnex</span></dt><dd><p>Rffpcnex test</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554066"></a><h3>NETLOGON</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">logonctrl2</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">logonctrl</span></dt><dd><p>Logon Control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samsync</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Synchronisation</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samdeltas</span></dt><dd><p>Query Sam Deltas</p></dd><dt><span class="term">samlogon</span></dt><dd><p>Sam Logon</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2554127"></a><h3>GENERAL COMMANDS</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>Set the current
debug level used to log information.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">help (?)</span></dt><dd><p>Print a listing of all
known commands or extended help on a particular command.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">quit (exit)</span></dt><dd><p>Exit <code class="literal">rpcclient
- </code>.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308866"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is designed as a developer testing tool
+ </code>.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554170"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is designed as a developer testing tool
and may not be robust in certain areas (such as command line parsing).
It has been known to generate a core dump upon failures when invalid
parameters where passed to the interpreter. </p><p>From Luke Leighton's original rpcclient man page:</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING!</em></span> The MSRPC over SMB code has
@@ -192,11 +192,11 @@ Comma Separated list of Files
implementation of these services has been demonstrated (and reported)
to be... a bit flaky in places. </p><p>The development of Samba's implementation is also a bit rough,
and as more of the services are understood, it can even result in
- versions of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a> that are incompatible for some commands or services. Additionally,
+ versions of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a> that are incompatible for some commands or services. Additionally,
the developers are sending reports to Microsoft, and problems found
or reported to Microsoft are fixed in Service Packs, which may
- result in incompatibilities.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308917"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308928"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ result in incompatibilities.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554230"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554241"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original rpcclient man page was written by Matthew
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/samba.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/samba.7.html
index 67de3c40fb..aee6b312dc 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/samba.7.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/samba.7.html
@@ -1,78 +1,78 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="samba.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>samba &#8212; A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">samba</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267383"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="samba.7"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>samba &#8212; A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">samba</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544116"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs
that implements the Server Message Block (commonly abbreviated
as SMB) protocol for UNIX systems. This protocol is sometimes
also referred to as the Common Internet File System (CIFS). For a
- more thorough description, see <a href="http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ more thorough description, see <a class="ulink" href="http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/" target="_top">
http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/</a>. Samba also implements the NetBIOS
- protocol in nmbd.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbd</code> daemon provides the file and print services to
+ protocol in nmbd.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbd</code> daemon provides the file and print services to
SMB clients, such as Windows 95/98, Windows NT, Windows
for Workgroups or LanManager. The configuration file
- for this daemon is described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
+ for this daemon is described in <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
daemon provides NetBIOS nameservice and browsing
support. The configuration file for this daemon
- is described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbclient</code>
+ is described in <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbclient</code>
program implements a simple ftp-like client. This
is useful for accessing SMB shares on other compatible
servers (such as Windows NT), and can also be used
to allow a UNIX box to print to a printer attached to
- any SMB server (such as a PC running Windows NT).</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">testparm</code>
- utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">testprns</code>
+ any SMB server (such as a PC running Windows NT).</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">testparm</code>
+ utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">testprns</code>
utility supports testing printer names defined
in your <code class="filename">printcap</code> file used
- by Samba.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbstatus.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbstatus</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbstatus</code>
+ by Samba.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbstatus.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbstatus</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbstatus</code>
tool provides access to information about the
- current connections to <code class="literal">smbd</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">nmblookup</code>
+ current connections to <code class="literal">smbd</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">nmblookup</code>
tools allows NetBIOS name queries to be made
- from a UNIX host.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code>
+ from a UNIX host.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code>
command is a tool for changing LanMan and Windows NT
- password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcacls.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcacls</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> command is
- a tool to set ACL's on remote CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbsh.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbsh</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbsh</code> command is
+ password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbcacls.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcacls</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> command is
+ a tool to set ACL's on remote CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbsh.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbsh</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbsh</code> command is
a program that allows you to run a unix shell with
- with an overloaded VFS.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtree.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtree</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbtree</code> command
- is a text-based network neighborhood tool.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbtar.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtar</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbtar</code> can make
- backups of data on CIFS/SMB servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbspool.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbspool</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> is a
+ with an overloaded VFS.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbtree.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtree</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbtree</code> command
+ is a text-based network neighborhood tool.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbtar.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbtar</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">smbtar</code> can make
+ backups of data on CIFS/SMB servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbspool.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbspool</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> is a
helper utility for printing on printers connected
- to CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> is a utility
+ to CIFS servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> is a utility
that can change the behaviour of running samba daemons.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is a utility
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="rpcclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">rpcclient</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">rpcclient</code> is a utility
that can be used to execute RPC commands on remote
- CIFS servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="pdbedit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">pdbedit</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">pdbedit</code> command
+ CIFS servers.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="pdbedit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">pdbedit</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">pdbedit</code> command
can be used to maintain the local user database on
- a samba server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">findsmb</code> command
+ a samba server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="findsmb.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">findsmb</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">findsmb</code> command
can be used to find SMB servers on the local network.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">net</code> command
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">net</code> command
is supposed to work similar to the DOS/Windows
- NET.EXE command.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">swat</code> is a web-based
+ NET.EXE command.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">swat</code> is a web-based
interface to configuring <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> is a daemon
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> is a daemon
that is used for integrating authentication and
- the user database into unix.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> is a utility
+ the user database into unix.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> is a utility
that retrieves and stores information related to winbind.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="profiles.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">profiles</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> is a command-line
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="profiles.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">profiles</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">profiles</code> is a command-line
utility that can be used to replace all occurences of
a certain SID with another SID.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="log2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">log2pcap</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> is a utility
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="log2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">log2pcap</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">log2pcap</code> is a utility
for generating pcap trace files from Samba log
- files.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfstest.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfstest</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> is a utility
- that can be used to test vfs modules.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> is a helper-utility
+ files.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="vfstest.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfstest</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> is a utility
+ that can be used to test vfs modules.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> is a helper-utility
for external programs wanting to do NTLM-authentication.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">
-<a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>,
-<a href="smbumount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbumount</span>(8)</span></a>,
-<a href="smbmnt.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmnt</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbmount</code>,<code class="literal">smbumount</code> and <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> are commands that can be used to
+<a class="citerefentry" href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>,
+<a class="citerefentry" href="smbumount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbumount</span>(8)</span></a>,
+<a class="citerefentry" href="smbmnt.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmnt</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbmount</code>,<code class="literal">smbumount</code> and <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> are commands that can be used to
mount CIFS/SMB shares on Linux.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbcquotas.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcquotas</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> is a tool that
- can set remote QUOTA's on server with NTFS 5. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308170"></a><h2>COMPONENTS</h2><p>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smbcquotas.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcquotas</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> is a tool that
+ can set remote QUOTA's on server with NTFS 5. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506576"></a><h2>COMPONENTS</h2><p>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each
component is described in a separate manual page. It is strongly
recommended that you read the documentation that comes with Samba
and the manual pages of those components that you use. If the
manual pages and documents aren't clear enough then please visit
- <a href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org</a>
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org</a>
for information on how to file a bug report or submit a patch.</p><p>If you require help, visit the Samba webpage at
- <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> and
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> and
explore the many option available to you.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308199"></a><h2>AVAILABILITY</h2><p>The Samba software suite is licensed under the
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506610"></a><h2>AVAILABILITY</h2><p>The Samba software suite is licensed under the
GNU Public License(GPL). A copy of that license should
have come with the package in the file COPYING. You are
encouraged to distribute copies of the Samba suite, but
@@ -80,33 +80,33 @@
obtained via anonymous ftp from samba.org in the
directory pub/samba/. It is also available on several
mirror sites worldwide.</p><p>You may also find useful information about Samba
- on the newsgroup <a href="news:comp.protocols.smb" target="_top">
+ on the newsgroup <a class="ulink" href="news:comp.protocols.smb" target="_top">
comp.protocol.smb</a> and the Samba mailing
list. Details on how to join the mailing list are given in
the README file that comes with Samba.</p><p>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Mozilla
or Konqueror) then you will also find lots of useful information,
including back issues of the Samba mailing list, at
- <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308237"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the
- Samba suite. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308247"></a><h2>CONTRIBUTIONS</h2><p>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project,
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506656"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the
+ Samba suite. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506667"></a><h2>CONTRIBUTIONS</h2><p>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project,
then I suggest you join the Samba mailing list at
- <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>.
</p><p>If you have patches to submit, visit
- <a href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org/</a>
+ <a class="ulink" href="http://devel.samba.org/" target="_top">http://devel.samba.org/</a>
for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches
- in <code class="literal">diff -u</code> format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308280"></a><h2>CONTRIBUTORS</h2><p>Contributors to the project are now too numerous
+ in <code class="literal">diff -u</code> format.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506703"></a><h2>CONTRIBUTORS</h2><p>Contributors to the project are now too numerous
to mention here but all deserve the thanks of all Samba
users. To see a full list, look at the
<code class="filename">change-log</code> in the source package
- for the pre-CVS changes and at <a href="http://cvs.samba.org/" target="_top">
+ for the pre-CVS changes and at <a class="ulink" href="http://cvs.samba.org/" target="_top">
http://cvs.samba.org/</a>
for the contributors to Samba post-CVS. CVS is the Open Source
source code control system used by the Samba Team to develop
- Samba. The project would have been unmanageable without it.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308305"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ Samba. The project would have been unmanageable without it.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506732"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smb.conf.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smb.conf.5.html
index bd1675c385..929328eab2 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smb.conf.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smb.conf.5.html
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smb.conf</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smb.conf.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smb.conf &#8212; The configuration file for the Samba suite</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267380"></a><h2>SYNOPSIS</h2><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smb.conf</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smb.conf.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smb.conf &#8212; The configuration file for the Samba suite</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544106"></a><h2>SYNOPSIS</h2><p>
The <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file is a configuration file for the Samba suite. <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> contains runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file is designed to be configured and administered by the
- <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> program. The
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> program. The
complete description of the file format and possible parameters held within are here for reference purposes.
</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="FILEFORMATSECT"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>
The file consists of sections and parameters. A section begins with the name of the section in square brackets
@@ -26,7 +26,7 @@
The values following the equals sign in parameters are all either a string (no quotes needed) or a boolean,
which may be given as yes/no, 0/1 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean values, but is preserved
in string values. Some items such as create masks are numeric.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299256"></a><h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507245"></a><h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2><p>
Each section in the configuration file (except for the [global] section) describes a shared resource (known as
a &#8220;<span class="quote">share</span>&#8221;). The section name is the name of the shared resource and the parameters within the
section define the shares attributes.
@@ -55,8 +55,8 @@
The following sample section defines a file space share. The user has write access to the path <code class="filename">/home/bar</code>. The share is accessed via the share name <code class="literal">foo</code>:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[foo]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266776"></a>path = /home/bar
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266783"></a>read only = no
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /home/bar</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only = no</a>
</pre><p>
</p><p>
The following sample section defines a printable share. The share is read-only, but printable. That is,
@@ -64,12 +64,12 @@
ok</em></span> parameter means access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[aprinter]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266810"></a>path = /usr/spool/public
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266818"></a>read only = yes
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266825"></a>printable = yes
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266832"></a>guest ok = yes
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /usr/spool/public</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only = yes</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTABLE">printable = yes</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok = yes</a>
</pre><p>
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266842"></a><h2>SPECIAL SECTIONS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id266848"></a><h3>The [global] section</h3><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506263"></a><h2>SPECIAL SECTIONS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506269"></a><h3>The [global] section</h3><p>
Parameters in this section apply to the server as a whole, or are defaults for sections that do not
specifically define certain items. See the notes under PARAMETERS for more information.
</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="HOMESECT"></a><h3>The [homes] section</h3><p>
@@ -105,7 +105,7 @@
than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes] section:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[homes]</code></em>
-<a class="indexterm" name="id266965"></a>read only = no
+<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only = no</a>
</pre><p>
</p><p>
An important point is that if guest access is specified in the [homes] section, all home directories will be
@@ -137,9 +137,9 @@
it. A typical [printers] entry looks like this:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[printers]</code></em>
-<a class="indexterm" name="id307925"></a>path = /usr/spool/public
-<a class="indexterm" name="id307932"></a>guest ok = yes
-<a class="indexterm" name="id307939"></a>printable = yes
+<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /usr/spool/public</a>
+<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok = yes</a>
+<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTABLE">printable = yes</a>
</pre><p>
</p><p>
All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned.
@@ -160,7 +160,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias...
On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what printers are defined on the system you may be able to use
<code class="literal">printcap name = lpstat</code> to automatically obtain a list of printers. See the
<code class="literal">printcap name</code> option for more details.
- </p></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307997"></a><h2>USERSHARES</h2><p>Starting with Samba version 3.0.23 the capability for non-root users to add, modify, and delete
+ </p></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506592"></a><h2>USERSHARES</h2><p>Starting with Samba version 3.0.23 the capability for non-root users to add, modify, and delete
their own share definitions has been added. This capability is called <span class="emphasis"><em>usershares</em></span> and
is controlled by a set of parameters in the [global] section of the smb.conf.
The relevant parameters are :
@@ -178,13 +178,13 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</pre><p>Then add the parameters
</p><pre class="programlisting">
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308127"></a>usershare path = /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308134"></a>usershare max shares = 10 # (or the desired number of shares)
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USERSHAREPATH">usershare path = /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USERSHAREMAXSHARES">usershare max shares = 10</a> # (or the desired number of shares)
</pre><p>
to the global
section of your <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>. Members of the group foo may then manipulate the user defined shares
- using the following commands.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">net usershare add sharename path [comment] [acl] [guest_ok=[y|n]]</span></dt><dd><p>To create or modify (overwrite) a user defined share.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare delete sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To delete a user defined share.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare list wildcard-sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To list user defined shares.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare info wildcard-sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To print information about user defined shares.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308201"></a><h2>PARAMETERS</h2><p>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</p><p>
+ using the following commands.</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">net usershare add sharename path [comment] [acl] [guest_ok=[y|n]]</span></dt><dd><p>To create or modify (overwrite) a user defined share.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare delete sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To delete a user defined share.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare list wildcard-sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To list user defined shares.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">net usershare info wildcard-sharename</span></dt><dd><p>To print information about user defined shares.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553528"></a><h2>PARAMETERS</h2><p>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</p><p>
Some parameters are specific to the [global] section (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span>). Some parameters
are usable in all sections (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>create mask</em></span>). All others are permissible only in normal
sections. For the purposes of the following descriptions the [homes] and [printers] sections will be
@@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
Parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may not create best bedfellows, but at least you can
find them! Where there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer to the preferred
synonym.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308242"></a><h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553576"></a><h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2><p>
Many of the strings that are settable in the config file can take substitutions. For example the option
&#8220;<span class="quote">path = /tmp/%u</span>&#8221; is interpreted as &#8220;<span class="quote">path = /tmp/john</span>&#8221; if the user connected with the
username john.
@@ -214,14 +214,19 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%M</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet name of the client machine.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%R</span></dt><dd><p>the selected protocol level after protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS,
LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%d</span></dt><dd><p>the process id of the current server
- process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%a</span></dt><dd><p>the architecture of the remote
- machine. It currently recognizes Samba (<code class="constant">Samba</code>),
- the Linux CIFS file system (<code class="constant">CIFSFS</code>), OS/2, (<code class="constant">OS2</code>),
- Windows for Workgroups (<code class="constant">WfWg</code>), Windows 9x/ME
- (<code class="constant">Win95</code>), Windows NT (<code class="constant">WinNT</code>),
- Windows 2000 (<code class="constant">Win2K</code>), Windows XP (<code class="constant">WinXP</code>),
- and Windows 2003 (<code class="constant">Win2K3</code>). Anything else will be known as
- <code class="constant">UNKNOWN</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%I</span></dt><dd><p>the IP address of the client machine.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%i</span></dt><dd><p>the local IP address to which a client connected.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%T</span></dt><dd><p>the current date and time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%D</span></dt><dd><p>name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%w</span></dt><dd><p>the winbind separator.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%$(<em class="replaceable"><code>envvar</code></em>)</span></dt><dd><p>the value of the environment variable
+ process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%a</span></dt><dd><p>
+ The architecture of the remote
+ machine. It currently recognizes Samba (<code class="constant">Samba</code>),
+ the Linux CIFS file system (<code class="constant">CIFSFS</code>), OS/2, (<code class="constant">OS2</code>),
+ Windows for Workgroups (<code class="constant">WfWg</code>), Windows 9x/ME
+ (<code class="constant">Win95</code>), Windows NT (<code class="constant">WinNT</code>),
+ Windows 2000 (<code class="constant">Win2K</code>),
+ Windows XP (<code class="constant">WinXP</code>),
+ Windows XP 64-bit(<code class="constant">WinXP64</code>),
+ Windows 2003 including
+ 2003R2 (<code class="constant">Win2K3</code>), and Windows
+ Vista (<code class="constant">Vista</code>). Anything else will be known as
+ <code class="constant">UNKNOWN</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%I</span></dt><dd><p>the IP address of the client machine.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%i</span></dt><dd><p>the local IP address to which a client connected.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%T</span></dt><dd><p>the current date and time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%D</span></dt><dd><p>name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%w</span></dt><dd><p>the winbind separator.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%$(<em class="replaceable"><code>envvar</code></em>)</span></dt><dd><p>the value of the environment variable
<em class="replaceable"><code>envar</code></em>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>
The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options (only those that are
used when a connection has been established):
@@ -253,8 +258,8 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">default case = upper/lower</span></dt><dd><p>
controls what the default case is for new filenames (ie. files that don't currently exist in the filesystem).
Default <span class="emphasis"><em>lower</em></span>. IMPORTANT NOTE: This option will be used to modify the case of
- <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> incoming client filenames, not just new filenames if the options <a class="indexterm" name="id308683"></a>case sensitive = yes, <a class="indexterm" name="id308690"></a>preserve case = No,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308697"></a>short preserve case = No are set. This change is needed as part of the
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> incoming client filenames, not just new filenames if the options <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive = yes</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRESERVECASE">preserve case = No</a>,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SHORTPRESERVECASE">short preserve case = No</a> are set. This change is needed as part of the
optimisations for directories containing large numbers of files.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>
controls whether new files (ie. files that don't currently exist in the filesystem) are created with the case
@@ -300,59 +305,74 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</p></li><li><p>
If the service is a guest service, a connection is made as the username given in the <code class="literal">guest account
=</code> for the service, irrespective of the supplied password.
- </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308893"></a><h2>REGISTRY-BASED CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
+ </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554319"></a><h2>REGISTRY-BASED CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
Starting with Samba version 3.2.0, the capability to
store Samba configuration in the registry is available.
+ The configuration is stored in the registry key
+ <span class="emphasis"><em><code class="literal">HKLM\Software\Samba\smbconf</code></em></span>.
There are two levels of registry configuration:
</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Share definitions stored in registry are used.
This is triggered by setting the global
- parameter <em class="parameter"><code>registry shares</code></em> to &#8220;<span class="quote">yes</span>&#8221;
- in <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>.
- </p><p>Note: Shares defined in <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>
- always take priority over
- shares of the same name defined in registry.
- </p></li><li><p>Global <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span> options stored in
- registry are used. This is triggered by the
- parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id308946"></a>config backend = registry in
- the [global] section of <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>.
- This removes everything that has been read from config files
+ parameter <em class="parameter"><code>registry shares</code></em>
+ to &#8220;<span class="quote">yes</span>&#8221; in <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>.
+ </p><p>The registry shares are loaded not at startup but
+ on demand at runtime by <span class="emphasis"><em>smbd</em></span>.
+ Shares defined in <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span> take
+ priority over shares of the same name defined in
+ registry.</p></li><li><p>Global <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>
+ options stored in registry are used. This can be activated
+ in two different ways:</p><p>Firstly, a registry only configuration is triggered
+ by setting
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CONFIGBACKEND">config backend = registry</a>
+ in the [global] section of <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>.
+ This resets everything that has been read from config files
to this point and reads the content of the global configuration
section from the registry.
- Activation of global registry options automatically
- activates registry shares. In this case, no share definitions
- from smb.conf are read: This is a registry only configuration
- with the advantage that share definitions are not read
- in a bulk at startup time but on demand when a share is
- accessed.
- </p></li></ol></div><p>
- Caveat: To make registry-based configurations foolproof at least to a
- certain extent, the use
- of <em class="parameter"><code>lock directory</code></em>,
- <em class="parameter"><code>config backend</code></em>, and
- <em class="parameter"><code>include</code></em> inside the registry
- configuration has been disabled. Especially, by changing the
+ This is the recommended method of using registry based
+ configuration.</p><p>Secondly, a mixed configuration can be activated
+ by a special new meaning of the parameter
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INCLUDE">include = registry</a>
+ in the [global] section of <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>.
+ This reads the global options from registry with the same
+ priorities as for an include of a text file.
+ This may be especially useful in cases where an initial
+ configuration is needed to access the registry.</p><p>Activation of global registry options automatically
+ activates registry shares. So in the registry only case,
+ shares are loaded on demand only.</p></li></ol></div><p>
+ Note: To make registry-based configurations foolproof
+ at least to a certain extent, the use
+ of <em class="parameter"><code>lock directory</code></em> and
+ <em class="parameter"><code>config backend</code></em>
+ inside the registry configuration has been disabled:
+ Especially by changing the
<em class="parameter"><code>lock directory</code></em> inside the registry
configuration, one would create a broken setup where the daemons
do not see the configuration they loaded once it is active.
</p><p>
The registry configuration can be accessed with
- tools like <span class="emphasis"><em>regedit</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>net rpc
+ tools like <span class="emphasis"><em>regedit</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>net (rpc)
registry</em></span> in the key
- <span class="emphasis"><em>HKLM\Software\Samba\smbconf</em></span>.
+ <span class="emphasis"><em><code class="literal">HKLM\Software\Samba\smbconf</code></em></span>.
More conveniently, the <span class="emphasis"><em>conf</em></span> subcommand of the
- <a href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a> utility
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a> utility
offers a dedicated interface to read and write the
registry based configuration locally, i.e. directly
accessing the database file, circumventing the
server.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id309022"></a><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a name="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>abort shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This a full path name to a script called by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that
- should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <a class="indexterm" name="id309062"></a>shutdown script.</p><p>If the connected user posseses the <code class="constant">SeRemoteShutdownPrivilege</code>,
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554512"></a><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2554525"></a>
+
+abort shutdown script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2554526"></a><a name="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This a full path name to a script called by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that
+ should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT">shutdown script</a>.</p><p>If the connected user posseses the <code class="constant">SeRemoteShutdownPrivilege</code>,
right, this command will be run as user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>abort shutdown script</code></em> = <code class="literal">""</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>abort shutdown script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/sbin/shutdown -c</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLCHECKPERMISSIONS"></a>acl check permissions (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls what <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>does on receiving a protocol request of "open for delete"
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2554614"></a>
+
+acl check permissions (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2554615"></a><a name="ACLCHECKPERMISSIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls what <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>does on receiving a protocol request of "open for delete"
from a Windows client. If a Windows client doesn't have permissions to delete a file then they
expect this to be denied at open time. POSIX systems normally only detect restrictions on delete by
actually attempting to delete the file or directory. As Windows clients can (and do) "back out" a
@@ -372,7 +392,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
with slightly different semantics was introduced in 3.0.20. That older version is not documented here.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>acl check permissions</code></em> = <code class="literal">True</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLCOMPATIBILITY"></a>acl compatibility (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies what OS ACL semantics should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2506118"></a>
+
+acl compatibility (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2506119"></a><a name="ACLCOMPATIBILITY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies what OS ACL semantics should
be compatible with. Possible values are <span class="emphasis"><em>winnt</em></span> for Windows NT 4,
<span class="emphasis"><em>win2k</em></span> for Windows 2000 and above and <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>.
If you specify <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, the value for this parameter
@@ -381,7 +404,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>acl compatibility</code></em> = <code class="literal">win2k</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLGROUPCONTROL"></a>acl group control (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2506195"></a>
+
+acl group control (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2506196"></a><a name="ACLGROUPCONTROL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
In a POSIX filesystem, only the owner of a file or directory and the superuser can modify the permissions
and ACLs on a file. If this parameter is set, then Samba overrides this restriction, and also allows the
<span class="emphasis"><em>primary group owner</em></span> of a file or directory to modify the permissions and ACLs
@@ -394,11 +420,11 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
or directory, easing managability.
</p><p>
This parameter allows Samba to also permit delegation of the control over a point in the exported
- directory hierarchy in much the same was as Windows. This allows all members of a UNIX group to
+ directory hierarchy in much the same way as Windows. This allows all members of a UNIX group to
control the permissions on a file or directory they have group ownership on.
</p><p>
- This parameter is best used with the <a class="indexterm" name="id309290"></a>inherit owner option and also
- on on a share containing directories with the UNIX <span class="emphasis"><em>setgid bit</em></span> bit set
+ This parameter is best used with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INHERITOWNER">inherit owner</a> option and also
+ on on a share containing directories with the UNIX <span class="emphasis"><em>setgid bit</em></span> set
on them, which causes new files and directories created within it to inherit the group
ownership from the containing directory.
</p><p>
@@ -406,16 +432,22 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
implemented by the <em class="parameter"><code>dos filemode</code></em> option.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>acl group control</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLMAPFULLCONTROL"></a>acl map full control (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>maps a POSIX ACE entry of "rwx" (read/write/execute), the maximum
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555014"></a>
+
+acl map full control (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555015"></a><a name="ACLMAPFULLCONTROL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This boolean parameter controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>maps a POSIX ACE entry of "rwx" (read/write/execute), the maximum
allowed POSIX permission set, into a Windows ACL of "FULL CONTROL". If this parameter is set to true any POSIX
ACE entry of "rwx" will be returned in a Windows ACL as "FULL CONTROL", is this parameter is set to false any
POSIX ACE entry of "rwx" will be returned as the specific Windows ACL bits representing read, write and
execute.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>acl map full control</code></em> = <code class="literal">True</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a new group is requested. It
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555070"></a>
+
+add group script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555071"></a><a name="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a new group is requested. It
will expand any <em class="parameter"><code>%g</code></em> to the group name passed. This script is only useful
for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools. The script is free to create a group with
an arbitrary name to circumvent unix group name restrictions. In that case the script must print the numeric
@@ -424,28 +456,36 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add group script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/sbin/groupadd %g</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDMACHINESCRIPT"></a>add machine script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555152"></a>
+
+add machine script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555153"></a><a name="ADDMACHINESCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is the full pathname to a script that will be run by
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a machine is
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a machine is
added to Samba's domain and a Unix account matching the machine's name appended with a "$" does not
already exist.
- </p><p>This option is very similar to the <a class="indexterm" name="id309488"></a>add user script, and likewise uses the %u
+ </p><p>This option is very similar to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDUSERSCRIPT">add user script</a>, and likewise uses the %u
substitution for the account name. Do not use the %m
substitution. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add machine script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add machine script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/sbin/adduser -n -g machines -c Machine -d /var/lib/nobody -s /bin/false %u</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDPORTCOMMAND"></a>add port command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Samba 3.0.23 introduces support for adding printer ports
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555239"></a>
+
+add port command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555240"></a><a name="ADDPORTCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Samba 3.0.23 introduced support for adding printer ports
remotely using the Windows "Add Standard TCP/IP Port Wizard".
This option defines an external program to be executed when
smbd receives a request to add a new Port to the system.
- he script is passed two parameters:
- </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>port name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>device URI</code></em></p></li></ul></div><p>The deviceURI is in the for of socket://&lt;hostname&gt;[:&lt;portnumber&gt;]
+ The script is passed two parameters:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>port name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>device URI</code></em></p></li></ul></div><p>The deviceURI is in the for of socket://&lt;hostname&gt;[:&lt;portnumber&gt;]
or lpd://&lt;hostname&gt;/&lt;queuename&gt;.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add port command</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add port command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/etc/samba/scripts/addport.sh</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"></a>add printer command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555330"></a>
+
+add printer command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555331"></a><a name="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing
support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add
Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the
"Printers..." folder displayed a share listing. The APW
@@ -456,7 +496,7 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
will perform the necessary operations for adding the printer
to the print system and to add the appropriate service definition
to the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file in order that it can be
- shared by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>addprinter command</code></em> is
+ shared by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>addprinter command</code></em> is
automatically invoked with the following parameter (in
order):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>printer name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>share name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>port name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>driver name</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>location</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Windows 9x driver location</code></em></p></li></ul></div><p>All parameters are filled in from the PRINTER_INFO_2 structure sent
by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception. The "Windows 9x
@@ -474,7 +514,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add printer command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/addprinter</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDSHARECOMMAND"></a>add share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555528"></a>
+
+add share command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555530"></a><a name="ADDSHARECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server
Manager. The <em class="parameter"><code>add share command</code></em> is used to define an external program
or script which will add a new service definition to <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>. In order
@@ -496,14 +539,17 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
Number of maximum simultaneous connections to this
share.
</p></li></ul></div><p>
- This parameter is only used for add file shares. To add printer shares, see the <a class="indexterm" name="id309946"></a>addprinter command.
+ This parameter is only used for add file shares. To add printer shares, see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND">addprinter command</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add share command</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add share command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/bin/addshare</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDUSERSCRIPT"></a>add user script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555732"></a>
+
+add user script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555733"></a><a name="ADDUSERSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
under special circumstances described below.
</p><p>
Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are created for all users accessing
@@ -512,17 +558,17 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows smbd to create the required UNIX users
<span class="emphasis"><em>ON DEMAND</em></span> when a user accesses the Samba server.
</p><p>
- In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be set to
- <a class="indexterm" name="id310044"></a>security = share and <a class="indexterm" name="id310052"></a>add user script
+ In order to use this option, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be set to
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = share</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDUSERSCRIPT">add user script</a>
must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX user given one argument of
<em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em>, which expands into the UNIX user name to create.
</p><p>
When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, at login (session setup in
- the SMB protocol) time, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts the <a class="indexterm" name="id310078"></a>password server
+ the SMB protocol) time, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER">password server</a>
and attempts to authenticate the given user with the given password. If the authentication
succeeds then <code class="literal">smbd</code> attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX
password database to map the Windows user into. If this lookup fails, and
- <a class="indexterm" name="id310093"></a>add user script is set then <code class="literal">smbd</code> will
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDUSERSCRIPT">add user script</a> is set then <code class="literal">smbd</code> will
call the specified script <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>, expanding any
<em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em> argument to be the user name to create.
</p><p>
@@ -530,15 +576,18 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
continue on as though the UNIX user already existed. In this way, UNIX users are dynamically created to
match existing Windows NT accounts.
</p><p>
- See also <a class="indexterm" name="id310130"></a>security, <a class="indexterm" name="id310137"></a>password server,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id310144"></a>delete user script.
+ See also <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER">password server</a>,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEUSERSCRIPT">delete user script</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add user script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add user script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/bin/add_user %u</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add user to group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2555977"></a>
+
+add user to group script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2555978"></a><a name="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Full path to the script that will be called when a user is added to a group using the Windows NT domain administration
- tools. It will be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ tools. It will be run by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
<span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>. Any <em class="parameter"><code>%g</code></em> will be replaced with the group name and
any <em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em> will be replaced with the user name.
</p><p>
@@ -548,23 +597,42 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>add user to group script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/sbin/adduser %u %g</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADMINUSERS"></a>admin users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users who will be granted
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556071"></a>
+
+administrative share (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556072"></a><a name="ADMINISTRATIVESHARE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is set to <code class="constant">yes</code> for
+ a share, then the share will be an administrative share. The Administrative
+ Shares are the default network shares created by all Windows NT-based
+ operating systems. These are shares like C$, D$ or ADMIN$. The type of these
+ shares is STYPE_DISKTREE_HIDDEN.</p><p>See the section below on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a> for more
+ information about this option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>administrative share</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556138"></a>
+
+admin users (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556139"></a><a name="ADMINUSERS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users who will be granted
administrative privileges on the share. This means that they
will do all file operations as the super-user (root).</p><p>You should use this option very carefully, as any user in
this list will be able to do anything they like on the share,
- irrespective of file permissions.</p><p>This parameter will not work with the <a class="indexterm" name="id310304"></a>security = share in
+ irrespective of file permissions.</p><p>This parameter will not work with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = share</a> in
Samba 3.0. This is by design.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>admin users</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>admin users</code></em> = <code class="literal">jason</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AFSSHARE"></a>afs share (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether special AFS features are enabled
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556218"></a>
+
+afs share (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556219"></a><a name="AFSSHARE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether special AFS features are enabled
for this share. If enabled, it assumes that the directory exported via
the <em class="parameter"><code>path</code></em> parameter is a local AFS import. The
special AFS features include the attempt to hand-craft an AFS token
if you enabled --with-fake-kaserver in configure.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>afs share</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AFSUSERNAMEMAP"></a>afs username map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If you are using the fake kaserver AFS feature, you might
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556268"></a>
+
+afs username map (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556270"></a><a name="AFSUSERNAMEMAP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If you are using the fake kaserver AFS feature, you might
want to hand-craft the usernames you are creating tokens for.
For example this is necessary if you have users from several domain
in your AFS Protection Database. One possible scheme to code users
@@ -574,39 +642,38 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>afs username map</code></em> = <code class="literal">%u@afs.samba.org</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AIOREADSIZE"></a>aio read size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If Samba has been built with asynchronous I/O support and this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556336"></a>
+
+aio read size (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556337"></a><a name="AIOREADSIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If Samba has been built with asynchronous I/O support and this
integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
Samba will read from file asynchronously when size of request is bigger
than this value. Note that it happens only for non-chained and non-chaining
reads and when not using write cache.</p><p>Current implementation of asynchronous I/O in Samba 3.0 does support
- only up to 10 outstanding asynchronous requests, read and write combined.</p>
-
- write cache size
- aio write size
-
-<p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio read size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
+ only up to 10 outstanding asynchronous requests, read and write combined.</p><p>Related command: <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITECACHESIZE">write cache size</a></p><p>Related command: <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#AIOWRITESIZE">aio write size</a></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio read size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio read size</code></em> = <code class="literal">16384
# Use asynchronous I/O for reads bigger than 16KB
request size</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AIOWRITESIZE"></a>aio write size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If Samba has been built with asynchronous I/O support and this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556436"></a>
+
+aio write size (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556437"></a><a name="AIOWRITESIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If Samba has been built with asynchronous I/O support and this
integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
Samba will write to file asynchronously when size of request is bigger
than this value. Note that it happens only for non-chained and non-chaining
reads and when not using write cache.</p><p>Current implementation of asynchronous I/O in Samba 3.0 does support
- only up to 10 outstanding asynchronous requests, read and write combined.</p>
-
- write cache size
- aio read size
-
-<p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio write size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
+ only up to 10 outstanding asynchronous requests, read and write combined.</p><p>Related command: <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITECACHESIZE">write cache size</a></p><p>Related command: <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#AIOREADSIZE">aio read size</a></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio write size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>aio write size</code></em> = <code class="literal">16384
# Use asynchronous I/O for writes bigger than 16KB
request size</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"></a>algorithmic rid base (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This determines how Samba will use its
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556533"></a>
+
+algorithmic rid base (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556534"></a><a name="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This determines how Samba will use its
algorithmic mapping from uids/gid to the RIDs needed to construct
NT Security Identifiers.
</p><p>Setting this option to a larger value could be useful to sites
@@ -621,7 +688,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>algorithmic rid base</code></em> = <code class="literal">100000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALLOCATIONROUNDUPSIZE"></a>allocation roundup size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows an administrator to tune the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556610"></a>
+
+allocation roundup size (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556611"></a><a name="ALLOCATIONROUNDUPSIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows an administrator to tune the
allocation size reported to Windows clients. The default
size of 1Mb generally results in improved Windows client
performance. However, rounding the allocation size may cause
@@ -633,8 +703,11 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>allocation roundup size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0
# (to disable roundups)</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"></a>allow trusted domains (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This option only takes effect when the <a class="indexterm" name="id310731"></a>security option is set to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556681"></a>
+
+allow trusted domains (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556682"></a><a name="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This option only takes effect when the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a> option is set to
<code class="constant">server</code>, <code class="constant">domain</code> or <code class="constant">ads</code>.
If it is set to no, then attempts to connect to a resource from
a domain or workgroup other than the one which smbd is running
@@ -648,7 +721,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
Samba server even if they do not have an account in DOMA. This
can make implementing a security boundary difficult.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>allow trusted domains</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ANNOUNCEAS"></a>announce as (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies what type of server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556759"></a>
+
+announce as (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556760"></a><a name="ANNOUNCEAS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies what type of server <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse
list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options
are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"),
"NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server,
@@ -660,16 +736,22 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>announce as</code></em> = <code class="literal">Win95</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ANNOUNCEVERSION"></a>announce version (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies the major and minor version numbers
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556834"></a>
+
+announce version (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556835"></a><a name="ANNOUNCEVERSION"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies the major and minor version numbers
that nmbd will use when announcing itself as a server. The default
is 4.9. Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific
need to set a Samba server to be a downlevel server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>announce version</code></em> = <code class="literal">4.9</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>announce version</code></em> = <code class="literal">2.0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AUTHMETHODS"></a>auth methods (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2556896"></a>
+
+auth methods (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2556897"></a><a name="AUTHMETHODS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option allows the administrator to chose what authentication methods <code class="literal">smbd</code>
- will use when authenticating a user. This option defaults to sensible values based on <a class="indexterm" name="id310928"></a>security.
+ will use when authenticating a user. This option defaults to sensible values based on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a>.
This should be considered a developer option and used only in rare circumstances. In the majority (if not all)
of production servers, the default setting should be adequate.
</p><p>
@@ -688,43 +770,49 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>auth methods</code></em> = <code class="literal">guest sam winbind</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AVAILABLE"></a>available (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557012"></a>
+
+available (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557013"></a><a name="AVAILABLE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If
<em class="parameter"><code>available = no</code></em>, then <span class="emphasis"><em>ALL</em></span>
attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are
logged.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>available</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BINDINTERFACESONLY"></a>bind interfaces only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This global parameter allows the Samba admin
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557064"></a>
+
+bind interfaces only (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557065"></a><a name="BINDINTERFACESONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This global parameter allows the Samba admin
to limit what interfaces on a machine will serve SMB requests. It
- affects file service <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and name service <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> in a slightly different ways.</p><p>
+ affects file service <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and name service <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> in a slightly different ways.</p><p>
For name service it causes <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to bind to ports 137 and 138 on the
- interfaces listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id311097"></a>interfaces parameter. <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
+ interfaces listed in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter. <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
also binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0) on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes of
reading broadcast messages. If this option is not set then <code class="literal">nmbd</code> will
- service name requests on all of these sockets. If <a class="indexterm" name="id311118"></a>bind interfaces only is set then
+ service name requests on all of these sockets. If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#BINDINTERFACESONLY">bind interfaces only</a> is set then
<code class="literal">nmbd</code> will check the source address of any packets coming in on the
broadcast sockets and discard any that don't match the broadcast addresses of the interfaces in the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id311132"></a>interfaces parameter list. As unicast packets are received on the other sockets it
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter list. As unicast packets are received on the other sockets it
allows <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to refuse to serve names to machines that send packets that
- arrive through any interfaces not listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id311147"></a>interfaces list. IP Source address
+ arrive through any interfaces not listed in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> list. IP Source address
spoofing does defeat this simple check, however, so it must not be used seriously as a security feature for
<code class="literal">nmbd</code>.
</p><p>
- For file service it causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to bind only to the interface list given in the <a class="indexterm" name="id311172"></a>interfaces parameter. This restricts the networks that <code class="literal">smbd</code> will
+ For file service it causes <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to bind only to the interface list given in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter. This restricts the networks that <code class="literal">smbd</code> will
serve to packets coming in those interfaces. Note that you should not use this parameter for machines that
are serving PPP or other intermittent or non-broadcast network interfaces as it will not cope with
non-permanent interfaces.
</p><p>
- If <a class="indexterm" name="id311191"></a>bind interfaces only is set then unless the network address
- <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added to the <a class="indexterm" name="id311202"></a>interfaces parameter list
- <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> and
- <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> may not work as
+ If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#BINDINTERFACESONLY">bind interfaces only</a> is set then unless the network address
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter list
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> and
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a> may not work as
expected due to the reasons covered below.
</p><p>
To change a users SMB password, the <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> by default connects to the
<span class="emphasis"><em>localhost - 127.0.0.1</em></span> address as an SMB client to issue the password change request. If
- <a class="indexterm" name="id311240"></a>bind interfaces only is set then unless the network address
- <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added to the <a class="indexterm" name="id311251"></a>interfaces parameter list then <code class="literal"> smbpasswd</code> will fail to connect in it's default mode. <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> can be forced to use the primary IP interface of the local host by using
- its <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> <em class="parameter"><code>-r <em class="replaceable"><code>remote machine</code></em></code></em> parameter, with <em class="replaceable"><code>remote
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#BINDINTERFACESONLY">bind interfaces only</a> is set then unless the network address
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> is added to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter list then <code class="literal"> smbpasswd</code> will fail to connect in it's default mode. <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> can be forced to use the primary IP interface of the local host by using
+ its <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> <em class="parameter"><code>-r <em class="replaceable"><code>remote machine</code></em></code></em> parameter, with <em class="replaceable"><code>remote
machine</code></em> set to the IP name of the primary interface of the local host.
</p><p>
The <code class="literal">swat</code> status page tries to connect with <code class="literal">smbd</code> and <code class="literal">nmbd</code> at the address
@@ -734,8 +822,11 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
from starting/stopping/restarting <code class="literal">smbd</code> and <code class="literal">nmbd</code>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>bind interfaces only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BLOCKINGLOCKS"></a>blocking locks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior
- of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when given a request by a client
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557442"></a>
+
+blocking locks (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557443"></a><a name="BLOCKINGLOCKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior
+ of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when given a request by a client
to obtain a byte range lock on a region of an open file, and the
request has a time limit associated with it.</p><p>If this parameter is set and the lock range requested
cannot be immediately satisfied, samba will internally
@@ -745,7 +836,10 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
will fail the lock request immediately if the lock range
cannot be obtained.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>blocking locks</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BLOCKSIZE"></a>block size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when reporting disk free
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557510"></a>
+
+block size (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557511"></a><a name="BLOCKSIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when reporting disk free
sizes. By default, this reports a disk block size of 1024 bytes.
</p><p>Changing this parameter may have some effect on the
efficiency of client writes, this is not yet confirmed. This
@@ -759,21 +853,36 @@ chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>block size</code></em> = <code class="literal">4096</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSABLE"></a>browsable</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for browseable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSEABLE"></a>browseable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether this share is seen in
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557593"></a><a name="BROWSABLE"></a>browsable</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557594"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#BROWSEABLE">browseable</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557623"></a>
+
+browseable (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557624"></a><a name="BROWSEABLE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether this share is seen in
the list of available shares in a net view and in the browse list.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>browseable</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BROWSELIST"></a>browse list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will serve a browse list to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557665"></a>
+
+browse list (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557666"></a><a name="BROWSELIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will serve a browse list to
a client doing a <code class="literal">NetServerEnum</code> call. Normally
set to <code class="constant">yes</code>. You should never need to change
this.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>browse list</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESIGNAMES"></a>casesignames</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for case sensitive.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESENSITIVE"></a>case sensitive (S)</span></dt><dd><p>See the discussion in the section <a class="indexterm" name="id311661"></a>name mangling.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>case sensitive</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557725"></a><a name="CASESIGNAMES"></a>casesignames</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557726"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557756"></a>
+
+case sensitive (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557757"></a><a name="CASESENSITIVE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>See the discussion in the section <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING">name mangling</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>case sensitive</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHANGENOTIFY"></a>change notify (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should reply
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557810"></a>
+
+change notify (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557811"></a><a name="CHANGENOTIFY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should reply
to a client's file change notify requests.
</p><p>You should never need to change this parameter</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>change notify</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"></a>change share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2557856"></a>
+
+change share command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2557857"></a><a name="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server
Manager. The <em class="parameter"><code>change share command</code></em> is used to define an external
program or script which will modify an existing service definition in <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>. In order to successfully execute the <em class="parameter"><code>change
@@ -804,18 +913,21 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>change share command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/bin/addshare</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHECKPASSWORDSCRIPT"></a>check password script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The name of a program that can be used to check password
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558052"></a>
+
+check password script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558053"></a><a name="CHECKPASSWORDSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The name of a program that can be used to check password
complexity. The password is sent to the program's standrad input.</p><p>The program must return 0 on good password any other value otherwise.
In case the password is considered weak (the program do not return 0) the
user will be notified and the password change will fail.</p><p>Note: In the example directory there is a sample program called crackcheck
- that uses cracklib to checkpassword quality</p>.
-
-
-<p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>check password script</code></em> = <code class="literal">Disabled</code>
+ that uses cracklib to checkpassword quality.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>check password script</code></em> = <code class="literal">Disabled</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>check password script</code></em> = <code class="literal">check password script = /usr/local/sbin/crackcheck</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTLANMANAUTH"></a>client lanman auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> and other samba client
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558126"></a>
+
+client lanman auth (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558127"></a><a name="CLIENTLANMANAUTH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> and other samba client
tools will attempt to authenticate itself to servers using the
weaker LANMAN password hash. If disabled, only server which support NT
password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000, Samba, etc... but not
@@ -826,8 +938,11 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
auth</code> parameter is enabled, then only NTLMv2 logins will be
attempted.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client lanman auth</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTLDAPSASLWRAPPING"></a>client ldap sasl wrapping (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- The <a class="indexterm" name="id312072"></a>client ldap sasl wrapping defines whether
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558208"></a>
+
+client ldap sasl wrapping (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558209"></a><a name="CLIENTLDAPSASLWRAPPING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CLIENTLDAPSASLWRAPPING">client ldap sasl wrapping</a> defines whether
ldap traffic will be signed or signed and encrypted (sealed).
Possible values are <span class="emphasis"><em>plain</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>sign</em></span>
and <span class="emphasis"><em>seal</em></span>.
@@ -839,7 +954,8 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
This option is needed in the case of Domain Controllers enforcing
the usage of signed LDAP connections (e.g. Windows 2000 SP3 or higher).
LDAP sign and seal can be controlled with the registry key
- "HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Services\NTDS\Parameters\LDAPServerIntegrity"
+ "<code class="literal">HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Services\</code>
+ <code class="literal">NTDS\Parameters\LDAPServerIntegrity</code>"
on the Windows server side.
</p><p>
Depending on the used KRB5 library (MIT and older Heimdal versions)
@@ -853,7 +969,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
<span class="emphasis"><em>seal</em></span>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client ldap sasl wrapping</code></em> = <code class="literal">plain</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTNTLMV2AUTH"></a>client ntlmv2 auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558337"></a>
+
+client ntlmv2 auth (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558338"></a><a name="CLIENTNTLMV2AUTH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
authenticate itself to servers using the NTLMv2 encrypted password
response.</p><p>If enabled, only an NTLMv2 and LMv2 response (both much more
secure than earlier versions) will be sent. Many servers
@@ -865,20 +984,29 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
those following 'best practice' security polices) only allow NTLMv2
responses, and not the weaker LM or NTLM.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client ntlmv2 auth</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTPLAINTEXTAUTH"></a>client plaintext auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a client should send a plaintext
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558431"></a>
+
+client plaintext auth (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558432"></a><a name="CLIENTPLAINTEXTAUTH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a client should send a plaintext
password if the server does not support encrypted passwords.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client plaintext auth</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSCHANNEL"></a>client schannel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558475"></a>
+
+client schannel (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558476"></a><a name="CLIENTSCHANNEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls whether the client offers or even demands the use of the netlogon schannel.
- <a class="indexterm" name="id312298"></a>client schannel = no does not offer the schannel,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id312306"></a>client schannel = auto offers the schannel but does not
- enforce it, and <a class="indexterm" name="id312313"></a>client schannel = yes denies access
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CLIENTSCHANNEL">client schannel = no</a> does not offer the schannel,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CLIENTSCHANNEL">client schannel = auto</a> offers the schannel but does not
+ enforce it, and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CLIENTSCHANNEL">client schannel = yes</a> denies access
if the server is not able to speak netlogon schannel.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client schannel</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client schannel</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSIGNING"></a>client signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or requires
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558572"></a>
+
+client signing (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558573"></a><a name="CLIENTSIGNING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or requires
the server it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values
are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span>
and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>.
@@ -887,26 +1015,57 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client signing</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTUSESPNEGO"></a>client use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This variable controls whether Samba clients will try
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558634"></a>
+
+client use spnego (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558635"></a><a name="CLIENTUSESPNEGO"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> This variable controls whether Samba clients will try
to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with
supporting servers (including WindowsXP, Windows2000 and Samba
3.0) to agree upon an authentication
mechanism. This enables Kerberos authentication in particular.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>client use spnego</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COMMENT"></a>comment (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a text field that is seen next to a share
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558680"></a>
+
+cluster addresses (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558681"></a><a name="CLUSTERADDRESSES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>With this parameter you can add additional addresses
+ nmbd will register with a WINS server. These addresses are not
+ necessarily present on all nodes simultaneously, but they will
+ be registered with the WINS server so that clients can contact
+ any of the nodes.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cluster addresses</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cluster addresses</code></em> = <code class="literal">10.0.0.1 10.0.0.2 10.0.0.3</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558742"></a>
+
+clustering (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558743"></a><a name="CLUSTERING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should contact
+ ctdb for accessing its tdb files and use ctdb as a backend
+ for its messaging backend.
+ </p><p>Set this parameter to <code class="literal">yes</code> only if
+ you have a cluster setup with ctdb running.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>clustering</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558795"></a>
+
+comment (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558796"></a><a name="COMMENT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a text field that is seen next to a share
when a client does a queries the server, either via the network
neighborhood or via <code class="literal">net view</code> to list what shares
are available.</p><p>If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the
- machine name then see the <a class="indexterm" name="id312483"></a>server string parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>comment</code></em> = <code class="literal">
+ machine name then see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SERVERSTRING">server string</a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>comment</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# No comment</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>comment</code></em> = <code class="literal">Fred's Files</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CONFIGBACKEND"></a>config backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558879"></a>
+
+config backend (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558880"></a><a name="CONFIGBACKEND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls the backend for storing the configuration.
Possible values are <span class="emphasis"><em>file</em></span> (the default)
and <span class="emphasis"><em>registry</em></span>.
- When <a class="indexterm" name="id312554"></a>config backend = registry
+ When <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CONFIGBACKEND">config backend = registry</a>
is encountered while loading <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span>,
the configuration read so far is dropped and the global
options are read from registry instead. So this triggers a
@@ -920,7 +1079,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>config backend</code></em> = <code class="literal">registry</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CONFIGFILE"></a>config file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the config file
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2558979"></a>
+
+config file (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2558980"></a><a name="CONFIGFILE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the config file
to use, instead of the default (usually <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>).
There is a chicken and egg problem here as this option is set
in the config file!</p><p>For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed
@@ -930,7 +1092,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
(allowing you to special case the config files of just a few
clients).</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>config file</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COPY"></a>copy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows you to "clone" service
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559049"></a>
+
+copy (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559050"></a><a name="COPY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows you to "clone" service
entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the
current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current
section will override those in the section being copied.</p><p>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and
@@ -940,7 +1105,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>copy</code></em> = <code class="literal">otherservice</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CREATEMODE"></a>create mode</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for create mask.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CREATEMASK"></a>create mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559116"></a><a name="CREATEMODE"></a>create mode</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559117"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#CREATEMASK">create mask</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559146"></a>
+
+create mask (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559147"></a><a name="CREATEMASK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
When a file is created, the necessary permissions are calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to
UNIX permissions, and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this parameter. This parameter may
be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for the UNIX modes of a file. Any bit <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> set here will
@@ -950,31 +1118,48 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
write and execute bits from the UNIX modes.
</p><p>
Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created from this parameter with the value of the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id312806"></a>force create mode parameter which is set to 000 by default.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCECREATEMODE">force create mode</a> parameter which is set to 000 by default.
</p><p>
- This parameter does not affect directory masks. See the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id312818"></a>directory mask
+ This parameter does not affect directory masks. See the parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask</a>
for details.
</p><p>
Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the
- administrator wishes to enforce a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a class="indexterm" name="id312830"></a>security mask.
+ administrator wishes to enforce a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYMASK">security mask</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>create mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0744</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>create mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0775</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CSCPOLICY"></a>csc policy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559284"></a>
+
+csc policy (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559285"></a><a name="CSCPOLICY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This stands for <span class="emphasis"><em>client-side caching policy</em></span>, and specifies how clients capable of offline
caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values are: manual, documents, programs, disable.
</p><p>
These values correspond to those used on Windows servers.
</p><p>
For example, shares containing roaming profiles can have offline caching disabled using
- <a class="indexterm" name="id312906"></a>csc policy = disable.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CSCPOLICY">csc policy = disable</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>csc policy</code></em> = <code class="literal">manual</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>csc policy</code></em> = <code class="literal">programs</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CUPSOPTIONS"></a>cups options (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter is only applicable if <a class="indexterm" name="id312969"></a>printing is
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559369"></a><a name="DEFAULT"></a>default</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559370"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#CTDBDSOCKET">ctdbd socket</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559400"></a>
+
+ctdbd socket (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559402"></a><a name="CTDBDSOCKET"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If you set <code class="literal">clustering=yes</code>,
+ you need to tell Samba where ctdbd listens on its unix domain
+ socket. The default path as of ctdb 1.0 is /tmp/ctdb.socket which
+ you have to explicitly set for Samba in smb.conf.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ctdbd socket</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ctdbd socket</code></em> = <code class="literal">/tmp/ctdb.socket</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559466"></a>
+
+cups options (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559468"></a><a name="CUPSOPTIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter is only applicable if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a> is
set to <code class="constant">cups</code>. Its value is a free form string of options
passed directly to the cups library.
</p><p>
@@ -982,6 +1167,9 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
in the CUPS "Software Users' Manual"). You can also pass any printer
specific option (as listed in "lpoptions -d printername -l")
valid for the target queue.
+ Multiple parameters should be space-delimited name/value pairs according to
+ the PAPI text option ABNF specification. Collection values
+ ("name={a=... b=... c=...}") are stored with the curley brackets intact.
</p><p>
You should set this parameter to <code class="constant">raw</code> if your CUPS server
<code class="filename">error_log</code> file contains messages such as
@@ -990,10 +1178,13 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
system wide raw printing in <code class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.{convs,types}</code>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cups options</code></em> = <code class="literal">""</code>
</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cups options</code></em> = <code class="literal">"raw,media=a4,job-sheets=secret,secret"</code>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cups options</code></em> = <code class="literal">"raw media=a4"</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CUPSSERVER"></a>cups server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter is only applicable if <a class="indexterm" name="id313063"></a>printing is set to <code class="constant">cups</code>.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559584"></a>
+
+cups server (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559585"></a><a name="CUPSSERVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter is only applicable if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a> is set to <code class="constant">cups</code>.
</p><p>
If set, this option overrides the ServerName option in the CUPS <code class="filename">client.conf</code>. This is
necessary if you have virtual samba servers that connect to different CUPS daemons.
@@ -1006,7 +1197,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>cups server</code></em> = <code class="literal">mycupsserver:1631</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEADTIME"></a>deadtime (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer)
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559692"></a>
+
+deadtime (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559693"></a><a name="DEADTIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer)
represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection
is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes
effect if the number of open files is zero.</p><p>This is useful to stop a server's resources being
@@ -1018,46 +1212,78 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>deadtime</code></em> = <code class="literal">15</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"></a>debug hires timestamp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559774"></a>
+
+debug class (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559775"></a><a name="DEBUGCLASS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ With this boolean parameter enabled, the debug class (DBGC_CLASS)
+ will be displayed in the debug header.
+ </p><p>
+ For more information about currently available debug classes, see
+ section about <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a>.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug class</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559832"></a>
+
+debug hires timestamp (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559833"></a><a name="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages are needed with a resolution of higher that seconds, this
boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp message header when turned on.
</p><p>
- Note that the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id313240"></a>debug timestamp must be on for this to have an effect.
+ Note that the parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a> must be on for this to have an effect.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug hires timestamp</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGPID"></a>debug pid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- When using only one log file for more then one forked <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>-process there may be hard to follow which process outputs which
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559894"></a>
+
+debug pid (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559895"></a><a name="DEBUGPID"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ When using only one log file for more then one forked <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>-process there may be hard to follow which process outputs which
message. This boolean parameter is adds the process-id to the timestamp message headers in the
logfile when turned on.
</p><p>
- Note that the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id313298"></a>debug timestamp must be on for this to have an effect.
+ Note that the parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a> must be on for this to have an effect.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug pid</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGPREFIXTIMESTAMP"></a>debug prefix timestamp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2559962"></a>
+
+debug prefix timestamp (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2559964"></a><a name="DEBUGPREFIXTIMESTAMP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
With this option enabled, the timestamp message header is prefixed to the debug message without the
- filename and function information that is included with the <a class="indexterm" name="id313346"></a>debug timestamp
+ filename and function information that is included with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a>
parameter. This gives timestamps to the messages without adding an additional line.
</p><p>
- Note that this parameter overrides the <a class="indexterm" name="id313357"></a>debug timestamp parameter.
+ Note that this parameter overrides the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a> parameter.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug prefix timestamp</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESTAMPLOGS"></a>timestamp logs</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for debug timestamp.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"></a>debug timestamp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560036"></a><a name="TIMESTAMPLOGS"></a>timestamp logs</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560037"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560067"></a>
+
+debug timestamp (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560068"></a><a name="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Samba debug log messages are timestamped by default. If you are running at a high
- <a class="indexterm" name="id313424"></a>debug level these timestamps can be distracting. This
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGLEVEL">debug level</a> these timestamps can be distracting. This
boolean parameter allows timestamping to be turned off.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug timestamp</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGUID"></a>debug uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560122"></a>
+
+debug uid (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560124"></a><a name="DEBUGUID"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime run as the connected user, this boolean parameter inserts the
current euid, egid, uid and gid to the timestamp message headers in the log file if turned on.
</p><p>
- Note that the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id313475"></a>debug timestamp must be on for this to have an effect.
+ Note that the parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp</a> must be on for this to have an effect.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>debug uid</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTCASE"></a>default case (S)</span></dt><dd><p>See the section on <a class="indexterm" name="id313521"></a>name mangling.
- Also note the <a class="indexterm" name="id313528"></a>short preserve case parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>default case</code></em> = <code class="literal">lower</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560182"></a>
+
+default case (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560183"></a><a name="DEFAULTCASE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>See the section on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING">name mangling</a>.
+ Also note the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SHORTPRESERVECASE">short preserve case</a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>default case</code></em> = <code class="literal">lower</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTDEVMODE"></a>default devmode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only applicable to <a class="indexterm" name="id313574"></a>printable services.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560246"></a>
+
+default devmode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560247"></a><a name="DEFAULTDEVMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only applicable to <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTABLE">printable</a> services.
When smbd is serving Printer Drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients, each printer on the Samba
server has a Device Mode which defines things such as paper size and
orientation and duplex settings. The device mode can only correctly be
@@ -1077,16 +1303,19 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
do this all the time, setting <code class="literal">default devmode = yes</code>
will instruct smbd to generate a default one.
</p><p>For more information on Windows NT/2k printing and Device Modes,
- see the <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">MSDN documentation</a>.
+ see the <a class="ulink" href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">MSDN documentation</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>default devmode</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULT"></a>default</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for default service.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFAULTSERVICE"></a>default service (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a service
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560343"></a><a name="DEFAULT"></a>default</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560344"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#DEFAULTSERVICE">default service</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560379"></a>
+
+default service (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560380"></a><a name="DEFAULTSERVICE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a service
which will be connected to if the service actually requested cannot
be found. Note that the square brackets are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
given in the parameter value (see example below).</p><p>There is no default value for this parameter. If this
parameter is not given, attempting to connect to a nonexistent
service results in an error.</p><p>
- Typically the default service would be a <a class="indexterm" name="id313686"></a>guest ok, <a class="indexterm" name="id313693"></a>read-only service.</p><p>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed to equal
+ Typically the default service would be a <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READ-ONLY">read-only</a> service.</p><p>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed to equal
that of the requested service, this is very useful as it allows you to use macros like <em class="parameter"><code>%S</code></em> to make a wildcard service.
</p><p>Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service
used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for
@@ -1094,7 +1323,10 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>default service</code></em> = <code class="literal">pub</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEFERSHARINGVIOLATIONS"></a>defer sharing violations (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560492"></a>
+
+defer sharing violations (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560494"></a><a name="DEFERSHARINGVIOLATIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Windows allows specifying how a file will be shared with
other processes when it is opened. Sharing violations occur when
a file is opened by a different process using options that violate
@@ -1107,23 +1339,29 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
designed to enable Samba to more correctly emulate Windows.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>defer sharing violations</code></em> = <code class="literal">True</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"></a>delete group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a group is requested to be deleted.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560551"></a>
+
+delete group script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560552"></a><a name="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will
+ be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a group is requested to be deleted.
It will expand any <em class="parameter"><code>%g</code></em> to the group name passed.
This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete group script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"></a>deleteprinter command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560612"></a>
+
+deleteprinter command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560614"></a><a name="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer
support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, it is now
possible to delete printer at run time by issuing the
DeletePrinter() RPC call.</p><p>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be
physically deleted from underlying printing system. The
- <a class="indexterm" name="id313883"></a>deleteprinter command defines a script to be run which
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">deleteprinter command</a> defines a script to be run which
will perform the necessary operations for removing the printer
from the print system and from <code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.
- </p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id313900"></a>deleteprinter command is
- automatically called with only one parameter: <a class="indexterm" name="id313908"></a>printer name.
- </p><p>Once the <a class="indexterm" name="id313918"></a>deleteprinter command has
+ </p><p>The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">deleteprinter command</a> is
+ automatically called with only one parameter: <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTERNAME">printer name</a>.
+ </p><p>Once the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">deleteprinter command</a> has
been executed, <code class="literal">smbd</code> will reparse the <code class="filename">
smb.conf</code> to associated printer no longer exists.
If the sharename is still valid, then <code class="literal">smbd
@@ -1131,12 +1369,18 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>deleteprinter command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/removeprinter</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEREADONLY"></a>delete readonly (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560764"></a>
+
+delete readonly (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560765"></a><a name="DELETEREADONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.
This is not normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.</p><p>This option may be useful for running applications such
as rcs, where UNIX file ownership prevents changing file
permissions, and DOS semantics prevent deletion of a read only file.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete readonly</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETESHARECOMMAND"></a>delete share command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560813"></a>
+
+delete share command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560814"></a><a name="DELETESHARECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server
Manager. The <em class="parameter"><code>delete share command</code></em> is used to define an external
program or script which will remove an existing service definition from
@@ -1155,22 +1399,28 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
the existing service.
</p></li></ul></div><p>
This parameter is only used to remove file shares. To delete printer shares,
- see the <a class="indexterm" name="id314137"></a>deleteprinter command.
+ see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">deleteprinter command</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete share command</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete share command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/bin/delshare</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"></a>delete user from group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Full path to the script that will be called when
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2560984"></a>
+
+delete user from group script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2560985"></a><a name="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Full path to the script that will be called when
a user is removed from a group using the Windows NT domain administration
- tools. It will be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>.
+ tools. It will be run by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span>.
Any <em class="parameter"><code>%g</code></em> will be replaced with the group name and
any <em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em> will be replaced with the user name.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete user from group script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete user from group script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/sbin/deluser %u %g</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"></a>delete user script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will
- be run by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when managing users
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561070"></a>
+
+delete user script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561071"></a><a name="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will
+ be run by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when managing users
with remote RPC (NT) tools.
</p><p>This script is called when a remote client removes a user
from the server, normally using 'User Manager for Domains' or
@@ -1178,9 +1428,12 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete user script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/bin/del_user %u</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DELETEVETOFILES"></a>delete veto files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used when Samba is attempting to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561152"></a>
+
+delete veto files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561153"></a><a name="DELETEVETOFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option is used when Samba is attempting to
delete a directory that contains one or more vetoed directories
- (see the <a class="indexterm" name="id314355"></a>veto files
+ (see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VETOFILES">veto files</a>
option). If this option is set to <code class="constant">no</code> (the default) then if a vetoed
directory contains any non-vetoed files or directories then the
directory delete will fail. This is usually what you want.</p><p>If this option is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, then Samba
@@ -1188,11 +1441,14 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
the vetoed directory. This can be useful for integration with file
serving systems such as NetAtalk which create meta-files within
directories you might normally veto DOS/Windows users from seeing
- (e.g. <code class="filename">.AppleDouble</code>)</p><p>Setting <a class="indexterm" name="id314386"></a>delete veto files = yes allows these
+ (e.g. <code class="filename">.AppleDouble</code>)</p><p>Setting <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEVETOFILES">delete veto files = yes</a> allows these
directories to be transparently deleted when the parent directory
is deleted (so long as the user has permissions to do so).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>delete veto files</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DFREECACHETIME"></a>dfree cache time (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561250"></a>
+
+dfree cache time (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561251"></a><a name="DFREECACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The <em class="parameter"><code>dfree cache time</code></em> should only be used on systems where a problem
occurs with the internal disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix, but may occur
with other operating systems. The symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry Ignore" at the
@@ -1200,12 +1456,15 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
</p><p>
This is a new parameter introduced in Samba version 3.0.21. It specifies in seconds the time that smbd will
cache the output of a disk free query. If set to zero (the default) no caching is done. This allows a heavily
- loaded server to prevent rapid spawning of <a class="indexterm" name="id314446"></a>dfree command scripts increasing the load.
+ loaded server to prevent rapid spawning of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DFREECOMMAND">dfree command</a> scripts increasing the load.
</p><p>
By default this parameter is zero, meaning no caching will be done.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dfree cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">dfree cache time = 60</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DFREECOMMAND"></a>dfree command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561332"></a>
+
+dfree command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561333"></a><a name="DFREECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The <em class="parameter"><code>dfree command</code></em> setting should only be used on systems where a
problem occurs with the internal disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix, but may
occur with other operating systems. The symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry Ignore"
@@ -1216,7 +1475,7 @@ connected using a root account (i.e. uid == 0).
function.
</p><p>
In Samba version 3.0.21 this parameter has been changed to be a per-share parameter, and in addition the
- parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id314518"></a>dfree cache time was added to allow the output of this script to be cached
+ parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DFREECACHETIME">dfree cache time</a> was added to allow the output of this script to be cached
for systems under heavy load.
</p><p>
The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating a directory in the filesystem being queried.
@@ -1243,7 +1502,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
By default internal routines for determining the disk capacity and remaining space will be used.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dfree command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/bin/dfree</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYMODE"></a>directory mode</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for directory mask.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYMASK"></a>directory mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is the octal modes which are
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561464"></a><a name="DIRECTORYMODE"></a>directory mode</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561465"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561496"></a>
+
+directory mask (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561497"></a><a name="DIRECTORYMASK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is the octal modes which are
used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX
directories.</p><p>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are
calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions,
@@ -1254,19 +1516,22 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
created.</p><p>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group'
and 'other' write bits from the UNIX mode, allowing only the
user who owns the directory to modify it.</p><p>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode
- created from this parameter with the value of the <a class="indexterm" name="id314651"></a>force directory mode parameter.
+ created from this parameter with the value of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE">force directory mode</a> parameter.
This parameter is set to 000 by default (i.e. no extra mode bits are added).</p><p>Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
- a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a class="indexterm" name="id314664"></a>directory security mask.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>directory mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0755</code>
+ a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK">directory security mask</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>directory mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0755</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>directory mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0775</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"></a>directory security mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561613"></a>
+
+directory security mask (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561614"></a><a name="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
will be set when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX
permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog
box.</p><p>
This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the incoming permission bits, thus resetting
- any bits not in this mask. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="indexterm" name="id314734"></a>force directory security mode, which works similar like this one but uses logical OR instead of AND.
+ any bits not in this mask. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE">force directory security mode</a>, which works similar like this one but uses logical OR instead of AND.
Essentially, zero bits in this mask are a set of bits that will always be set to zero.
</p><p>
Essentially, all bits set to zero in this mask will result in setting to zero the corresponding bits on the
@@ -1281,13 +1546,19 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>directory security mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0700</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISABLENETBIOS"></a>disable netbios (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable netbios support
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561723"></a>
+
+disable netbios (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561724"></a><a name="DISABLENETBIOS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable netbios support
in Samba. Netbios is the only available form of browsing in
all windows versions except for 2000 and XP. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Clients that only support netbios won't be able to
see your samba server when netbios support is disabled.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>disable netbios</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISABLESPOOLSS"></a>disable spoolss (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable Samba's support
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561773"></a>
+
+disable spoolss (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561774"></a><a name="DISABLESPOOLSS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Enabling this parameter will disable Samba's support
for the SPOOLSS set of MS-RPC's and will yield identical behavior
as Samba 2.0.x. Windows NT/2000 clients will downgrade to using
Lanman style printing commands. Windows 9x/ME will be unaffected by
@@ -1299,16 +1570,22 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
<span class="emphasis"><em>Be very careful about enabling this parameter.</em></span>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>disable spoolss</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DISPLAYCHARSET"></a>display charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561828"></a>
+
+display charset (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561830"></a><a name="DISPLAYCHARSET"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Specifies the charset that samba will use to print messages to stdout and stderr.
The default value is "LOCALE", which means automatically set, depending on the
current locale. The value should generally be the same as the value of the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id314912"></a>unix charset.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXCHARSET">unix charset</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>display charset</code></em> = <code class="literal">"LOCALE" or "ASCII" (depending on the system)</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>display charset</code></em> = <code class="literal">UTF8</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DMAPISUPPORT"></a>dmapi support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should use DMAPI to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561904"></a>
+
+dmapi support (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561905"></a><a name="DMAPISUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should use DMAPI to
determine whether a file is offline or not. This would typically
be used in conjunction with a hierarchical storage system that
automatically migrates files to tape.
@@ -1323,7 +1600,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</p><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dmapi support</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DNSPROXY"></a>dns proxy (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server and
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2561967"></a>
+
+dns proxy (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2561968"></a><a name="DNSPROXY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies that <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server and
finding that a NetBIOS name has not been registered, should treat the
NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS name and do a lookup with the DNS server
for that name on behalf of the name-querying client.</p><p>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15
@@ -1332,43 +1612,52 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
DNS name lookup requests, as doing a name lookup is a blocking
action.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dns proxy</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOMAINLOGONS"></a>domain logons (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562036"></a>
+
+domain logons (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562037"></a><a name="DOMAINLOGONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
If set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, the Samba server will
provide the netlogon service for Windows 9X network logons for the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id315094"></a>workgroup it is in.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> it is in.
This will also cause the Samba server to act as a domain
controller for NT4 style domain services. For more details on
setting up this feature see the Domain Control chapter of the
Samba HOWTO Collection.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>domain logons</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOMAINMASTER"></a>domain master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- Tell <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to enable
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562097"></a>
+
+domain master (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562098"></a><a name="DOMAINMASTER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ Tell <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to enable
WAN-wide browse list collation. Setting this option causes <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to claim a
special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a domain master browser for its given
- <a class="indexterm" name="id315156"></a>workgroup. Local master browsers in the same <a class="indexterm" name="id315164"></a>workgroup on
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a>. Local master browsers in the same <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> on
broadcast-isolated subnets will give this <code class="literal">nmbd</code> their local browse lists,
- and then ask <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> for a
+ and then ask <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> for a
complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area network. Browser clients will then contact their
local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list for their
broadcast-isolated subnet.
</p><p>
- Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be able to claim this <a class="indexterm" name="id315191"></a>workgroup specific special NetBIOS name that identifies them as domain master browsers for that
- <a class="indexterm" name="id315199"></a>workgroup by default (i.e. there is no way to prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting
+ Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be able to claim this <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> specific special NetBIOS name that identifies them as domain master browsers for that
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> by default (i.e. there is no way to prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting
to do this). This means that if this parameter is set and <code class="literal">nmbd</code> claims the
- special name for a <a class="indexterm" name="id315213"></a>workgroup before a Windows NT PDC is able to do so then cross
+ special name for a <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> before a Windows NT PDC is able to do so then cross
subnet browsing will behave strangely and may fail.
</p><p>
- If <a class="indexterm" name="id315225"></a>domain logons = yes, then the default behavior is to enable the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id315232"></a>domain master parameter. If <a class="indexterm" name="id315239"></a>domain logons is not enabled (the
- default setting), then neither will <a class="indexterm" name="id315247"></a>domain master be enabled by default.
+ If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons = yes</a>, then the default behavior is to enable the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER">domain master</a> parameter. If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons</a> is not enabled (the
+ default setting), then neither will <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER">domain master</a> be enabled by default.
</p><p>
- When <a class="indexterm" name="id315257"></a>domain logons = Yes the default setting for this parameter is
- Yes, with the result that Samba will be a PDC. If <a class="indexterm" name="id315265"></a>domain master = No,
+ When <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons = Yes</a> the default setting for this parameter is
+ Yes, with the result that Samba will be a PDC. If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER">domain master = No</a>,
Samba will function as a BDC. In general, this parameter should be set to 'No' only on a BDC.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>domain master</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DONTDESCEND"></a>dont descend (S)</span></dt><dd><p>There are certain directories on some systems
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562328"></a>
+
+dont descend (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562329"></a><a name="DONTDESCEND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>There are certain directories on some systems
(e.g., the <code class="filename">/proc</code> tree under Linux) that are either not
of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This
parameter allows you to specify a comma-delimited list of directories
@@ -1379,12 +1668,18 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dont descend</code></em> = <code class="literal">/proc,/dev</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSCHARSET"></a>dos charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>DOS SMB clients assume the server has
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562413"></a>
+
+dos charset (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562414"></a><a name="DOSCHARSET"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>DOS SMB clients assume the server has
the same charset as they do. This option specifies which
charset Samba should talk to DOS clients.
</p><p>The default depends on which charsets you have installed.
Samba tries to use charset 850 but falls back to ASCII in
- case it is not available. Run <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> to check the default on your system.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILEMODE"></a>dos filemode (S)</span></dt><dd><p> The default behavior in Samba is to provide
+ case it is not available. Run <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> to check the default on your system.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562457"></a>
+
+dos filemode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562458"></a><a name="DOSFILEMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> The default behavior in Samba is to provide
UNIX-like behavior where only the owner of a file/directory is
able to change the permissions on it. However, this behavior
is often confusing to DOS/Windows users. Enabling this parameter
@@ -1394,11 +1689,14 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
change permissions if the group is only granted read access.
Ownership of the file/directory may also be changed.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dos filemode</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"></a>dos filetime resolution (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562507"></a>
+
+dos filetime resolution (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562508"></a><a name="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest
granularity on time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter
for a share causes Samba to round the reported time down to the
nearest two second boundary when a query call that requires one second
- resolution is made to <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual
+ resolution is made to <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual
C++ when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a
share, Visual C++ uses two different time reading calls to check if a
file has changed since it was last read. One of these calls uses a
@@ -1409,13 +1707,16 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
this option causes the two timestamps to match, and Visual C++ is
happy.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dos filetime resolution</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSFILETIMES"></a>dos filetimes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562580"></a>
+
+dos filetimes (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562581"></a><a name="DOSFILETIMES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a
file they can change the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics,
only the owner of the file or root may change the timestamp. By
default, Samba runs with POSIX semantics and refuses to change the
timestamp on a file if the user <code class="literal">smbd</code> is acting
on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <code class="constant">
- yes</code> allows DOS semantics and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will change the file
+ yes</code> allows DOS semantics and <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will change the file
timestamp as DOS requires. Due to changes in Microsoft Office 2000 and beyond,
the default for this parameter has been changed from "no" to "yes" in Samba 3.0.14
and above. Microsoft Excel will display dialog box warnings about the file being
@@ -1423,14 +1724,20 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
shared between users.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>dos filetimes</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="EASUPPORT"></a>ea support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow clients to attempt to store OS/2 style Extended
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562651"></a>
+
+ea support (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562652"></a><a name="EASUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow clients to attempt to store OS/2 style Extended
attributes on a share. In order to enable this parameter the underlying filesystem exported by
the share must support extended attributes (such as provided on XFS and EXT3 on Linux, with the
correct kernel patches). On Linux the filesystem must have been mounted with the mount
option user_xattr in order for extended attributes to work, also
extended attributes must be compiled into the Linux kernel.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ea support</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENABLEASUSUPPORT"></a>enable asu support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Hosts running the "Advanced Server for Unix (ASU)" product
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562708"></a>
+
+enable asu support (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562709"></a><a name="ENABLEASUSUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Hosts running the "Advanced Server for Unix (ASU)" product
require some special accomodations such as creating a builting [ADMIN$]
share that only supports IPC connections. The has been the default
behavior in smbd for many years. However, certain Microsoft applications
@@ -1438,7 +1745,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
an [ADMIN$} file share. Disabling this parameter allows for creating
an [ADMIN$] file share in smb.conf.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>enable asu support</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENABLEPRIVILEGES"></a>enable privileges (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562757"></a>
+
+enable privileges (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562758"></a><a name="ENABLEPRIVILEGES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter controls whether or not smbd will honor privileges assigned to specific SIDs via either
<code class="literal">net rpc rights</code> or one of the Windows user and group manager tools. This parameter is
enabled by default. It can be disabled to prevent members of the Domain Admins group from being able to
@@ -1451,7 +1761,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
Please read the extended description provided in the Samba HOWTO documentation.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>enable privileges</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"></a>encrypt passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562823"></a>
+
+encrypt passwords (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562824"></a><a name="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords
will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and
above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords
unless a registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in
@@ -1468,13 +1781,16 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
is no longer maintained in Microsoft Windows products. If you want to use
plain text passwords you must set this parameter to no.
</p><p>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must either
- have access to a local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file (see the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> program for information on how to set up
- and maintain this file), or set the <a class="indexterm" name="id315792"></a>security = [server|domain|ads] parameter which
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must either
+ have access to a local <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file (see the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> program for information on how to set up
+ and maintain this file), or set the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = [server|domain|ads]</a> parameter which
causes <code class="literal">smbd</code> to authenticate against another
server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>encrypt passwords</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENHANCEDBROWSING"></a>enhanced browsing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option enables a couple of enhancements to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2562935"></a>
+
+enhanced browsing (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2562936"></a><a name="ENHANCEDBROWSING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option enables a couple of enhancements to
cross-subnet browse propagation that have been added in Samba
but which are not standard in Microsoft implementations.
</p><p>The first enhancement to browse propagation consists of a regular
@@ -1487,7 +1803,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
to stay around forever which can be annoying.</p><p>In general you should leave this option enabled as it makes
cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>enhanced browsing</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"></a>enumports command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563001"></a>
+
+enumports command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563002"></a><a name="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign
to UNIX hosts. Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port
is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of
a local port (i.e. LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:) or a remote port
@@ -1504,7 +1823,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>enumports command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/listports</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="EVENTLOGLIST"></a>eventlog list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option defines a list of log names that Samba will
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563090"></a>
+
+eventlog list (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563091"></a><a name="EVENTLOGLIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option defines a list of log names that Samba will
report to the Microsoft EventViewer utility. The listed
eventlogs will be associated with tdb file on disk in the
<code class="filename">$(lockdir)/eventlog</code>.
@@ -1517,7 +1839,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>eventlog list</code></em> = <code class="literal">Security Application Syslog Apache</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"></a>fake directory create times (S)</span></dt><dd><p>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563170"></a>
+
+fake directory create times (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563171"></a><a name="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create
time for all files and directories. This is not the same as the
ctime - status change time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default
reports the earliest of the various times Unix does keep. Setting
@@ -1539,14 +1864,17 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
ensures directories always predate their contents and an NMAKE build
will proceed as expected.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>fake directory create times</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FAKEOPLOCKS"></a>fake oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563249"></a>
+
+fake oplocks (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563250"></a><a name="FAKEOPLOCKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission
from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants
an oplock (opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume
that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively
cache file data. With some oplock types the client may even cache
file open/close operations. This can give enormous performance benefits.
- </p><p>When you set <code class="literal">fake oplocks = yes</code>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will
- always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using the file.</p><p>It is generally much better to use the real <a class="indexterm" name="id316132"></a>oplocks support rather
+ </p><p>When you set <code class="literal">fake oplocks = yes</code>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will
+ always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using the file.</p><p>It is generally much better to use the real <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#OPLOCKS">oplocks</a> support rather
than this parameter.</p><p>If you enable this option on all read-only shares or
shares that you know will only be accessed from one client at a
time such as physically read-only media like CDROMs, you will see
@@ -1555,8 +1883,11 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
files read-write at the same time you can get data corruption. Use
this option carefully!</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>fake oplocks</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"></a>follow symlinks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter allows the Samba administrator to stop <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> from following symbolic links in a particular share. Setting this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563342"></a>
+
+follow symlinks (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563343"></a><a name="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter allows the Samba administrator to stop <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> from following symbolic links in a particular share. Setting this
parameter to <code class="constant">no</code> prevents any file or directory that is a symbolic link from being
followed (the user will get an error). This option is very useful to stop users from adding a symbolic
link to <code class="filename">/etc/passwd</code> in their home directory for instance. However
@@ -1565,7 +1896,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
This option is enabled (i.e. <code class="literal">smbd</code> will follow symbolic links) by default.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>follow symlinks</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCECREATEMODE"></a>force create mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563417"></a>
+
+force create mode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563418"></a><a name="FORCECREATEMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
permissions that will <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> be set on a
file created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto
the mode bits of a file that is being created or having its
@@ -1578,7 +1912,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force create mode</code></em> = <code class="literal">0755</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"></a>force directory mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563498"></a>
+
+force directory mode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563499"></a><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
permissions that will <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> be set on a directory
created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the
mode bits of a directory that is being created. The default for this
@@ -1591,12 +1928,15 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force directory mode</code></em> = <code class="literal">0755</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"></a>force directory security mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563579"></a>
+
+force directory security mode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563580"></a><a name="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
the UNIX permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog box.
</p><p>
This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this
- mask that the user may have modified to be on. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="indexterm" name="id316406"></a>directory security mask, which works in a similar manner to this one, but uses a logical AND instead
+ mask that the user may have modified to be on. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK">directory security mask</a>, which works in a similar manner to this one, but uses a logical AND instead
of an OR.
</p><p>
Essentially, this mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a directory,
@@ -1612,7 +1952,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force directory security mode</code></em> = <code class="literal">700</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GROUP"></a>group</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for force group.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEGROUP"></a>force group (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563683"></a><a name="GROUP"></a>group</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563684"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#FORCEGROUP">force group</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563714"></a>
+
+force group (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563715"></a><a name="FORCEGROUP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be
assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting
to this service. This is useful for sharing files by ensuring
that all access to files on service will use the named group for
@@ -1630,13 +1973,16 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
that only users who are already in group sys will have their default
primary group assigned to sys when accessing this Samba share. All
other users will retain their ordinary primary group.</p><p>
- If the <a class="indexterm" name="id266502"></a>force user parameter is also set the group specified in
+ If the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCEUSER">force user</a> parameter is also set the group specified in
<em class="parameter"><code>force group</code></em> will override the primary group
set in <em class="parameter"><code>force user</code></em>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force group</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force group</code></em> = <code class="literal">agroup</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEPRINTERNAME"></a>force printername (S)</span></dt><dd><p>When printing from Windows NT (or later),
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563829"></a>
+
+force printername (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563830"></a><a name="FORCEPRINTERNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>When printing from Windows NT (or later),
each printer in <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> has two
associated names which can be used by the client. The first
is the sharename (or shortname) defined in smb.conf. This
@@ -1659,12 +2005,15 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
not be able to delete printer connections from their local Printers
folder.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force printername</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCESECURITYMODE"></a>force security mode (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2563921"></a>
+
+force security mode (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2563922"></a><a name="FORCESECURITYMODE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog box.
</p><p>
This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this
- mask that the user may have modified to be on. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="indexterm" name="id316754"></a>security mask, which works similar like this one but uses logical AND instead of OR.
+ mask that the user may have modified to be on. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYMASK">security mask</a>, which works similar like this one but uses logical AND instead of OR.
</p><p>
Essentially, one bits in this mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a file,
the user has always set to be on.
@@ -1679,7 +2028,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force security mode</code></em> = <code class="literal">700</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEUNKNOWNACLUSER"></a>force unknown acl user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564022"></a>
+
+force unknown acl user (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564023"></a><a name="FORCEUNKNOWNACLUSER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
If this parameter is set, a Windows NT ACL that contains an unknown SID (security descriptor, or
representation of a user or group id) as the owner or group owner of the file will be silently
mapped into the current UNIX uid or gid of the currently connected user.
@@ -1693,7 +2045,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
Try using this parameter when XCOPY /O gives an ACCESS_DENIED error.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force unknown acl user</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FORCEUSER"></a>force user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564085"></a>
+
+force user (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564086"></a><a name="FORCEUSER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be
assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service.
This is useful for sharing files. You should also use it carefully
as using it incorrectly can cause security problems.</p><p>This user name only gets used once a connection is established.
@@ -1707,9 +2062,12 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>force user</code></em> = <code class="literal">auser</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="FSTYPE"></a>fstype (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564161"></a>
+
+fstype (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564162"></a><a name="FSTYPE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter allows the administrator to configure the string that specifies the type of filesystem a share
- is using that is reported by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ is using that is reported by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
when a client queries the filesystem type for a share. The default type is <code class="constant">NTFS</code> for compatibility
with Windows NT but this can be changed to other strings such as <code class="constant">Samba</code> or <code class="constant">FAT</code>
if required.
@@ -1717,7 +2075,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>fstype</code></em> = <code class="literal">Samba</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>get quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">get quota command</code> should only be used
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564242"></a>
+
+get quota command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564243"></a><a name="GETQUOTACOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">get quota command</code> should only be used
whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that
samba can use.</p><p>This option is only available with <code class="literal">./configure --with-sys-quotas</code>.
Or on linux when <code class="literal">./configure --with-quotas</code> was used and a working quota api
@@ -1729,13 +2090,19 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>get quota command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/sbin/query_quota</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETWDCACHE"></a>getwd cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564429"></a>
+
+getwd cache (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564430"></a><a name="GETWDCACHE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a
caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd()
calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially
- when the <a class="indexterm" name="id317205"></a>wide smbconfoptions parameter is set to <code class="constant">no</code>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>getwd cache</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
+ when the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WIDESMBCONFOPTIONS">wide smbconfoptions</a> parameter is set to <code class="constant">no</code>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>getwd cache</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTACCOUNT"></a>guest account (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a username which will be used for access
- to services which are specified as <a class="indexterm" name="id317254"></a>guest ok (see below). Whatever privileges this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564489"></a>
+
+guest account (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564490"></a><a name="GUESTACCOUNT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a username which will be used for access
+ to services which are specified as <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok</a> (see below). Whatever privileges this
user has will be available to any client connecting to the guest service.
This user must exist in the password file, but does not require
a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice
@@ -1752,22 +2119,34 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>guest account</code></em> = <code class="literal">ftp</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PUBLIC"></a>public</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for guest ok.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTOK"></a>guest ok (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code> for
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564597"></a><a name="PUBLIC"></a>public</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564598"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#GUESTOK">guest ok</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564627"></a>
+
+guest ok (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564628"></a><a name="GUESTOK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code> for
a service, then no password is required to connect to the service.
- Privileges will be those of the <a class="indexterm" name="id317373"></a>guest account.</p><p>This paramater nullifies the benifits of setting
- <a class="indexterm" name="id317384"></a>restrict anonymous = 2
- </p><p>See the section below on <a class="indexterm" name="id317394"></a>security for more information about this option.
+ Privileges will be those of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>.</p><p>This paramater nullifies the benifits of setting
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#RESTRICTANONYMOUS">restrict anonymous = 2</a>
+ </p><p>See the section below on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a> for more information about this option.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>guest ok</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ONLYGUEST"></a>only guest</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for guest only.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTONLY"></a>guest only (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code> for
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564715"></a><a name="ONLYGUEST"></a>only guest</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564716"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#GUESTONLY">guest only</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564746"></a>
+
+guest only (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564747"></a><a name="GUESTONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code> for
a service, then only guest connections to the service are permitted.
- This parameter will have no effect if <a class="indexterm" name="id317465"></a>guest ok is not set for the service.</p><p>See the section below on <a class="indexterm" name="id317476"></a>security for more information about this option.
+ This parameter will have no effect if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok</a> is not set for the service.</p><p>See the section below on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security</a> for more information about this option.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>guest only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEDOTFILES"></a>hide dot files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564819"></a>
+
+hide dot files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564820"></a><a name="HIDEDOTFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether
files starting with a dot appear as hidden files.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hide dot files</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEFILES"></a>hide files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of files or directories that are not
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564861"></a>
+
+hide files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564862"></a><a name="HIDEFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of files or directories that are not
visible but are accessible. The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied
to any files or directories that match.</p><p>Each entry in the list must be separated by a '/',
which allows spaces to be included in the entry. '*'
@@ -1778,7 +2157,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $(NF-4),$(NF-2)}'
as it will be forced to check all files and directories for a match
as they are scanned.</p><p>
The example shown above is based on files that the Macintosh
- SMB client (DAVE) available from <a href="http://www.thursby.com" target="_top">
+ SMB client (DAVE) available from <a class="ulink" href="http://www.thursby.com" target="_top">
Thursby</a> creates for internal use, and also still hides
all files beginning with a dot.
</p><p>
@@ -1789,21 +2168,33 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hide files</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# no file are hidden</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDESPECIALFILES"></a>hide special files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564950"></a>
+
+hide special files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564951"></a><a name="HIDESPECIALFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter prevents clients from seeing special files such as sockets, devices and
fifo's in directory listings.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hide special files</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEUNREADABLE"></a>hide unreadable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter prevents clients from seeing the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2564992"></a>
+
+hide unreadable (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2564993"></a><a name="HIDEUNREADABLE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter prevents clients from seeing the
existance of files that cannot be read. Defaults to off.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hide unreadable</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"></a>hide unwriteable files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565035"></a>
+
+hide unwriteable files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565036"></a><a name="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter prevents clients from seeing the existance of files that cannot be written to.
Defaults to off. Note that unwriteable directories are shown as usual.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hide unwriteable files</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOMEDIRMAP"></a>homedir map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- If <a class="indexterm" name="id317755"></a>nis homedir is <code class="constant">yes</code>, and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> is also acting as a Win95/98 <em class="parameter"><code>logon server</code></em>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565079"></a>
+
+homedir map (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565080"></a><a name="HOMEDIRMAP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NISHOMEDIR">nis homedir</a> is <code class="constant">yes</code>, and <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> is also acting as a Win95/98 <em class="parameter"><code>logon server</code></em>
then this parameter specifies the NIS (or YP) map from which the server for the user's home directory should be extracted.
At present, only the Sun auto.home map format is understood. The form of the map is:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -1817,15 +2208,21 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>homedir map</code></em> = <code class="literal">amd.homedir</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTMSDFS"></a>host msdfs (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565192"></a>
+
+host msdfs (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565193"></a><a name="HOSTMSDFS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
If set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, Samba will act as a Dfs server, and allow Dfs-aware clients to browse
Dfs trees hosted on the server.
</p><p>
- See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id317862"></a>msdfs root share level parameter. For more information on
+ See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT">msdfs root</a> share level parameter. For more information on
setting up a Dfs tree on Samba, refer to the MSFDS chapter in the book Samba3-HOWTO.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>host msdfs</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"></a>hostname lookups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether samba should use (expensive)
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565256"></a>
+
+hostname lookups (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565257"></a><a name="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether samba should use (expensive)
hostname lookups or use the ip addresses instead. An example place
where hostname lookups are currently used is when checking
the <code class="literal">hosts deny</code> and <code class="literal">hosts allow</code>.
@@ -1833,7 +2230,10 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hostname lookups</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ALLOWHOSTS"></a>allow hosts</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for hosts allow.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSALLOW"></a>hosts allow (S)</span></dt><dd><p>A synonym for this parameter is <a class="indexterm" name="id317998"></a>allow hosts.</p><p>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565329"></a><a name="ALLOWHOSTS"></a>allow hosts</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565330"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#HOSTSALLOW">hosts allow</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565360"></a>
+
+hosts allow (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565361"></a><a name="HOSTSALLOW"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>A synonym for this parameter is <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ALLOWHOSTS">allow hosts</a>.</p><p>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited
set of hosts which are permitted to access a service.</p><p>If specified in the [global] section then it will
apply to all services, regardless of whether the individual
service has a different setting.</p><p>You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For
@@ -1843,67 +2243,85 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
page <code class="filename">hosts_access(5)</code>. Note that this man
page may not be present on your system, so a brief description will
be given here also.</p><p>Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always
- be allowed access unless specifically denied by a <a class="indexterm" name="id318036"></a>hosts deny option.</p><p>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and
+ be allowed access unless specifically denied by a <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTSDENY">hosts deny</a> option.</p><p>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and
by netgroup names if your system supports netgroups. The
<span class="emphasis"><em>EXCEPT</em></span> keyword can also be used to limit a
wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</p><p>Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</p><p><code class="literal">hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</code></p><p>Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</p><p><code class="literal">hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</code></p><p>Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</p><p><code class="literal">hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</code></p><p>Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but
- deny access from one particular host</p><p><code class="literal">hosts allow = @foonet</code></p><p><code class="literal">hosts deny = pirate</code></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</p></div><p>See <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> for a way of testing your host access
+ deny access from one particular host</p><p><code class="literal">hosts allow = @foonet</code></p><p><code class="literal">hosts deny = pirate</code></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</p></div><p>See <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> for a way of testing your host access
to see if it does what you expect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hosts allow</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hosts allow</code></em> = <code class="literal">150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DENYHOSTS"></a>deny hosts</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for hosts deny.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSDENY"></a>hosts deny (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The opposite of <em class="parameter"><code>hosts allow</code></em>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565562"></a><a name="DENYHOSTS"></a>deny hosts</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565563"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#HOSTSDENY">hosts deny</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565592"></a>
+
+hosts deny (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565593"></a><a name="HOSTSDENY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The opposite of <em class="parameter"><code>hosts allow</code></em>
- hosts listed here are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> permitted access to
services unless the specific services have their own lists to override
this one. Where the lists conflict, the <em class="parameter"><code>allow</code></em>
list takes precedence.</p><p>
In the event that it is necessary to deny all by default, use the keyword
ALL (or the netmask <code class="literal">0.0.0.0/0</code>) and then explicitly specify
- to the <a class="indexterm" name="id318224"></a>hosts allow = hosts allow parameter those hosts
+ to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTSALLOW">hosts allow = hosts allow</a> parameter those hosts
that should be permitted access.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hosts deny</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# none (i.e., no hosts specifically excluded)</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>hosts deny</code></em> = <code class="literal">150.203.4. badhost.mynet.edu.au</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPALLOCBACKEND"></a>idmap alloc backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565694"></a>
+
+idmap alloc backend (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565695"></a><a name="IDMAPALLOCBACKEND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap alloc backend provides a plugin interface for Winbind to use
when allocating Unix uids/gids for Windows SIDs. This option is
- to be used in conjunction with the <a class="indexterm" name="id318289"></a>idmap domains
+ to be used in conjunction with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a>
parameter and refers to the name of the idmap module which will provide
the id allocation functionality. Please refer to the man page
for each idmap plugin to determine whether or not the module implements
- the allocation feature. The most common plugins are the tdb (<a href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>)
- and ldap (<a href="idmap_ldap.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ldap</span>(8)</span></a>) libraries.
- </p><p>Also refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id318318"></a>idmap alloc config option.
+ the allocation feature. The most common plugins are the tdb (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>)
+ and ldap (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_ldap.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ldap</span>(8)</span></a>) libraries.
+ </p><p>Also refer to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPALLOCCONFIG">idmap alloc config</a> option.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap alloc backend</code></em> = <code class="literal">tdb</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPALLOCCONFIG"></a>idmap alloc config (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565791"></a>
+
+idmap alloc config (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565792"></a><a name="IDMAPALLOCCONFIG"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap alloc config prefix provides a means of managing settings
- for the backend defined by the <a class="indexterm" name="id318368"></a>idmap alloc backend
+ for the backend defined by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPALLOCBACKEND">idmap alloc backend</a>
parameter. Refer to the man page for each idmap plugin regarding
specific configuration details.
- </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPBACKEND"></a>idmap backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565836"></a>
+
+idmap backend (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565837"></a><a name="IDMAPBACKEND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap backend provides a plugin interface for Winbind to use
varying backends to store SID/uid/gid mapping tables. This
option is mutually exclusive with the newer and more flexible
- <a class="indexterm" name="id318404"></a>idmap domains parameter. The main difference
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a> parameter. The main difference
between the "idmap backend" and the "idmap domains"
is that the former only allows on backend for all domains while the
latter supports configuring backends on a per domain basis.
- </p><p>Examples of SID/uid/gid backends include tdb (<a href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>),
- ldap (<a href="idmap_ldap.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ldap</span>(8)</span></a>), rid (<a href="idmap_rid.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_rid</span>(8)</span></a>),
- and ad (<a href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>).
+ </p><p>Examples of SID/uid/gid backends include tdb (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>),
+ ldap (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_ldap.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ldap</span>(8)</span></a>), rid (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_rid.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_rid</span>(8)</span></a>),
+ and ad (<a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a>).
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap backend</code></em> = <code class="literal">tdb</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPCACHETIME"></a>idmap cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds that Winbind's
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565931"></a>
+
+idmap cache time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565932"></a><a name="IDMAPCACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds that Winbind's
idmap interface will cache positive SID/uid/gid query results.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">900</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPCONFIG"></a>idmap config (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2565974"></a>
+
+idmap config (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2565975"></a><a name="IDMAPCONFIG"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap config prefix provides a means of managing each domain
- defined by the <a class="indexterm" name="id318526"></a>idmap domains option using Samba's
+ defined by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a> option using Samba's
parameteric option support. The idmap config prefix should be
followed by the name of the domain, a colon, and a setting specific to
the chosen backend. There are three options available for all domains:
@@ -1917,11 +2335,11 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
domain SID).
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">readonly = [yes|no]</span></dt><dd><p>
Mark the domain as readonly which means that no attempts to
- allocate a uid or gid (by the <a class="indexterm" name="id318573"></a>idmap alloc backend) for any user or group in that domain
+ allocate a uid or gid (by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPALLOCBACKEND">idmap alloc backend</a>) for any user or group in that domain
will be attempted.
</p></dd></dl></div><p>
- The following example illustrates how to configure the <a href="idmap_ad.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ad</span>(8)</span></a>
- for the CORP domain and the <a href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a> backend for all other domains. The
+ The following example illustrates how to configure the <a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_ad.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_ad</span>(8)</span></a>
+ for the CORP domain and the <a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_tdb.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_tdb</span>(8)</span></a> backend for all other domains. The
TRUSTEDDOMAINS string is simply a key used to reference the "idmap
config" settings and does not represent the actual name of a domain.
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -1933,52 +2351,78 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
idmap config TRUSTEDDOMAINS:backend = tdb
idmap config TRUSTEDDOMAINS:default = yes
idmap config TRUSTEDDOMAINS:range = 1000 - 9999
- </pre><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPDOMAINS"></a>idmap domains (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </pre><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566108"></a>
+
+idmap domains (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566110"></a><a name="IDMAPDOMAINS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap domains option defines a list of Windows domains which will each
have a separately configured backend for managing Winbind's SID/uid/gid
- tables. This parameter is mutually exclusive with the older <a class="indexterm" name="id318641"></a>idmap backend option.
+ tables. This parameter is mutually exclusive with the older <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a> option.
</p><p>
Values consist of the short domain name for Winbind's primary or collection
of trusted domains. You may also use an arbitrary string to represent a catchall
domain backend for any domain not explicitly listed.
</p><p>
- Refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id318656"></a>idmap config for details about
+ Refer to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPCONFIG">idmap config</a> for details about
managing the SID/uid/gid backend for each domain.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap domains</code></em> = <code class="literal">default AD CORP</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDGID"></a>winbind gid</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for idmap gid.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPGID"></a>idmap gid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap gid parameter specifies the range of group ids
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566193"></a><a name="WINBINDGID"></a>winbind gid</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566194"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#IDMAPGID">idmap gid</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566224"></a>
+
+idmap gid (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566225"></a><a name="IDMAPGID"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The idmap gid parameter specifies the range of group ids
that are allocated for the purpose of mapping UNX groups to NT group
SIDs. This range of group ids should have no
existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can
- occur otherwise.</p><p>See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id318734"></a>idmap backend, <a class="indexterm" name="id318741"></a>idmap domains, and <a class="indexterm" name="id318748"></a>idmap config options.
+ occur otherwise.</p><p>See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a>, and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPCONFIG">idmap config</a> options.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap gid</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap gid</code></em> = <code class="literal">10000-20000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPNEGATIVECACHETIME"></a>idmap negative cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds that Winbind's
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566322"></a>
+
+idmap negative cache time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566323"></a><a name="IDMAPNEGATIVECACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds that Winbind's
idmap interface will cache negative SID/uid/gid query results.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap negative cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">120</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUID"></a>winbind uid</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for idmap uid.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPUID"></a>idmap uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566365"></a><a name="WINBINDUID"></a>winbind uid</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566366"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#IDMAPUID">idmap uid</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566396"></a>
+
+idmap uid (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566397"></a><a name="IDMAPUID"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The idmap uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
allocated for use in mapping UNIX users to NT user SIDs. This
range of ids should have no existing local
- or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id318876"></a>idmap backend, <a class="indexterm" name="id318883"></a>idmap domains, and <a class="indexterm" name="id318890"></a>idmap config options.
+ or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a>, and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPCONFIG">idmap config</a> options.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap uid</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>idmap uid</code></em> = <code class="literal">10000-20000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INCLUDE"></a>include (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566493"></a>
+
+include (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566494"></a><a name="INCLUDE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This allows you to include one config file inside another. The file is included literally, as though typed
in place.
</p><p>
It takes the standard substitutions, except <em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em>,
<em class="parameter"><code>%P</code></em> and <em class="parameter"><code>%S</code></em>.
+ </p><p>
+ The parameter <em class="parameter"><code>include = registry</code></em> has
+ a special meaning: It does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> include
+ a file named <span class="emphasis"><em>registry</em></span> from the current working
+ directory, but instead reads the global configuration options
+ from the registry. See the section on registry-based
+ configuration for details. Note that this option
+ automatically activates registry shares.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>include</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>include</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/lib/admin_smb.conf</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INHERITACLS"></a>inherit acls (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter can be used to ensure that if default acls
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566594"></a>
+
+inherit acls (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566595"></a><a name="INHERITACLS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter can be used to ensure that if default acls
exist on parent directories, they are always honored when creating a
new file or subdirectory in these parent directories. The default
behavior is to use the unix mode specified when creating the directory.
@@ -1986,7 +2430,10 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
default directory acls are propagated.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>inherit acls</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INHERITOWNER"></a>inherit owner (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The ownership of new files and directories
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566641"></a>
+
+inherit owner (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566642"></a><a name="INHERITOWNER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The ownership of new files and directories
is normally governed by effective uid of the connected user.
This option allows the Samba administrator to specify that
the ownership for new files and directories should be controlled
@@ -1995,19 +2442,25 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
delete them and to ensure that newly create files in a user's
roaming profile directory are actually owner by the user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>inherit owner</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INHERITPERMISSIONS"></a>inherit permissions (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- The permissions on new files and directories are normally governed by <a class="indexterm" name="id319114"></a>create mask,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id319121"></a>directory mask, <a class="indexterm" name="id319128"></a>force create mode and <a class="indexterm" name="id319135"></a>force directory mode but the boolean inherit permissions parameter overrides this.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566694"></a>
+
+inherit permissions (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566695"></a><a name="INHERITPERMISSIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ The permissions on new files and directories are normally governed by <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a>,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCECREATEMODE">force create mode</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE">force directory mode</a> but the boolean inherit permissions parameter overrides this.
</p><p>New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
including bits such as setgid.</p><p>
New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent directory. Their execute bits continue to be
- determined by <a class="indexterm" name="id319151"></a>map archive, <a class="indexterm" name="id319158"></a>map hidden and <a class="indexterm" name="id319166"></a>map system as usual.
+ determined by <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPARCHIVE">map archive</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPHIDDEN">map hidden</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPSYSTEM">map system</a> as usual.
</p><p>Note that the setuid bit is <span class="emphasis"><em>never</em></span> set via
inheritance (the code explicitly prohibits this).</p><p>This can be particularly useful on large systems with
many users, perhaps several thousand, to allow a single [homes]
share to be used flexibly by each user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>inherit permissions</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INTERFACES"></a>interfaces (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the default
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566842"></a>
+
+interfaces (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566843"></a><a name="INTERFACES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the default
network interfaces list that Samba will use for browsing, name
registration and other NBT traffic. By default Samba will query
the kernel for the list of all active interfaces and use any
@@ -2031,7 +2484,10 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>interfaces</code></em> = <code class="literal">eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="INVALIDUSERS"></a>invalid users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that should not be allowed
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2566958"></a>
+
+invalid users (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2566959"></a><a name="INVALIDUSERS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that should not be allowed
to login to this service. This is really a <span class="emphasis"><em>paranoid</em></span>
check to absolutely ensure an improper setting does not breach
your security.</p><p>A name starting with a '@' is interpreted as an NIS
@@ -2051,8 +2507,11 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>invalid users</code></em> = <code class="literal">root fred admin @wheel</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IPRINTSERVER"></a>iprint server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter is only applicable if <a class="indexterm" name="id319425"></a>printing is set to <code class="constant">iprint</code>.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567071"></a>
+
+iprint server (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567072"></a><a name="IPRINTSERVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter is only applicable if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a> is set to <code class="constant">iprint</code>.
</p><p>
If set, this option overrides the ServerName option in the CUPS <code class="filename">client.conf</code>. This is
necessary if you have virtual samba servers that connect to different CUPS daemons.
@@ -2060,34 +2519,46 @@ hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>iprint server</code></em> = <code class="literal">MYCUPSSERVER</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KEEPALIVE"></a>keepalive (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567158"></a>
+
+keepalive (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567159"></a><a name="KEEPALIVE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents
the number of seconds between <em class="parameter"><code>keepalive</code></em>
packets. If this parameter is zero, no keepalive packets will be
sent. Keepalive packets, if sent, allow the server to tell whether
a client is still present and responding.</p><p>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket
- has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it by default. (see <a class="indexterm" name="id319514"></a>socket options).
+ has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it by default. (see <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS">socket options</a>).
Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>keepalive</code></em> = <code class="literal">300</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>keepalive</code></em> = <code class="literal">600</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELCHANGENOTIFY"></a>kernel change notify (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should ask the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567245"></a>
+
+kernel change notify (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567246"></a><a name="KERNELCHANGENOTIFY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should ask the
kernel for change notifications in directories so that
SMB clients can refresh whenever the data on the server changes.
</p><p>This parameter is only used when your kernel supports
change notification to user programs using the inotify interface.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>kernel change notify</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELOPLOCKS"></a>kernel oplocks (G)</span></dt><dd><p>For UNIXes that support kernel based <a class="indexterm" name="id319620"></a>oplocks
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567294"></a>
+
+kernel oplocks (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567296"></a><a name="KERNELOPLOCKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>For UNIXes that support kernel based <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#OPLOCKS">oplocks</a>
(currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter
allows the use of them to be turned on or off.</p><p>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <em class="parameter"><code>oplocks
</code></em> to be broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation
- accesses a file that <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has oplocked. This allows complete
+ accesses a file that <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has oplocked. This allows complete
data consistency between SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is
a <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> cool feature :-).</p><p>This parameter defaults to <code class="constant">on</code>, but is translated
to a no-op on systems that no not have the necessary kernel support.
You should never need to touch this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>kernel oplocks</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LANMANAUTH"></a>lanman auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567382"></a>
+
+lanman auth (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567383"></a><a name="LANMANAUTH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
authenticate users or permit password changes
using the LANMAN password hash. If disabled, only clients which support NT
password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000 clients, smbclient, but not
@@ -2104,8 +2575,11 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
permited. Not all clients support NTLMv2, and most will require
special configuration to use it.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lanman auth</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LARGEREADWRITE"></a>large readwrite (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> supports the new 64k
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567475"></a>
+
+large readwrite (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567476"></a><a name="LARGEREADWRITE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> supports the new 64k
streaming read and write varient SMB requests introduced with
Windows 2000. Note that due to Windows 2000 client redirector bugs
this requires Samba to be running on a 64-bit capable operating
@@ -2113,54 +2587,107 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
performance by 10% with Windows 2000 clients. Defaults to on. Not as
tested as some other Samba code paths.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>large readwrite</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPADMINDN"></a>ldap admin dn (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- The <a class="indexterm" name="id319828"></a>ldap admin dn defines the Distinguished Name (DN) name used by Samba to contact
- the ldap server when retreiving user account information. The <a class="indexterm" name="id319836"></a>ldap admin dn is used
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567531"></a>
+
+ldap admin dn (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567532"></a><a name="LDAPADMINDN"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a> defines the Distinguished Name (DN) name used by Samba to contact
+ the ldap server when retreiving user account information. The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a> is used
in conjunction with the admin dn password stored in the <code class="filename">private/secrets.tdb</code>
- file. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ file. See the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>
man page for more information on how to accomplish this.
</p><p>
- The <a class="indexterm" name="id319862"></a>ldap admin dn requires a fully specified DN. The <a class="indexterm" name="id319869"></a>ldap suffix is not appended to the <a class="indexterm" name="id319876"></a>ldap admin dn.
- </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPDELETEDN"></a>ldap delete dn (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This parameter specifies whether a delete
+ The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a> requires a fully specified DN. The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> is not appended to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a>.
+ </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567640"></a>
+
+ldap debug level (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567641"></a><a name="LDAPDEBUGLEVEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter controls the debug level of the LDAP library
+ calls. In the case of OpenLDAP, it is the same
+ bit-field as understood by the server and documented in the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="slapd.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">slapd.conf</span>(5)</span></a>
+ manpage.
+ A typical useful value will be
+ <span class="emphasis"><em>1</em></span> for tracing function calls.
+ </p><p>
+ The debug ouput from the LDAP libraries appears with the
+ prefix [LDAP] in Samba's logging output.
+ The level at which LDAP logging is printed is controlled by the
+ parameter <em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug threshold</code></em>.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug level</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug level</code></em> = <code class="literal">1</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567727"></a>
+
+ldap debug threshold (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567728"></a><a name="LDAPDEBUGTHRESHOLD"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter controls the Samba debug level at which
+ the ldap library debug output is
+ printed in the Samba logs. See the description of
+ <em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug level</code></em> for details.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug threshold</code></em> = <code class="literal">10</code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap debug threshold</code></em> = <code class="literal">5</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567794"></a>
+
+ldap delete dn (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567795"></a><a name="LDAPDELETEDN"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> This parameter specifies whether a delete
operation in the ldapsam deletes the complete entry or only the attributes
specific to Samba.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap delete dn</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPGROUPSUFFIX"></a>ldap group suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the suffix that is
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567838"></a>
+
+ldap group suffix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567839"></a><a name="LDAPGROUPSUFFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the suffix that is
used for groups when these are added to the LDAP directory.
- If this parameter is unset, the value of <a class="indexterm" name="id319950"></a>ldap suffix will be used instead. The suffix string is pre-pended to the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id319957"></a>ldap suffix string so use a partial DN.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap group suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+ If this parameter is unset, the value of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> will be used instead. The suffix string is pre-pended to the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> string so use a partial DN.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap group suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap group suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal">ou=Groups</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX"></a>ldap idmap suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2567921"></a>
+
+ldap idmap suffix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2567922"></a><a name="LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameters specifies the suffix that is used when storing idmap mappings. If this parameter
- is unset, the value of <a class="indexterm" name="id320020"></a>ldap suffix will be used instead. The suffix
- string is pre-pended to the <a class="indexterm" name="id320027"></a>ldap suffix string so use a partial DN.
+ is unset, the value of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> will be used instead. The suffix
+ string is pre-pended to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> string so use a partial DN.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap idmap suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap idmap suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal">ou=Idmap</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"></a>ldap machine suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568004"></a>
+
+ldap machine suffix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568005"></a><a name="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
It specifies where machines should be added to the ldap tree. If this parameter is unset, the value of
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320089"></a>ldap suffix will be used instead. The suffix string is pre-pended to the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320097"></a>ldap suffix string so use a partial DN.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> will be used instead. The suffix string is pre-pended to the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> string so use a partial DN.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap machine suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap machine suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal">ou=Computers</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"></a>ldap passwd sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568085"></a>
+
+ldap passwd sync (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568086"></a><a name="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option is used to define whether or not Samba should sync the LDAP password with the NT
and LM hashes for normal accounts (NOT for workstation, server or domain trusts) on a password
change via SAMBA.
</p><p>
- The <a class="indexterm" name="id320164"></a>ldap passwd sync can be set to one of three values:
+ The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPASSWDSYNC">ldap passwd sync</a> can be set to one of three values:
</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Yes</code></em> = Try
to update the LDAP, NT and LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>No</code></em> = Update NT and
LM passwords and update the pwdLastSet time.</p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Only</code></em> = Only update
the LDAP password and let the LDAP server do the rest.</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap passwd sync</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPREPLICATIONSLEEP"></a>ldap replication sleep (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568186"></a>
+
+ldap replication sleep (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568187"></a><a name="LDAPREPLICATIONSLEEP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
When Samba is asked to write to a read-only LDAP replica, we are redirected to talk to the read-write master server.
This server then replicates our changes back to the 'local' server, however the replication might take some seconds,
especially over slow links. Certain client activities, particularly domain joins, can become confused by the 'success'
@@ -2173,7 +2700,10 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
The value is specified in milliseconds, the maximum value is 5000 (5 seconds).
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap replication sleep</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSAM:EDITPOSIX"></a>ldapsam:editposix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568249"></a>
+
+ldapsam:editposix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568250"></a><a name="LDAPSAM:EDITPOSIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Editposix is an option that leverages ldapsam:trusted to make it simpler to manage a domain controller
eliminating the need to set up custom scripts to add and manage the posix users and groups. This option
will instead directly manipulate the ldap tree to create, remove and modify user and group entries.
@@ -2186,8 +2716,8 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
provision</code>. To run this command the ldap server must be running, Winindd must be running and
the smb.conf ldap options must be properly configured.
- The typical ldap setup used with the <a class="indexterm" name="id320317"></a>ldapsam:trusted = yes option
- is usually sufficient to use <a class="indexterm" name="id320325"></a>ldapsam:editposix = yes as well.
+ The typical ldap setup used with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSAM:TRUSTED">ldapsam:trusted = yes</a> option
+ is usually sufficient to use <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSAM:EDITPOSIX">ldapsam:editposix = yes</a> as well.
</p><p>
An example configuration can be the following:
@@ -2252,7 +2782,10 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldapsam:editposix</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSAM:TRUSTED"></a>ldapsam:trusted (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568376"></a>
+
+ldapsam:trusted (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568377"></a><a name="LDAPSAM:TRUSTED"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
By default, Samba as a Domain Controller with an LDAP backend needs to use the Unix-style NSS subsystem to
access user and group information. Due to the way Unix stores user information in /etc/passwd and /etc/group
this inevitably leads to inefficiencies. One important question a user needs to know is the list of groups he
@@ -2260,54 +2793,69 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
counterparts in LDAP. UNIX has optimized functions to enumerate group membership. Sadly, other functions that
are used to deal with user and group attributes lack such optimization.
</p><p>
- To make Samba scale well in large environments, the <a class="indexterm" name="id320404"></a>ldapsam:trusted = yes
+ To make Samba scale well in large environments, the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSAM:TRUSTED">ldapsam:trusted = yes</a>
option assumes that the complete user and group database that is relevant to Samba is stored in LDAP with the
standard posixAccount/posixGroup attributes. It further assumes that the Samba auxiliary object classes are
stored together with the POSIX data in the same LDAP object. If these assumptions are met,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320414"></a>ldapsam:trusted = yes can be activated and Samba can bypass the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSAM:TRUSTED">ldapsam:trusted = yes</a> can be activated and Samba can bypass the
NSS system to query user group memberships. Optimized LDAP queries can greatly speed up domain logon and
administration tasks. Depending on the size of the LDAP database a factor of 100 or more for common queries
is easily achieved.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldapsam:trusted</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSSL"></a>ldap ssl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether or not Samba should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568475"></a>
+
+ldap ssl (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568476"></a><a name="LDAPSSL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether or not Samba should
use SSL when connecting to the ldap server
This is <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> related to
Samba's previous SSL support which was enabled by specifying the
<code class="literal">--with-ssl</code> option to the <code class="filename">configure</code>
- script.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id320482"></a>ldap ssl can be set to one of three values:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Off</code></em> = Never
+ script.</p><p>The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSSL">ldap ssl</a> can be set to one of three values:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Off</code></em> = Never
use SSL when querying the directory.</p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>Start_tls</code></em> = Use
the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation (RFC2830) for
communicating with the directory server.</p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>On</code></em> = Use SSL
on the ldaps port when contacting the <em class="parameter"><code>ldap server</code></em>. Only available when the
backwards-compatiblity <code class="literal">--with-ldapsam</code> option is specified
- to configure. See <a class="indexterm" name="id320538"></a>passdb backend</p>.
+ to configure. See <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND">passdb backend</a></p>.
</li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap ssl</code></em> = <code class="literal">start_tls</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPSUFFIX"></a>ldap suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the base for all ldap suffixes and for storing the sambaDomain object.</p><p>
- The ldap suffix will be appended to the values specified for the <a class="indexterm" name="id320590"></a>ldap user suffix,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320597"></a>ldap group suffix, <a class="indexterm" name="id320604"></a>ldap machine suffix, and the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320612"></a>ldap idmap suffix. Each of these should be given only a DN relative to the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320619"></a>ldap suffix.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568614"></a>
+
+ldap suffix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568615"></a><a name="LDAPSUFFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies the base for all ldap suffixes and for storing the sambaDomain object.</p><p>
+ The ldap suffix will be appended to the values specified for the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPUSERSUFFIX">ldap user suffix</a>,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPGROUPSUFFIX">ldap group suffix</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPMACHINESUFFIX">ldap machine suffix</a>, and the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX">ldap idmap suffix</a>. Each of these should be given only a DN relative to the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal">dc=samba,dc=org</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPTIMEOUT"></a>ldap timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568737"></a>
+
+ldap timeout (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568738"></a><a name="LDAPTIMEOUT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
When Samba connects to an ldap server that servermay be down or unreachable. To prevent Samba from hanging whilst
waiting for the connection this parameter specifies in seconds how long Samba should wait before failing the
connect. The default is to only wait fifteen seconds for the ldap server to respond to the connect request.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">15</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"></a>ldap user suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568783"></a>
+
+ldap user suffix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568784"></a><a name="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies where users are added to the tree. If this parameter is unset,
- the value of <a class="indexterm" name="id320721"></a>ldap suffix will be used instead. The suffix
- string is pre-pended to the <a class="indexterm" name="id320729"></a>ldap suffix string so use a partial DN.
+ the value of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> will be used instead. The suffix
+ string is pre-pended to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</a> string so use a partial DN.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap user suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ldap user suffix</code></em> = <code class="literal">ou=people</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"></a>level2 oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether Samba supports
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568865"></a>
+
+level2 oplocks (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568866"></a><a name="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether Samba supports
level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</p><p>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients
that have an oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock
to a read-only oplock once a second client opens the file (instead
@@ -2321,13 +2869,16 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and
delete any read-ahead caches.</p><p>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on to
speed access to shared executables.</p><p>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.</p><p>
- Currently, if <a class="indexterm" name="id320816"></a>kernel oplocks are supported then
+ Currently, if <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#KERNELOPLOCKS">kernel oplocks</a> are supported then
level2 oplocks are not granted (even if this parameter is set to
- <code class="constant">yes</code>). Note also, the <a class="indexterm" name="id320827"></a>oplocks
+ <code class="constant">yes</code>). Note also, the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#OPLOCKS">oplocks</a>
parameter must be set to <code class="constant">yes</code> on this share in order for
this parameter to have any effect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>level2 oplocks</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LMANNOUNCE"></a>lm announce (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will produce Lanman announce
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2568972"></a>
+
+lm announce (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2568973"></a><a name="LMANNOUNCE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will produce Lanman announce
broadcasts that are needed by OS/2 clients in order for them to see
the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter can have three
values, <code class="constant">yes</code>, <code class="constant">no</code>, or
@@ -2335,30 +2886,39 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
If set to <code class="constant">no</code> Samba will never produce these
broadcasts. If set to <code class="constant">yes</code> Samba will produce
Lanman announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320908"></a>lm interval. If set to <code class="constant">auto</code>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LMINTERVAL">lm interval</a>. If set to <code class="constant">auto</code>
Samba will not send Lanman announce broadcasts by default but will
listen for them. If it hears such a broadcast on the wire it will
then start sending them at a frequency set by the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320920"></a>lm interval.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lm announce</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LMINTERVAL">lm interval</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lm announce</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lm announce</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LMINTERVAL"></a>lm interval (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569094"></a>
+
+lm interval (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569095"></a><a name="LMINTERVAL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce
broadcasts needed by OS/2 clients (see the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id320983"></a>lm announce parameter) then this
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LMANNOUNCE">lm announce</a> parameter) then this
parameter defines the frequency in seconds with which they will be
made. If this is set to zero then no Lanman announcements will be
- made despite the setting of the <a class="indexterm" name="id320992"></a>lm announce
+ made despite the setting of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LMANNOUNCE">lm announce</a>
parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lm interval</code></em> = <code class="literal">60</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lm interval</code></em> = <code class="literal">120</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOADPRINTERS"></a>load printers (G)</span></dt><dd><p>A boolean variable that controls whether all
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569179"></a>
+
+load printers (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569180"></a><a name="LOADPRINTERS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>A boolean variable that controls whether all
printers in the printcap will be loaded for browsing by default.
- See the <a class="indexterm" name="id321055"></a>printers section for
+ See the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTERS">printers</a> section for
more details.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>load printers</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCALMASTER"></a>local master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to try and become a local master browser
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569234"></a>
+
+local master (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569235"></a><a name="LOCALMASTER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to try and become a local master browser
on a subnet. If set to <code class="constant">no</code> then <code class="literal">
nmbd</code> will not attempt to become a local master browser
on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By
@@ -2368,9 +2928,12 @@ Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Defa
will <span class="emphasis"><em>participate</em></span> in elections for local master browser.</p><p>Setting this value to <code class="constant">no</code> will cause <code class="literal">nmbd</code> <span class="emphasis"><em>never</em></span> to become a local
master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>local master</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKDIR"></a>lock dir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for lock directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKDIRECTORY"></a>lock directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the directory where lock
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569335"></a><a name="LOCKDIR"></a>lock dir</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569336"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#LOCKDIRECTORY">lock directory</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569366"></a>
+
+lock directory (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569367"></a><a name="LOCKDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the directory where lock
files will be placed. The lock files are used to implement the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id321217"></a>max connections option.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAXCONNECTIONS">max connections</a> option.
</p><p>
Note: This option can not be set inside registry
configurations.
@@ -2378,7 +2941,10 @@ master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter">
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lock directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">/var/run/samba/locks</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKING"></a>locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether or not locking will be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569445"></a>
+
+locking (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569446"></a><a name="LOCKING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether or not locking will be
performed by the server in response to lock requests from the
client.</p><p>If <code class="literal">locking = no</code>, all lock and unlock
requests will appear to succeed and all lock queries will report
@@ -2388,37 +2954,54 @@ master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter">
CDROM drives), although setting this parameter of <code class="constant">no</code>
is not really recommended even in this case.</p><p>Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a
specific service, as lack of locking may result in data corruption.
- You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINCOUNT"></a>lock spin count (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter has been made inoperative in Samba 3.0.24.
+ You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569521"></a>
+
+lock spin count (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569522"></a><a name="LOCKSPINCOUNT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter has been made inoperative in Samba 3.0.24.
The functionality it contolled is now controlled by the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id321351"></a>lock spin time.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCKSPINTIME">lock spin time</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lock spin count</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINTIME"></a>lock spin time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The time in microseconds that smbd should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569577"></a>
+
+lock spin time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569578"></a><a name="LOCKSPINTIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The time in microseconds that smbd should
keep waiting to see if a failed lock request can
be granted. This parameter has changed in default
value from Samba 3.0.23 from 10 to 200. The associated
- <a class="indexterm" name="id321399"></a>lock spin count parameter is
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCKSPINCOUNT">lock spin count</a> parameter is
no longer used in Samba 3.0.24. You should not need
to change the value of this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lock spin time</code></em> = <code class="literal">200</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGFILE"></a>log file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569635"></a>
+
+log file (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569636"></a><a name="LOGFILE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option allows you to override the name of the Samba log file (also known as the debug file).
</p><p>
This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have separate log files for each user or machine.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>log file</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/var/log.%m</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGLEVEL"></a>debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for log level.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGLEVEL"></a>log level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569687"></a><a name="DEBUGLEVEL"></a>debuglevel</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569688"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#LOGLEVEL">log level</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569717"></a>
+
+log level (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569718"></a><a name="LOGLEVEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
The value of the parameter (a astring) allows the debug level (logging level) to be specified in the
- <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file. This parameter has been extended since the 2.2.x
- series, now it allow to specify the debug level for multiple debug classes. This is to give greater
- flexibility in the configuration of the system.
- </p><p>
- The default will be the log level specified on the command line or level zero if none was specified.
- </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>log level</code></em> = <code class="literal">3 passdb:5 auth:10 winbind:2</code>
+ <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
+ </p><p>This parameter has been extended since the 2.2.x
+ series, now it allows to specify the debug level for multiple
+ debug classes. This is to give greater flexibility in the configuration
+ of the system. The following debug classes are currently implemented:
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>all</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>tdb</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>printdrivers</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>lanman</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>smb</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>rpc_parse</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>rpc_srv</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>rpc_cli</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>passdb</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>sam</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>auth</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>winbind</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>vfs</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>idmap</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>quota</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>acls</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>locking</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>msdfs</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>dmapi</code></em></p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>registry</code></em></p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>log level</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONDRIVE"></a>logon drive (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>log level</code></em> = <code class="literal">3 passdb:5 auth:10 winbind:2</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2569950"></a>
+
+logon drive (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2569951"></a><a name="LOGONDRIVE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the local path to which the home directory will be
- connected (see <a class="indexterm" name="id321570"></a>logon home) and is only used by NT
+ connected (see <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME">logon home</a>) and is only used by NT
Workstations.
</p><p>
Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon server.
@@ -2426,7 +3009,10 @@ master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter">
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>logon drive</code></em> = <code class="literal">h:</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONHOME"></a>logon home (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570024"></a>
+
+logon home (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570025"></a><a name="LOGONHOME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the home directory location when a Win95/98 or NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC.
It allows you to do
</p><p>
@@ -2445,23 +3031,26 @@ master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter">
in a NetUserGetInfo request. Win9X clients truncate the info to \\server\share when a user does
<code class="literal">net use /home</code> but use the whole string when dealing with profiles.
</p><p>
- Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <a class="indexterm" name="id321687"></a>logon path was returned rather than
+ Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH">logon path</a> was returned rather than
<em class="parameter"><code>logon home</code></em>. This broke <code class="literal">net use /home</code>
but allowed profiles outside the home directory. The current implementation is correct, and can be used for
profiles if you use the above trick.
</p><p>
- Disable this feature by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id321711"></a>logon home = "" - using the empty string.
+ Disable this feature by setting <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME">logon home = ""</a> - using the empty string.
</p><p>
This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon server.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>logon home</code></em> = <code class="literal">\\%N\%U</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>logon home</code></em> = <code class="literal">\\remote_smb_server\%U</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONPATH"></a>logon path (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570189"></a>
+
+logon path (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570190"></a><a name="LOGONPATH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the directory where roaming profiles (Desktop, NTuser.dat, etc) are
stored. Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has nothing to do with Win 9X roaming
profiles. To find out how to handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id321780"></a>logon home parameter.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME">logon home</a> parameter.
</p><p>
This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have separate logon scripts for each user or
machine. It also specifies the directory from which the "Application Data", <code class="filename">desktop</code>, <code class="filename">start menu</code>, <code class="filename">network neighborhood</code>, <code class="filename">programs</code> and other
@@ -2490,7 +3079,7 @@ master browser.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter">
provided system tool).
</p></div><p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a domain controller.</p><p>
Disable the use of roaming profiles by setting the value of this parameter to the empty string. For
- example, <a class="indexterm" name="id321857"></a>logon path = "". Take note that even if the default setting
+ example, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH">logon path = ""</a>. Take note that even if the default setting
in the smb.conf file is the empty string, any value specified in the user account settings in the passdb
backend will over-ride the effect of setting this parameter to null. Disabling of all roaming profile use
requires that the user account settings must also be blank.
@@ -2501,13 +3090,16 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>logon path</code></em> = <code class="literal">\\%N\%U\profile</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONSCRIPT"></a>logon script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570357"></a>
+
+logon script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570358"></a><a name="LOGONSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the batch file (<code class="filename">.bat</code>) or NT command file
(<code class="filename">.cmd</code>) to be downloaded and run on a machine when a user successfully logs in. The file
must contain the DOS style CR/LF line endings. Using a DOS-style editor to create the file is recommended.
</p><p>
The script must be a relative path to the <em class="parameter"><code>[netlogon]</code></em> service. If the [netlogon]
- service specifies a <a class="indexterm" name="id321939"></a>path of <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/netlogon</code>, and <a class="indexterm" name="id321952"></a>logon script = STARTUP.BAT, then the file that will be downloaded is:
+ service specifies a <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path</a> of <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/netlogon</code>, and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT">logon script = STARTUP.BAT</a>, then the file that will be downloaded is:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT
</pre><p>
@@ -2532,7 +3124,10 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>logon script</code></em> = <code class="literal">scripts\%U.bat</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPPAUSECOMMAND"></a>lppause command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570527"></a>
+
+lppause command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570528"></a><a name="LPPAUSECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to stop printing or spooling
a specific print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
a printer name and job number to pause the print job. One way
@@ -2547,7 +3142,7 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
will have the SPOOLED or PRINTING status.</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
in the lppause command as the PATH may not be available to the server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lppause command</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# Currently no default value is given to
- this string, unless the value of the <a class="indexterm" name="id322120"></a>printing
+ this string, unless the value of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a>
parameter is <code class="constant">SYSV</code>, in which case the default is :
<code class="literal">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</code> or if the value of the
<em class="parameter"><code>printing</code></em> parameter is
@@ -2556,7 +3151,10 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lppause command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPQCACHETIME"></a>lpq cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls how long lpq info will be cached
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570675"></a>
+
+lpq cache time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570676"></a><a name="LPQCACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls how long lpq info will be cached
for to prevent the <code class="literal">lpq</code> command being called too
often. A separate cache is kept for each variation of the <code class="literal">
lpq</code> command used by the system, so if you use different
@@ -2569,7 +3167,10 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lpq cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">10</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPQCOMMAND"></a>lpq command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570794"></a>
+
+lpq command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570795"></a><a name="LPQCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to obtain <code class="literal">lpq
</code>-style printer status information.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which
takes a printer name as its only parameter and outputs printer
@@ -2591,20 +3192,26 @@ logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lpq command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/lpq -P%p</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPRESUMECOMMAND"></a>lpresume command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2570920"></a>
+
+lpresume command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2570921"></a><a name="LPRESUMECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to restart or continue
printing or spooling a specific print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
a printer name and job number to resume the print job. See
- also the <a class="indexterm" name="id322423"></a>lppause command parameter.</p><p>If a <em class="parameter"><code>%p</code></em> is given then the printer name
+ also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LPPAUSECOMMAND">lppause command</a> parameter.</p><p>If a <em class="parameter"><code>%p</code></em> is given then the printer name
is put in its place. A <em class="parameter"><code>%j</code></em> is replaced with
the job number (an integer).</p><p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
in the <em class="parameter"><code>lpresume command</code></em> as the PATH may not
- be available to the server.</p><p>See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id322460"></a>printing parameter.</p><p>Default: Currently no default value is given
+ be available to the server.</p><p>See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a> parameter.</p><p>Default: Currently no default value is given
to this string, unless the value of the <em class="parameter"><code>printing</code></em>
- parameter is <code class="constant">SYSV</code>, in which case the default is :</p><p><code class="literal">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</code></p><p>or if the value of the <em class="parameter"><code>printing</code></em> parameter
- is <code class="constant">SOFTQ</code>, then the default is:</p><p><code class="literal">qstat -s -j%j -r</code></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lpresume command</code></em> = <code class="literal">lpresume command = /usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p2</code>
+ parameter is <code class="constant">SYSV</code>, in which case the default is:</p><p><code class="literal">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</code></p><p>or if the value of the <em class="parameter"><code>printing</code></em> parameter
+ is <code class="constant">SOFTQ</code>, then the default is:</p><p><code class="literal">qstat -s -j%j -r</code></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lpresume command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p2</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LPRMCOMMAND"></a>lprm command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571073"></a>
+
+lprm command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571074"></a><a name="LPRMCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to delete a print job.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
a printer name and job number, and deletes the print job.</p><p>If a <em class="parameter"><code>%p</code></em> is given then the printer name
is put in its place. A <em class="parameter"><code>%j</code></em> is replaced with
@@ -2621,32 +3228,41 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>lprm command</code></em> = <code class="literal"> determined by printing parameter</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"></a>machine password timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- If a Samba server is a member of a Windows NT Domain (see the <a class="indexterm" name="id322626"></a>security = domain parameter) then periodically a running smbd process will try and change
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571160"></a>
+
+machine password timeout (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571161"></a><a name="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ If a Samba server is a member of a Windows NT Domain (see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = domain</a> parameter) then periodically a running smbd process will try and change
the MACHINE ACCOUNT PASSWORD stored in the TDB called <code class="filename">private/secrets.tdb
</code>. This parameter specifies how often this password will be changed, in seconds. The default is one
week (expressed in seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member server.
</p><p>
- See also <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>,
- and the <a class="indexterm" name="id322653"></a>security = domain parameter.
+ See also <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>,
+ and the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = domain</a> parameter.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>machine password timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">604800</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAGICOUTPUT"></a>magic output (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571247"></a>
+
+magic output (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571248"></a><a name="MAGICOUTPUT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the name of a file which will contain output created by a magic script (see the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id322699"></a>magic script parameter below).
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAGICSCRIPT">magic script</a> parameter below).
</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>If two clients use the same <em class="parameter"><code>magic script
</code></em> in the same directory the output file content is undefined.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>magic output</code></em> = <code class="literal">&lt;magic script name&gt;.out</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>magic output</code></em> = <code class="literal">myfile.txt</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAGICSCRIPT"></a>magic script (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a file which,
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571331"></a>
+
+magic script (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571332"></a><a name="MAGICSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the name of a file which,
if opened, will be executed by the server when the file is closed.
This allows a UNIX script to be sent to the Samba host and
executed on behalf of the connected user.</p><p>Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon
completion assuming that the user has the appropriate level
of privilege and the file permissions allow the deletion.</p><p>If the script generates output, output will be sent to
- the file specified by the <a class="indexterm" name="id322784"></a>magic output
+ the file specified by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAGICOUTPUT">magic output</a>
parameter (see above).</p><p>Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts
containing CR/LF instead of CR as
the end-of-line marker. Magic scripts must be executable
@@ -2656,30 +3272,12 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>magic script</code></em> = <code class="literal">user.csh</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDMAP"></a>mangled map (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This is for those who want to directly map UNIX file names which cannot be represented on
- Windows/DOS. The mangling of names is not always what is needed. In particular you may have
- documents with file extensions that differ between DOS and UNIX.
- For example, under UNIX it is common to use <code class="filename">.html</code>
- for HTML files, whereas under Windows/DOS <code class="filename">.htm</code>
- is more commonly used.
- </p><p>
- So to map <code class="filename">html</code> to <code class="filename">htm</code>
- you would use:
- </p><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id322898"></a>mangled map = (*.html *.htm).
- </p><p>
- One very useful case is to remove the annoying <code class="filename">;1</code> off
- the ends of filenames on some CDROMs (only visible under some UNIXes). To do this use a map of
- (*;1 *;).
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangled map</code></em> = <code class="literal">
-# no mangled map</code>
-</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangled map</code></em> = <code class="literal">(*;1 *;)</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDNAMES"></a>mangled names (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571437"></a>
+
+mangled names (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571438"></a><a name="MANGLEDNAMES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX
should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible,
- or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</p><p>See the section on <a class="indexterm" name="id322975"></a>name mangling for
+ or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</p><p>See the section on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING">name mangling</a> for
details on how to control the mangling process.</p><p>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters
before the rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced
to upper case, and appear as the first (up to) five characters
@@ -2689,7 +3287,7 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation
only if it contains any upper case characters or is longer than three
characters.</p><p>Note that the character to use may be specified using
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id323009"></a>mangling char
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MANGLINGCHAR">mangling char</a>
option, if you don't like '~'.</p></li><li><p>Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be
presented as DOS hidden files. The mangled name will be created as
for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as
@@ -2702,7 +3300,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
from Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names
do not change between sessions.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangled names</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEPREFIX"></a>mangle prefix (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the number of prefix
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571574"></a>
+
+mangle prefix (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571575"></a><a name="MANGLEPREFIX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> controls the number of prefix
characters from the original name used when generating
the mangled names. A larger value will give a weaker
hash and therefore more name collisions. The minimum
@@ -2712,14 +3313,20 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangle prefix</code></em> = <code class="literal">4</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGCHAR"></a>mangling char (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what character is used as
- the <span class="emphasis"><em>magic</em></span> character in <a class="indexterm" name="id323146"></a>name mangling. The
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571640"></a>
+
+mangling char (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571641"></a><a name="MANGLINGCHAR"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls what character is used as
+ the <span class="emphasis"><em>magic</em></span> character in <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING">name mangling</a>. The
default is a '~' but this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set
it to whatever you prefer. This is effective only when mangling method is hash.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangling char</code></em> = <code class="literal">~</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangling char</code></em> = <code class="literal">^</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGMETHOD"></a>mangling method (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the algorithm used for the generating
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571718"></a>
+
+mangling method (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571719"></a><a name="MANGLINGMETHOD"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> controls the algorithm used for the generating
the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and
"hash2". "hash" is the algorithm that was used
used in Samba for many years and was the default in Samba 2.2.x "hash2" is
@@ -2730,7 +3337,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>mangling method</code></em> = <code class="literal">hash</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPACLINHERIT"></a>map acl inherit (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map the 'inherit' and 'protected'
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571784"></a>
+
+map acl inherit (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571785"></a><a name="MAPACLINHERIT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map the 'inherit' and 'protected'
access control entry flags stored in Windows ACLs into an extended attribute
called user.SAMBA_PAI. This parameter only takes effect if Samba is being run
on a platform that supports extended attributes (Linux and IRIX so far) and
@@ -2738,7 +3348,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
POSIX ACL mapping code.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>map acl inherit</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPARCHIVE"></a>map archive (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571841"></a>
+
+map archive (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571842"></a><a name="MAPARCHIVE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls whether the DOS archive attribute
should be mapped to the UNIX owner execute bit. The DOS archive bit
is set when a file has been modified since its last backup. One
@@ -2746,23 +3359,29 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
any file it touches from becoming executable under UNIX. This can
be quite annoying for shared source code, documents, etc...
</p><p>
- Note that this requires the <a class="indexterm" name="id323326"></a>create mask parameter to be set such that owner
+ Note that this requires the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a> parameter to be set such that owner
execute bit is not masked out (i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id323334"></a>create mask for details.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a> for details.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>map archive</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPHIDDEN"></a>map hidden (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571923"></a>
+
+map hidden (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571924"></a><a name="MAPHIDDEN"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls whether DOS style hidden files should be mapped to the UNIX world execute bit.
</p><p>
- Note that this requires the <a class="indexterm" name="id323384"></a>create mask to be set such that the world execute
- bit is not masked out (i.e. it must include 001). See the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id323392"></a>create mask
+ Note that this requires the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a> to be set such that the world execute
+ bit is not masked out (i.e. it must include 001). See the parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a>
for details.
- </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPREADONLY"></a>map read only (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2571981"></a>
+
+map read only (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2571982"></a><a name="MAPREADONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls how the DOS read only attribute should be mapped from a UNIX filesystem.
</p><p>
- This parameter can take three different values, which tell <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> how to display the read only attribute on files, where either
- <a class="indexterm" name="id323437"></a>store dos attributes is set to <code class="constant">No</code>, or no extended attribute is
- present. If <a class="indexterm" name="id323448"></a>store dos attributes is set to <code class="constant">yes</code> then this
+ This parameter can take three different values, which tell <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> how to display the read only attribute on files, where either
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#STOREDOSATTRIBUTES">store dos attributes</a> is set to <code class="constant">No</code>, or no extended attribute is
+ present. If <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#STOREDOSATTRIBUTES">store dos attributes</a> is set to <code class="constant">yes</code> then this
parameter is <span class="emphasis"><em>ignored</em></span>. This is a new parameter introduced in Samba version 3.0.21.
</p><p>The three settings are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
<code class="constant">Yes</code> - The read only DOS attribute is mapped to the inverse of the user
@@ -2770,35 +3389,41 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
read only attribute is reported as being set on the file.
</p></li><li><p>
<code class="constant">Permissions</code> - The read only DOS attribute is mapped to the effective permissions of
- the connecting user, as evaluated by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> by reading the unix permissions and POSIX ACL (if present).
+ the connecting user, as evaluated by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> by reading the unix permissions and POSIX ACL (if present).
If the connecting user does not have permission to modify the file, the read only attribute
is reported as being set on the file.
</p></li><li><p>
<code class="constant">No</code> - The read only DOS attribute is unaffected by permissions, and can only be set by
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id323505"></a>store dos attributes method. This may be useful for exporting mounted CDs.
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#STOREDOSATTRIBUTES">store dos attributes</a> method. This may be useful for exporting mounted CDs.
</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>map read only</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPSYSTEM"></a>map system (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572134"></a>
+
+map system (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572135"></a><a name="MAPSYSTEM"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls whether DOS style system files should be mapped to the UNIX group execute bit.
</p><p>
- Note that this requires the <a class="indexterm" name="id323556"></a>create mask to be set such that the group
+ Note that this requires the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a> to be set such that the group
execute bit is not masked out (i.e. it must include 010). See the parameter
- <a class="indexterm" name="id323564"></a>create mask for details.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</a> for details.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>map system</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAPTOGUEST"></a>map to guest (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only useful in <a class="indexterm" name="id323609"></a>SECURITY =
- security modes other than <em class="parameter"><code>security = share</code></em>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572203"></a>
+
+map to guest (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572204"></a><a name="MAPTOGUEST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only useful in <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">SECURITY =
+ security</a> modes other than <em class="parameter"><code>security = share</code></em>
and <em class="parameter"><code>security = server</code></em>
- i.e. <code class="constant">user</code>, and <code class="constant">domain</code>.</p><p>This parameter can take four different values, which tell
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> what to do with user
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> what to do with user
login requests that don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.</p><p>The four settings are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">Never</code> - Means user login
requests with an invalid password are rejected. This is the
default.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">Bad User</code> - Means user
logins with an invalid password are rejected, unless the username
does not exist, in which case it is treated as a guest login and
- mapped into the <a class="indexterm" name="id323673"></a>guest account.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">Bad Password</code> - Means user logins
+ mapped into the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">Bad Password</code> - Means user logins
with an invalid password are treated as a guest login and mapped
- into the <a class="indexterm" name="id323690"></a>guest account. Note that
+ into the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>. Note that
this can cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing
their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and
will not know the reason they cannot access files they think
@@ -2828,15 +3453,21 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>map to guest</code></em> = <code class="literal">Bad User</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXCONNECTIONS"></a>max connections (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service to be limited.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572442"></a>
+
+max connections (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572444"></a><a name="MAXCONNECTIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service to be limited.
If <em class="parameter"><code>max connections</code></em> is greater than 0 then connections
will be refused if this number of connections to the service are already open. A value
of zero mean an unlimited number of connections may be made.</p><p>Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The lock files will be stored in
- the directory specified by the <a class="indexterm" name="id323827"></a>lock directory option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max connections</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
+ the directory specified by the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCKDIRECTORY">lock directory</a> option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max connections</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max connections</code></em> = <code class="literal">10</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXDISKSIZE"></a>max disk size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to put an upper limit
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572528"></a>
+
+max disk size (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572530"></a><a name="MAXDISKSIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to put an upper limit
on the apparent size of disks. If you set this option to 100
then all shares will appear to be not larger than 100 MB in
size.</p><p>Note that this option does not limit the amount of
@@ -2850,7 +3481,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max disk size</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXLOGSIZE"></a>max log size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572620"></a>
+
+max log size (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572621"></a><a name="MAXLOGSIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies the max size the log file should grow to.
Samba periodically checks the size and if it is exceeded it will rename the file, adding
a <code class="filename">.old</code> extension.
@@ -2859,26 +3493,38 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max log size</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXMUX"></a>max mux (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum number of
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572692"></a>
+
+max mux (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572693"></a><a name="MAXMUX"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum number of
outstanding simultaneous SMB operations that Samba tells the client
it will allow. You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max mux</code></em> = <code class="literal">50</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXOPENFILES"></a>max open files (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of
- open files that one <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> file
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572735"></a>
+
+max open files (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572736"></a><a name="MAXOPENFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of
+ open files that one <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> file
serving process may have open for a client at any one time. The
default for this parameter is set very high (10,000) as Samba uses
only one bit per unopened file.</p><p>The limit of the number of open files is usually set
by the UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than
this parameter so you should never need to touch this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max open files</code></em> = <code class="literal">10000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPRINTJOBS"></a>max print jobs (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572795"></a>
+
+max print jobs (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572796"></a><a name="MAXPRINTJOBS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of
jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment.
- If this number is exceeded, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.
+ If this number is exceeded, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max print jobs</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max print jobs</code></em> = <code class="literal">5000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROTOCOL"></a>protocol</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for max protocol.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPROTOCOL"></a>max protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572865"></a><a name="PROTOCOL"></a>protocol</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572866"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#MAXPROTOCOL">max protocol</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2572896"></a>
+
+max protocol (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2572898"></a><a name="MAXPROTOCOL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest
protocol level that will be supported by the server.</p><p>Possible values are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">CORE</code>: Earliest version. No
concept of user names.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">COREPLUS</code>: Slight improvements on
CORE for efficiency.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">LANMAN1</code>: First <span class="emphasis"><em>
@@ -2890,7 +3536,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max protocol</code></em> = <code class="literal">LANMAN1</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXREPORTEDPRINTJOBS"></a>max reported print jobs (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573021"></a>
+
+max reported print jobs (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573022"></a><a name="MAXREPORTEDPRINTJOBS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter limits the maximum number of jobs displayed in a port monitor for
Samba printer queue at any given moment. If this number is exceeded, the excess
jobs will not be shown. A value of zero means there is no limit on the number of
@@ -2899,15 +3548,21 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max reported print jobs</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"></a>max smbd processes (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes concurrently running on a system and is intended
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573085"></a>
+
+max smbd processes (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573086"></a><a name="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes concurrently running on a system and is intended
as a stopgap to prevent degrading service to clients in the event that the server has insufficient
resources to handle more than this number of connections. Remember that under normal operating
- conditions, each user will have an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> associated with him or her to handle connections to all
+ conditions, each user will have an <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> associated with him or her to handle connections to all
shares from a given host.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max smbd processes</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max smbd processes</code></em> = <code class="literal">1000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXSTATCACHESIZE"></a>max stat cache size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the size in memory of any
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573166"></a>
+
+max stat cache size (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573168"></a><a name="MAXSTATCACHESIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the size in memory of any
<em class="parameter"><code>stat cache</code></em> being used
to speed up case insensitive name mappings. This parameter is
the number of kilobyte (1024) units the stat cache can use.
@@ -2917,18 +3572,27 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max stat cache size</code></em> = <code class="literal">100</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXTTL"></a>max ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> what the default 'time to live'
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573240"></a>
+
+max ttl (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573242"></a><a name="MAXTTL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> what the default 'time to live'
of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds) when <code class="literal">nmbd</code> is
requesting a name using either a broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should
never need to change this parameter. The default is 3 days.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max ttl</code></em> = <code class="literal">259200</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXWINSTTL"></a>max wins ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server
- (<a class="indexterm" name="id324595"></a>wins support = yes) what the maximum
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573299"></a>
+
+max wins ttl (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573300"></a><a name="MAXWINSTTL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when acting as a WINS server
+ (<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT">wins support = yes</a>) what the maximum
'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <code class="literal">nmbd</code>
will grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
parameter. The default is 6 days (518400 seconds).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max wins ttl</code></em> = <code class="literal">518400</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXXMIT"></a>max xmit (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum packet size
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573370"></a>
+
+max xmit (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573371"></a><a name="MAXXMIT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum packet size
that will be negotiated by Samba. The default is 16644, which
matches the behavior of Windows 2000. A value below 2048 is likely to cause problems.
You should never need to change this parameter from its default value.
@@ -2936,7 +3600,10 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>max xmit</code></em> = <code class="literal">8192</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MESSAGECOMMAND"></a>message command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies what command to run when the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573433"></a>
+
+message command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573434"></a><a name="MESSAGECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies what command to run when the
server receives a WinPopup style message.</p><p>This would normally be a command that would
deliver the message somehow. How this is to be done is
up to your imagination.</p><p>An example is:
@@ -2975,26 +3642,35 @@ lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>message command</code></em> = <code class="literal">csh -c 'xedit %s; rm %s' &amp;</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPRINTSPACE"></a>min print space (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This sets the minimum amount of free disk
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573643"></a>
+
+min print space (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573644"></a><a name="MINPRINTSPACE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This sets the minimum amount of free disk
space that must be available before a user will be able to spool
a print job. It is specified in kilobytes. The default is 0, which
means a user can always spool a print job.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min print space</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min print space</code></em> = <code class="literal">2000</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINPROTOCOL"></a>min protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573705"></a>
+
+min protocol (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573706"></a><a name="MINPROTOCOL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the
lowest SMB protocol dialect than Samba will support. Please refer
- to the <a class="indexterm" name="id324954"></a>max protocol
+ to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAXPROTOCOL">max protocol</a>
parameter for a list of valid protocol names and a brief description
of each. You may also wish to refer to the C source code in
<code class="filename">source/smbd/negprot.c</code> for a listing of known protocol
dialects supported by clients.</p><p>If you are viewing this parameter as a security measure, you should
- also refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id324973"></a>lanman auth parameter. Otherwise, you should never need
+ also refer to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LANMANAUTH">lanman auth</a> parameter. Otherwise, you should never need
to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min protocol</code></em> = <code class="literal">CORE</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min protocol</code></em> = <code class="literal">NT1</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINRECEIVEFILESIZE"></a>min receivefile size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option changes the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when processing SMBwriteX calls. Any incoming
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573803"></a>
+
+min receivefile size (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573804"></a><a name="MINRECEIVEFILESIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option changes the behavior of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when processing SMBwriteX calls. Any incoming
SMBwriteX call on a non-signed SMB/CIFS connection greater than this value will not be processed in the normal way but will
be passed to any underlying kernel recvfile or splice system call (if there is no such
call Samba will emulate in user space). This allows zero-copy writes directly from network
@@ -3003,21 +3679,30 @@ but user testing is recommended. If set to zero Samba processes SMBwriteX calls
normal way. To enable POSIX large write support (SMB/CIFS writes up to 16Mb) this option must be
nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently set to 128k.</p><p>Note this option will have NO EFFECT if set on a SMB signed connection.</p><p>The default is zero, which diables this option.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min receivefile size</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MINWINSTTL"></a>min wins ttl (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>
- when acting as a WINS server (<a class="indexterm" name="id325104"></a>wins support = yes) what the minimum 'time to live'
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573872"></a>
+
+min wins ttl (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573873"></a><a name="MINWINSTTL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option tells <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ when acting as a WINS server (<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT">wins support = yes</a>) what the minimum 'time to live'
of NetBIOS names that <code class="literal">nmbd</code> will grant will be (in
seconds). You should never need to change this parameter. The default
is 6 hours (21600 seconds).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>min wins ttl</code></em> = <code class="literal">21600</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MSDFSPROXY"></a>msdfs proxy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter indicates that the share is a
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2573942"></a>
+
+msdfs proxy (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2573944"></a><a name="MSDFSPROXY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter indicates that the share is a
stand-in for another CIFS share whose location is specified by
the value of the parameter. When clients attempt to connect to
this share, they are redirected to the proxied share using
the SMB-Dfs protocol.</p><p>Only Dfs roots can act as proxy shares. Take a look at the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id325163"></a>msdfs root and <a class="indexterm" name="id325170"></a>host msdfs
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT">msdfs root</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS">host msdfs</a>
options to find out how to set up a Dfs root share.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>msdfs proxy</code></em> = <code class="literal">\otherserver\someshare</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MSDFSROOT"></a>msdfs root (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, Samba treats the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574021"></a>
+
+msdfs root (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574022"></a><a name="MSDFSROOT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, Samba treats the
share as a Dfs root and allows clients to browse the
distributed file system tree rooted at the share directory.
Dfs links are specified in the share directory by symbolic
@@ -3025,14 +3710,20 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
and so on. For more information on setting up a Dfs tree on
Samba, refer to the MSDFS chapter in the Samba3-HOWTO book.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>msdfs root</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"></a>name cache timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574076"></a>
+
+name cache timeout (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574077"></a><a name="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before
entries in samba's hostname resolve cache time out. If
the timeout is set to 0. the caching is disabled.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>name cache timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">660</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>name cache timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMERESOLVEORDER"></a>name resolve order (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574137"></a>
+
+name resolve order (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574138"></a><a name="NAMERESOLVEORDER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba
suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order
to resolve host names to IP addresses. Its main purpose to is to
control how netbios name resolution is performed. The option takes a space
@@ -3050,9 +3741,9 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
useful for active directory domains and results in a DNS query for the SRV RR entry matching
_ldap._tcp.domain.
</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">wins</code> : Query a name with
- the IP address listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id325382"></a>WINSSERVER parameter. If no WINS server has
+ the IP address listed in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSERVER">WINSSERVER</a> parameter. If no WINS server has
been specified this method will be ignored.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">bcast</code> : Do a broadcast on
- each of the known local interfaces listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id325399"></a>interfaces
+ each of the known local interfaces listed in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES">interfaces</a>
parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>The example below will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined
@@ -3063,7 +3754,10 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>name resolve order</code></em> = <code class="literal">lmhosts bcast host</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSALIASES"></a>netbios aliases (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that nmbd will
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574338"></a>
+
+netbios aliases (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574339"></a><a name="NETBIOSALIASES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that nmbd will
advertise as additional names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine
to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If a machine is acting as a browse server
or logon server none of these names will be advertised as either browse server or logon
@@ -3073,7 +3767,10 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>netbios aliases</code></em> = <code class="literal">TEST TEST1 TEST2</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSNAME"></a>netbios name (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574404"></a>
+
+netbios name (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574405"></a><a name="NETBIOSNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba server is known. By default it is the same as the first component
of the host's DNS name. If a machine is a browse server or logon server this name (or the first component of
the hosts DNS name) will be the name that these services are advertised under.
@@ -3086,11 +3783,17 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>netbios name</code></em> = <code class="literal">MYNAME</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSSCOPE"></a>netbios scope (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574486"></a>
+
+netbios scope (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574487"></a><a name="NETBIOSSCOPE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will
operate under. This should not be set unless every machine
on your LAN also sets this value.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>netbios scope</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NISHOMEDIR"></a>nis homedir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574529"></a>
+
+nis homedir (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574530"></a><a name="NISHOMEDIR"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For
UNIX systems that use an automounter, the user's home directory
will often be mounted on a workstation on demand from a remote
server. </p><p>When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory
@@ -3104,19 +3807,25 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
it will be mounted on the Samba client directly from the directory
server. When Samba is returning the home share to the client, it
will consult the NIS map specified in
- <a class="indexterm" name="id325685"></a>homedir map and return the server
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#HOMEDIRMAP">homedir map</a> and return the server
listed there.</p><p>Note that for this option to work there must be a working
NIS system and the Samba server with this option must also
be a logon server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>nis homedir</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTACLSUPPORT"></a>nt acl support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574609"></a>
+
+nt acl support (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574610"></a><a name="NTACLSUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map
UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. The UNIX
permissions considered are the the traditional UNIX owner and
group permissions, as well as POSIX ACLs set on any files or
directories. This parameter was formally a global parameter in
releases prior to 2.2.2.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>nt acl support</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTLMAUTH"></a>ntlm auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574664"></a>
+
+ntlm auth (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574665"></a><a name="NTLMAUTH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to
authenticate users using the NTLM encrypted password response.
If disabled, either the lanman password hash or an NTLMv2 response
will need to be sent by the client.</p><p>If this option, and <code class="literal">lanman
@@ -3124,44 +3833,62 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
permited. Not all clients support NTLMv2, and most will require
special configuration to us it.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>ntlm auth</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTPIPESUPPORT"></a>nt pipe support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow Windows NT
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574728"></a>
+
+nt pipe support (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574729"></a><a name="NTPIPESUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will allow Windows NT
clients to connect to the NT SMB specific <code class="constant">IPC$</code>
pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left
alone.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>nt pipe support</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"></a>nt status support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will negotiate NT specific status
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574784"></a>
+
+nt status support (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574785"></a><a name="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will negotiate NT specific status
support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. This is a developer debugging option and should be left alone.
If this option is set to <code class="constant">no</code> then Samba offers
exactly the same DOS error codes that versions prior to Samba 2.2.3
reported.</p><p>You should not need to ever disable this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>nt status support</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NULLPASSWORDS"></a>null passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Allow or disallow client access to accounts that have null passwords. </p><p>See also <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>null passwords</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574845"></a>
+
+null passwords (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574846"></a><a name="NULLPASSWORDS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Allow or disallow client access to accounts that have null passwords. </p><p>See also <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>null passwords</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"></a>obey pam restrictions (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba 3.0 is configured to enable PAM support
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574898"></a>
+
+obey pam restrictions (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574899"></a><a name="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>When Samba 3.0 is configured to enable PAM support
(i.e. --with-pam), this parameter will control whether or not Samba
should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The
default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only
and to ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba
- always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <a class="indexterm" name="id326002"></a>encrypt passwords = yes. The reason
+ always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords = yes</a>. The reason
is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response
authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>obey pam restrictions</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ONLYUSER"></a>only user (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean option that controls whether
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2574962"></a>
+
+only user (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2574963"></a><a name="ONLYUSER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean option that controls whether
connections with usernames not in the <em class="parameter"><code>user</code></em>
list will be allowed. By default this option is disabled so that a
client can supply a username to be used by the server. Enabling
this parameter will force the server to only use the login
names from the <em class="parameter"><code>user</code></em> list and is only really
- useful in <a class="indexterm" name="id326064"></a>security = share level security.</p><p>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce
+ useful in <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = share</a> level security.</p><p>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce
usernames from the service name. This can be annoying for
the [homes] section. To get around this you could use <code class="literal">user =
%S</code> which means your <em class="parameter"><code>user</code></em> list
will be just the service name, which for home directories is the
name of the user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>only user</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"></a>oplock break wait time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575051"></a>
+
+oplock break wait time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575052"></a><a name="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in both Windows 9x and WinNT. If Samba responds to a client too
quickly when that client issues an SMB that can cause an oplock break request, then the network client can
fail and not respond to the break request. This tuning parameter (which is set in milliseconds) is the amount
@@ -3170,11 +3897,14 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>oplock break wait time</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"></a>oplock contention limit (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This is a <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> advanced <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> tuning option to improve the efficiency of the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575106"></a>
+
+oplock contention limit (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575107"></a><a name="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This is a <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> advanced <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> tuning option to improve the efficiency of the
granting of oplocks under multiple client contention for the same file.
</p><p>
- In brief it specifies a number, which causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>not to grant an oplock even when requested if the
+ In brief it specifies a number, which causes <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>not to grant an oplock even when requested if the
approximate number of clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this
limit. This causes <code class="literal">smbd</code> to behave in a similar
way to Windows NT.
@@ -3182,7 +3912,10 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>oplock contention limit</code></em> = <code class="literal">2</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OPLOCKS"></a>oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575188"></a>
+
+oplocks (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575190"></a><a name="OPLOCKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This boolean option tells <code class="literal">smbd</code> whether to
issue oplocks (opportunistic locks) to file open requests on this
share. The oplock code can dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve
@@ -3194,14 +3927,17 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
<code class="filename">docs/</code> directory.
</p><p>
Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files with a share. See
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id326275"></a>veto oplock files parameter. On some systems
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VETOOPLOCKFILES">veto oplock files</a> parameter. On some systems
oplocks are recognized by the underlying operating system. This
allows data synchronization between all access to oplocked files,
whether it be via Samba or NFS or a local UNIX process. See the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326284"></a>kernel oplocks parameter for details.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#KERNELOPLOCKS">kernel oplocks</a> parameter for details.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>oplocks</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OS2DRIVERMAP"></a>os2 driver map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The parameter is used to define the absolute
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575287"></a>
+
+os2 driver map (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575288"></a><a name="OS2DRIVERMAP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The parameter is used to define the absolute
path to a file containing a mapping of Windows NT printer driver
names to OS/2 printer driver names. The format is:</p><p>&lt;nt driver name&gt; = &lt;os2 driver name&gt;.&lt;device name&gt;</p><p>For example, a valid entry using the HP LaserJet 5
printer driver would appear as <code class="literal">HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP
@@ -3211,9 +3947,12 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
details on OS/2 clients, please refer to chapter on other clients in the Samba3-HOWTO book.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>os2 driver map</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OSLEVEL"></a>os level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575354"></a>
+
+os level (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575355"></a><a name="OSLEVEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This integer value controls what level Samba advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this
- parameter determines whether <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <a class="indexterm" name="id326397"></a>workgroup in the local broadcast area.
+ parameter determines whether <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> in the local broadcast area.
</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
Note:</em></span> By default, Samba will win a local master browsing election over all Microsoft operating
systems except a Windows NT 4.0/2000 Domain Controller. This means that a misconfigured Samba host can
@@ -3226,22 +3965,31 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>os level</code></em> = <code class="literal">65</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"></a>pam password change (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2,
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575453"></a>
+
+pam password change (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575454"></a><a name="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2,
this parameter, it is possible to use PAM's password change control
flag for Samba. If enabled, then PAM will be used for password
changes when requested by an SMB client instead of the program listed in
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326476"></a>passwd program.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program</a>.
It should be possible to enable this without changing your
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326484"></a>passwd chat parameter for most setups.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>pam password change</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWDCHAT">passwd chat</a> parameter for most setups.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>pam password change</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PANICACTION"></a>panic action (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a Samba developer option that allows a
- system command to be called when either <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> or <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> crashes. This is usually used to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575525"></a>
+
+panic action (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575526"></a><a name="PANICACTION"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a Samba developer option that allows a
+ system command to be called when either <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> or <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> crashes. This is usually used to
draw attention to the fact that a problem occurred.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>panic action</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>panic action</code></em> = <code class="literal">"/bin/sleep 90000"</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"></a>paranoid server security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575601"></a>
+
+paranoid server security (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575602"></a><a name="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest
users with a bad passowrd. When this option is enabled, samba will not
use a broken NT 4.x server as password server, but instead complain
to the logs and exit.
@@ -3249,23 +3997,26 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
this check, which involves deliberatly attempting a
bad logon to the remote server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>paranoid server security</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSDBBACKEND"></a>passdb backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the administrator to chose which backend
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575652"></a>
+
+passdb backend (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575653"></a><a name="PASSDBBACKEND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows the administrator to chose which backend
will be used for storing user and possibly group information. This allows
- you to swap between dfferent storage mechanisms without recompile. </p><p>The parameter value is divided into two parts, the backend's name, and a 'location'
+ you to swap between different storage mechanisms without recompile. </p><p>The parameter value is divided into two parts, the backend's name, and a 'location'
string that has meaning only to that particular backed. These are separated
by a : character.</p><p>Available backends can include:
</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> - The default smbpasswd
backend. Takes a path to the smbpasswd file as an optional argument.
</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">tdbsam</code> - The TDB based password storage
backend. Takes a path to the TDB as an optional argument (defaults to passdb.tdb
- in the <a class="indexterm" name="id326681"></a>private dir directory.</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ldapsam</code> - The LDAP based passdb
+ in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRIVATEDIR">private dir</a> directory.</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ldapsam</code> - The LDAP based passdb
backend. Takes an LDAP URL as an optional argument (defaults to
<code class="literal">ldap://localhost</code>)</p><p>LDAP connections should be secured where possible. This may be done using either
- Start-TLS (see <a class="indexterm" name="id326710"></a>ldap ssl) or by
+ Start-TLS (see <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSSL">ldap ssl</a>) or by
specifying <em class="parameter"><code>ldaps://</code></em> in
- the URL argument. </p><p>Multiple servers may also be specified in double-quotes, if your
- LDAP libraries supports the LDAP URL notation.
- (OpenLDAP does).
+ the URL argument. </p><p>Multiple servers may also be specified in double-quotes.
+ Whether multiple servers are supported or not and the exact
+ syntax depends on the LDAP library you use.
</p></li></ul></div><p>
</p>
@@ -3273,34 +4024,68 @@ nonzero. The maximum value is 128k. Values greater than 128k will be silently se
<pre class="programlisting">
passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb
-or
+or multi server LDAP URL with OpenLDAP library:
passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
+
+or multi server LDAP URL with Netscape based LDAP library:
+
+passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap-2.example.com"
</pre><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passdb backend</code></em> = <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSDBEXPANDEXPLICIT"></a>passdb expand explicit (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575808"></a>
+
+passdb expand explicit (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575809"></a><a name="PASSDBEXPANDEXPLICIT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter controls whether Samba substitutes %-macros in the passdb fields if they are explicitly set. We
used to expand macros here, but this turned out to be a bug because the Windows client can expand a variable
%G_osver% in which %G would have been substituted by the user's primary group.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passdb expand explicit</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHAT"></a>passwd chat (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This string controls the <span class="emphasis"><em>"chat"</em></span>
- conversation that takes places between <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and the local password changing
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575854"></a>
+
+passwd chat debug (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575855"></a><a name="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script
+ parameter is run in <span class="emphasis"><em>debug</em></span> mode. In this mode the
+ strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed
+ in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log with a
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEBUGLEVEL">debug level</a>
+ of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords
+ to be seen in the <code class="literal">smbd</code> log. It is available to help
+ Samba admins debug their <em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat</code></em> scripts
+ when calling the <em class="parameter"><code>passwd program</code></em> and should
+ be turned off after this has been done. This option has no effect if the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">pam password change</a>
+ parameter is set. This parameter is off by default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat debug</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2575957"></a>
+
+passwd chat timeout (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2575958"></a><a name="PASSWDCHATTIMEOUT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This integer specifies the number of seconds smbd will wait for an initial
+ answer from a passwd chat script being run. Once the initial answer is received
+ the subsequent answers must be received in one tenth of this time. The default it
+ two seconds.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">2</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576002"></a>
+
+passwd chat (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576003"></a><a name="PASSWDCHAT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This string controls the <span class="emphasis"><em>"chat"</em></span>
+ conversation that takes places between <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and the local password changing
program to change the user's password. The string describes a
- sequence of response-receive pairs that <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> uses to determine what to send to the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326839"></a>passwd program and what to expect back. If the expected output is not
+ sequence of response-receive pairs that <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> uses to determine what to send to the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program</a> and what to expect back. If the expected output is not
received then the password is not changed.</p><p>This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending
on what local methods are used for password control (such as NIS
- etc).</p><p>Note that this parameter only is only used if the <a class="indexterm" name="id326855"></a>unix password sync parameter is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>. This sequence is
+ etc).</p><p>Note that this parameter only is only used if the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC">unix password sync</a> parameter is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>. This sequence is
then called <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> when the SMB password in the
smbpasswd file is being changed, without access to the old password
cleartext. This means that root must be able to reset the user's password without
knowing the text of the previous password. In the presence of
- NIS/YP, this means that the <a class="indexterm" name="id326872"></a>passwd program must
+ NIS/YP, this means that the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program</a> must
be executed on the NIS master.
</p><p>The string can contain the macro <em class="parameter"><code>%n</code></em> which is substituted
for the new password. The old passsword (<em class="parameter"><code>%o</code></em>) is only available when
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326895"></a>encrypt passwords has been disabled.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords</a> has been disabled.
The chat sequence can also contain the standard macros
\n, \r, \t and \s to give line-feed, carriage-return, tab
and space. The chat sequence string can also contain
@@ -3308,32 +4093,17 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
be used to collect strings with spaces in them into a single
string.</p><p>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence is a full
stop ".", then no string is sent. Similarly, if the
- expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</p><p>If the <a class="indexterm" name="id326913"></a>pam password change parameter is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, the
+ expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</p><p>If the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">pam password change</a> parameter is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, the
chat pairs may be matched in any order, and success is determined by the PAM result, not any particular
output. The \n macro is ignored for PAM conversions.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat</code></em> = <code class="literal">*new*password* %n\n*new*password* %n\n *changed*</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat</code></em> = <code class="literal">"*Enter NEW password*" %n\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\n "*Password changed*"</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"></a>passwd chat debug (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script
- parameter is run in <span class="emphasis"><em>debug</em></span> mode. In this mode the
- strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed
- in the <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log with a
- <a class="indexterm" name="id326995"></a>debug level
- of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords
- to be seen in the <code class="literal">smbd</code> log. It is available to help
- Samba admins debug their <em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat</code></em> scripts
- when calling the <em class="parameter"><code>passwd program</code></em> and should
- be turned off after this has been done. This option has no effect if the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id327022"></a>pam password change
- parameter is set. This parameter is off by default.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat debug</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATTIMEOUT"></a>passwd chat timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This integer specifies the number of seconds smbd will wait for an initial
- answer from a passwd chat script being run. Once the initial answer is received
- the subsequent answers must be received in one tenth of this time. The default it
- two seconds.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd chat timeout</code></em> = <code class="literal">2</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDPROGRAM"></a>passwd program (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The name of a program that can be used to set
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576207"></a>
+
+passwd program (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576208"></a><a name="PASSWDPROGRAM"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The name of a program that can be used to set
UNIX user passwords. Any occurrences of <em class="parameter"><code>%u</code></em>
will be replaced with the user name. The user name is checked for
existence before calling the password changing program.</p><p>Also note that many passwd programs insist in <span class="emphasis"><em>reasonable
@@ -3354,7 +4124,10 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>passwd program</code></em> = <code class="literal">/bin/passwd %u</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWORDLEVEL"></a>password level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some client/server combinations have difficulty
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576342"></a>
+
+password level (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576343"></a><a name="PASSWORDLEVEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Some client/server combinations have difficulty
with mixed-case passwords. One offending client is Windows for
Workgroups, which for some reason forces passwords to upper
case when using the LANMAN1 protocol, but leaves them alone when
@@ -3372,11 +4145,14 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
process a new connection.</p><p>A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be
made - the password as is and the password in all-lower case.</p><p>This parameter is used only when using plain-text passwords. It is
not at all used when encrypted passwords as in use (that is the default
- since samba-3.0.0). Use this only when <a class="indexterm" name="id327287"></a>encrypt passwords = No.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>password level</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
+ since samba-3.0.0). Use this only when <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords = No</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>password level</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>password level</code></em> = <code class="literal">4</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWORDSERVER"></a>password server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>By specifying the name of another SMB server
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576479"></a>
+
+password server (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576480"></a><a name="PASSWORDSERVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>By specifying the name of another SMB server
or Active Directory domain controller with this option,
and using <code class="literal">security = [ads|domain|server]</code>
it is possible to get Samba to
@@ -3388,7 +4164,7 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
Samba will use the standard LDAP port of tcp/389. Note that port numbers
have no effect on password servers for Windows NT 4.0 domains or netbios
connections.</p><p>If parameter is a name, it is looked up using the
- parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id327369"></a>name resolve order and so may resolved
+ parameter <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order</a> and so may resolved
by any method and order described in that parameter.</p><p>The password server must be a machine capable of using
the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in
user level security mode.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Using a password server means your UNIX box (running
@@ -3438,7 +4214,10 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>password server</code></em> = <code class="literal">*</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORY"></a>directory</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for path.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PATH"></a>path (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a directory to which
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576802"></a><a name="DIRECTORY"></a>directory</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576803"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PATH">path</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576832"></a>
+
+path (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576833"></a><a name="PATH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a directory to which
the user of the service is to be given access. In the case of
printable services, this is where print data will spool prior to
being submitted to the host for printing.</p><p>For a printable service offering guest access, the service
@@ -3450,26 +4229,35 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
on this connection. Any occurrences of <em class="parameter"><code>%m</code></em>
will be replaced by the NetBIOS name of the machine they are
connecting from. These replacements are very useful for setting
- up pseudo home directories for users.</p><p>Note that this path will be based on <a class="indexterm" name="id327672"></a>root dir
+ up pseudo home directories for users.</p><p>Note that this path will be based on <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ROOTDIR">root dir</a>
if one was specified.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>path</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>path</code></em> = <code class="literal">/home/fred</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PIDDIRECTORY"></a>pid directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576936"></a>
+
+pid directory (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576937"></a><a name="PIDDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option specifies the directory where pid files will be placed.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>pid directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">${prefix}/var/locks</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>pid directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">pid directory = /var/run/</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="POSIXLOCKING"></a>posix locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- The <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2576996"></a>
+
+posix locking (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2576997"></a><a name="POSIXLOCKING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ The <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>
daemon maintains an database of file locks obtained by SMB clients. The default behavior is
to map this internal database to POSIX locks. This means that file locks obtained by SMB clients are
consistent with those seen by POSIX compliant applications accessing the files via a non-SMB
method (e.g. NFS or local file access). You should never need to disable this parameter.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>posix locking</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="POSTEXEC"></a>postexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577051"></a>
+
+postexec (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577052"></a><a name="POSTEXEC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run
whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual
substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some
systems.</p><p>An interesting example may be to unmount server
@@ -3477,29 +4265,38 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>postexec</code></em> = <code class="literal">echo \"%u disconnected from %S from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="EXEC"></a>exec</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preexec.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXEC"></a>preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577124"></a>
+
+preexec close (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577125"></a><a name="PREEXECCLOSE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This boolean option controls whether a non-zero return code from <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PREEXEC">preexec</a>
+ should close the service being connected to.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preexec close</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577178"></a><a name="EXEC"></a>exec</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577179"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PREEXEC">preexec</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577208"></a>
+
+preexec (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577209"></a><a name="PREEXEC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever
the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</p><p>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome
message every time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here
is an example:</p><p>
<code class="literal">preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" |
/usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' &amp; </code>
</p><p>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</p><p>
- See also <a class="indexterm" name="id327950"></a>preexec close and <a class="indexterm" name="id327957"></a>postexec.
+ See also <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PREEXECCLOSE">preexec close</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#POSTEXEC">postexec</a>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preexec</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preexec</code></em> = <code class="literal">echo \"%u connected to %S from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXECCLOSE"></a>preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This boolean option controls whether a non-zero return code from <a class="indexterm" name="id328019"></a>preexec
- should close the service being connected to.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preexec close</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFEREDMASTER"></a>prefered master</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preferred master.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFERREDMASTER"></a>preferred master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This boolean parameter controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> is a preferred master browser for its workgroup.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577316"></a><a name="PREFEREDMASTER"></a>prefered master</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577318"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PREFERREDMASTER">preferred master</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577348"></a>
+
+preferred master (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577350"></a><a name="PREFERREDMASTER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This boolean parameter controls if <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> is a preferred master browser for its workgroup.
</p><p>
If this is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, on startup, <code class="literal">nmbd</code> will force
an election, and it will have a slight advantage in winning the election. It is recommended that this
- parameter is used in conjunction with <a class="indexterm" name="id328108"></a>domain master = yes, so that
+ parameter is used in conjunction with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER">domain master = yes</a>, so that
<code class="literal">nmbd</code> can guarantee becoming a domain master.
</p><p>
Use this option with caution, because if there are several hosts (whether Samba servers, Windows 95 or NT)
@@ -3508,38 +4305,53 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
capabilities.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preferred master</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AUTOSERVICES"></a>auto services</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for preload.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRELOAD"></a>preload (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of services that you want to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577441"></a>
+
+preload modules (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577442"></a><a name="PRELOADMODULES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of paths to modules that should
+ be loaded into smbd before a client connects. This improves
+ the speed of smbd when reacting to new connections somewhat. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload modules</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload modules</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/lib/samba/passdb/mysql.so</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577502"></a><a name="AUTOSERVICES"></a>auto services</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577503"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PRELOAD">preload</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577534"></a>
+
+preload (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577535"></a><a name="PRELOAD"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a list of services that you want to be
automatically added to the browse lists. This is most useful
for homes and printers services that would otherwise not be
visible.</p><p>
Note that if you just want all printers in your
- printcap file loaded then the <a class="indexterm" name="id328193"></a>load printers
+ printcap file loaded then the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOADPRINTERS">load printers</a>
option is easier.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload</code></em> = <code class="literal">fred lp colorlp</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRELOADMODULES"></a>preload modules (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of paths to modules that should
- be loaded into smbd before a client connects. This improves
- the speed of smbd when reacting to new connections somewhat. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload modules</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
-</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preload modules</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/lib/samba/passdb/mysql.so</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRESERVECASE"></a>preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577612"></a>
+
+preserve case (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577613"></a><a name="PRESERVECASE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls if new filenames are created with the case that the client passes, or if
- they are forced to be the <a class="indexterm" name="id328311"></a>default case.
+ they are forced to be the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEFAULTCASE">default case</a>.
</p><p>
- See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for a fuller discussion.
+ See the section on <a class="link" href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for a fuller discussion.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>preserve case</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTOK"></a>print ok</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTABLE"></a>printable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, then
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577678"></a><a name="PRINTOK"></a>print ok</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577679"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PRINTABLE">printable</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577708"></a>
+
+printable (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577709"></a><a name="PRINTABLE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, then
clients may open, write to and submit spool files on the directory
specified for the service. </p><p>Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing
to the service path (user privileges permitting) via the spooling
- of print data. The <a class="indexterm" name="id328500"></a>read only parameter controls only non-printing access to
+ of print data. The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</a> parameter controls only non-printing access to
the resource.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printable</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAPCACHETIME"></a>printcap cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the number of seconds before the printing
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577771"></a>
+
+printcap cache time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577772"></a><a name="PRINTCAPCACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the number of seconds before the printing
subsystem is again asked for the known printers. If the value
is greater than 60 the initial waiting time is set to 60 seconds
to allow an earlier first rescan of the printing subsystem.
@@ -3549,12 +4361,15 @@ passdb backend = ldapsam:"ldap://ldap-1.example.com ldap://ldap-2.example.com"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printcap cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">600</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAP"></a>printcap</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printcap name.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCAPNAME"></a>printcap name (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577839"></a><a name="PRINTCAP"></a>printcap</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577840"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PRINTCAPNAME">printcap name</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2577871"></a>
+
+printcap name (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2577872"></a><a name="PRINTCAPNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter may be used to override the compiled-in default printcap name used by the server (usually
- <code class="filename"> /etc/printcap</code>). See the discussion of the <a href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">[printers]</a> section above for reasons why you might want to do this.
+ <code class="filename"> /etc/printcap</code>). See the discussion of the <a class="link" href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">[printers]</a> section above for reasons why you might want to do this.
</p><p>
To use the CUPS printing interface set <code class="literal">printcap name = cups </code>. This should
- be supplemented by an addtional setting <a class="indexterm" name="id328654"></a>printing = cups in the [global]
+ be supplemented by an addtional setting <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing = cups</a> in the [global]
section. <code class="literal">printcap name = cups</code> will use the "dummy" printcap
created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS configuration file.
</p><p>
@@ -3584,7 +4399,10 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printcap name</code></em> = <code class="literal">/etc/myprintcap</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTCOMMAND"></a>print command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>After a print job has finished spooling to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578055"></a>
+
+print command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578056"></a><a name="PRINTCOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>After a print job has finished spooling to
a service, this command will be used via a <code class="literal">system()</code>
call to process the spool file. Typically the command specified will
submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem, but there
@@ -3607,17 +4425,17 @@ print5|My Printer 5
printable service nor a global print command, spool files will
be created but not processed and (most importantly) not removed.</p><p>Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the
<code class="constant">nobody</code> account. If this happens then create
- an alternative guest account that can print and set the <a class="indexterm" name="id328877"></a>guest account
+ an alternative guest account that can print and set the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>
in the [global] section.</p><p>You can form quite complex print commands by realizing
that they are just passed to a shell. For example the following
will log a print job, print the file, then remove it. Note that
';' is the usual separator for command in shell scripts.</p><p><code class="literal">print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt;
/tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</code></p><p>You may have to vary this command considerably depending
on how you normally print files on your system. The default for
- the parameter varies depending on the setting of the <a class="indexterm" name="id328903"></a>printing
+ the parameter varies depending on the setting of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTING">printing</a>
parameter.</p><p>Default: For <code class="literal">printing = BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG
or PLP :</code></p><p><code class="literal">print command = lpr -r -P%p %s</code></p><p>For <code class="literal">printing = SYSV or HPUX :</code></p><p><code class="literal">print command = lp -c -d%p %s; rm %s</code></p><p>For <code class="literal">printing = SOFTQ :</code></p><p><code class="literal">print command = lp -d%p -s %s; rm %s</code></p><p>For printing = CUPS : If SAMBA is compiled against
- libcups, then <a class="indexterm" name="id328959"></a>printcap = cups
+ libcups, then <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTCAP">printcap = cups</a>
uses the CUPS API to
submit jobs, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V
commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it
@@ -3626,7 +4444,10 @@ print5|My Printer 5
and if SAMBA is compiled against libcups, any manually
set print command will be ignored.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>print command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTERADMIN"></a>printer admin (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578325"></a>
+
+printer admin (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578326"></a><a name="PRINTERADMIN"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This lists users who can do anything to printers
via the remote administration interfaces offered
by MS-RPC (usually using a NT workstation).
@@ -3642,20 +4463,26 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printer admin</code></em> = <code class="literal">admin, @staff</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTER"></a>printer</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for printer name.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTERNAME"></a>printer name (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578395"></a><a name="PRINTER"></a>printer</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578396"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#PRINTERNAME">printer name</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578425"></a>
+
+printer name (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578426"></a><a name="PRINTERNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter specifies the name of the printer to which print jobs spooled through a printable service
will be sent.
</p><p>
If specified in the [global] section, the printer name given will be used for any printable service that
does not have its own printer name specified.
</p><p>
- The default value of the <a class="indexterm" name="id329116"></a>printer name may be <code class="literal">lp</code> on many
+ The default value of the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTERNAME">printer name</a> may be <code class="literal">lp</code> on many
systems.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printer name</code></em> = <code class="literal">none</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printer name</code></em> = <code class="literal">laserwriter</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTING"></a>printing (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters controls how printer status information is
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578512"></a>
+
+printing (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578514"></a><a name="PRINTING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameters controls how printer status information is
interpreted on your system. It also affects the default values for
the <em class="parameter"><code>print command</code></em>, <em class="parameter"><code>lpq command</code></em>, <em class="parameter"><code>lppause command </code></em>, <em class="parameter"><code>lpresume command</code></em>, and <em class="parameter"><code>lprm command</code></em> if specified in the
[global] section.</p><p>Currently nine printing styles are supported. They are
@@ -3664,23 +4491,32 @@ print5|My Printer 5
<code class="constant">SYSV</code>, <code class="constant">HPUX</code>,
<code class="constant">QNX</code>, <code class="constant">SOFTQ</code>,
and <code class="constant">CUPS</code>.</p><p>To see what the defaults are for the other print
- commands when using the various options use the <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> program.</p><p>This option can be set on a per printer basis. Please be
+ commands when using the various options use the <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> program.</p><p>This option can be set on a per printer basis. Please be
aware however, that you must place any of the various printing
commands (e.g. print command, lpq command, etc...) after defining
the value for the <em class="parameter"><code>printing</code></em> option since it will
- reset the printing commands to default values.</p><p>See also the discussion in the <a href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">
- [printers]</a> section.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTJOBUSERNAME"></a>printjob username (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies which user information will be
+ reset the printing commands to default values.</p><p>See also the discussion in the <a class="link" href="#PRINTERSSECT" title="The [printers] section">
+ [printers]</a> section.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578648"></a>
+
+printjob username (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578649"></a><a name="PRINTJOBUSERNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies which user information will be
passed to the printing system. Usually, the username is sent,
but in some cases, e.g. the domain prefix is useful, too.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printjob username</code></em> = <code class="literal">%U</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>printjob username</code></em> = <code class="literal">%D\%U</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRIVATEDIR"></a>private dir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters defines the directory
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578709"></a>
+
+private dir (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578710"></a><a name="PRIVATEDIR"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameters defines the directory
smbd will use for storing such files as <code class="filename">smbpasswd</code>
and <code class="filename">secrets.tdb</code>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>private dir</code></em> = <code class="literal">${prefix}/private</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROFILEACLS"></a>profile acls (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578763"></a>
+
+profile acls (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578764"></a><a name="PROFILEACLS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This boolean parameter was added to fix the problems that people have been
having with storing user profiles on Samba shares from Windows 2000 or
Windows XP clients. New versions of Windows 2000 or Windows XP service
@@ -3708,7 +4544,10 @@ print5|My Printer 5
tree to the owning user.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>profile acls</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"></a>queuepause command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578836"></a>
+
+queuepause command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578837"></a><a name="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
a printer name as its only parameter and stops the printer queue,
such that no longer jobs are submitted to the printer.</p><p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
@@ -3719,10 +4558,13 @@ print5|My Printer 5
path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the
server.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>queuepause command</code></em> = <code class="literal">disable %p</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"></a>queueresume command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2578912"></a>
+
+queueresume command (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2578913"></a><a name="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be
executed on the server host in order to resume the printer queue. It
is the command to undo the behavior that is caused by the
- previous parameter (<a class="indexterm" name="id329545"></a>queuepause command).</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
+ previous parameter (<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND">queuepause command</a>).</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes
a printer name as its only parameter and resumes the printer queue,
such that queued jobs are resubmitted to the printer.</p><p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95
@@ -3734,23 +4576,32 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>queueresume command</code></em> = <code class="literal">enable %p</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READLIST"></a>read list (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579014"></a>
+
+read list (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579015"></a><a name="READLIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is a list of users that are given read-only access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list
- then they will not be given write access, no matter what the <a class="indexterm" name="id329631"></a>read only option is set
- to. The list can include group names using the syntax described in the <a class="indexterm" name="id329639"></a>invalid users
+ then they will not be given write access, no matter what the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</a> option is set
+ to. The list can include group names using the syntax described in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#INVALIDUSERS">invalid users</a>
parameter.
- </p><p>This parameter will not work with the <a class="indexterm" name="id329650"></a>security = share in
+ </p><p>This parameter will not work with the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = share</a> in
Samba 3.0. This is by design.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>read list</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>read list</code></em> = <code class="literal">mary, @students</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READONLY"></a>read only (S)</span></dt><dd><p>An inverted synonym is <a class="indexterm" name="id329711"></a>writeable.</p><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, then users
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579114"></a>
+
+read only (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579115"></a><a name="READONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>An inverted synonym is <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITEABLE">writeable</a>.</p><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, then users
of a service may not create or modify files in the service's
directory.</p><p>Note that a printable service (<code class="literal">printable = yes</code>)
will <span class="emphasis"><em>ALWAYS</em></span> allow writing to the directory
(user privileges permitting), but only via spooling operations.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>read only</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READRAW"></a>read raw (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579190"></a>
+
+read raw (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579192"></a><a name="READRAW"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server
will support the raw read SMB requests when transferring data
to clients.</p><p>If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in
one packet. This typically provides a major performance benefit.
@@ -3759,14 +4610,20 @@ print5|My Printer 5
sizes, and for these clients you may need to disable raw reads.</p><p>In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning
tool and left severely alone.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>read raw</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REALM"></a>realm (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the kerberos realm to use. The realm is
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579251"></a>
+
+realm (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579252"></a><a name="REALM"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option specifies the kerberos realm to use. The realm is
used as the ADS equivalent of the NT4 <code class="literal">domain</code>. It
is usually set to the DNS name of the kerberos server.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>realm</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>realm</code></em> = <code class="literal">mysambabox.mycompany.com</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REGISTRYSHARES"></a>registry shares (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579316"></a>
+
+registry shares (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579317"></a><a name="REGISTRYSHARES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This turns on or off support for share definitions read from
registry. Shares defined in <span class="emphasis"><em>smb.conf</em></span> take
precedence over shares with the same name defined in
@@ -3775,14 +4632,17 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</p><p>
Note that this parameter defaults to <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span>,
but it is set to <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span> when
- <em class="parameter"><code>config bakend</code></em> is set
+ <em class="parameter"><code>config backend</code></em> is set
to <span class="emphasis"><em>registry</em></span>.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>registry shares</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>registry shares</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEANNOUNCE"></a>remote announce (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>to periodically announce itself
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579402"></a>
+
+remote announce (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579403"></a><a name="REMOTEANNOUNCE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This option allows you to setup <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>to periodically announce itself
to arbitrary IP addresses with an arbitrary workgroup name.
</p><p>
This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear in a remote workgroup for
@@ -3795,7 +4655,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</pre><p>
the above line would cause <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to announce itself
to the two given IP addresses using the given workgroup names. If you leave out the
- workgroup name then the one given in the <a class="indexterm" name="id330010"></a>workgroup parameter
+ workgroup name then the one given in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</a> parameter
is used instead.
</p><p>
The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses of the remote
@@ -3805,8 +4665,11 @@ print5|My Printer 5
See the chapter on Network Browsing in the Samba-HOWTO book.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>remote announce</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"></a>remote browse sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to periodically request
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579507"></a>
+
+remote browse sync (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579508"></a><a name="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This option allows you to setup <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to periodically request
synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba
server that is on a remote segment. This option will allow you to
gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across routed networks. This
@@ -3832,13 +4695,16 @@ print5|My Printer 5
that the remote machine is available, is listening, nor that it
is in fact the browse master on its segment.
</p><p>
- The <a class="indexterm" name="id330111"></a>remote browse sync may be used on networks
+ The <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#REMOTEBROWSESYNC">remote browse sync</a> may be used on networks
where there is no WINS server, and may be used on disjoint networks where
each network has its own WINS server.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>remote browse sync</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="RENAMEUSERSCRIPT"></a>rename user script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This is the full pathname to a script that will be run as root by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> under special circumstances described below.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579619"></a>
+
+rename user script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579620"></a><a name="RENAMEUSERSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This is the full pathname to a script that will be run as root by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> under special circumstances described below.
</p><p>
When a user with admin authority or SeAddUserPrivilege rights renames a user (e.g.: from the NT4 User Manager
for Domains), this script will be run to rename the POSIX user. Two variables, <code class="literal">%uold</code> and
@@ -3855,7 +4721,10 @@ print5|My Printer 5
needs to change for other applications using the same directory.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>rename user script</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="RESETONZEROVC"></a>reset on zero vc (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579709"></a>
+
+reset on zero vc (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579710"></a><a name="RESETONZEROVC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This boolean option controls whether an incoming session setup
should kill other connections coming from the same IP. This matches
the default Windows 2003 behaviour.
@@ -3874,7 +4743,10 @@ print5|My Printer 5
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>reset on zero vc</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"></a>restrict anonymous (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The setting of this parameter determines whether user and
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579762"></a>
+
+restrict anonymous (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579763"></a><a name="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The setting of this parameter determines whether user and
group list information is returned for an anonymous connection.
and mirrors the effects of the
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -3894,17 +4766,20 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
means.
</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>
The security advantage of using restrict anonymous = 2 is removed
- by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id330306"></a>guest ok = yes on any share.
+ by setting <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK">guest ok = yes</a> on any share.
</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>restrict anonymous</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOT"></a>root</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for root directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIR"></a>root dir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for root directory.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIRECTORY"></a>root directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The server will <code class="literal">chroot()</code> (i.e.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579846"></a><a name="ROOT"></a>root</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579847"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#ROOTDIRECTORY">root directory</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579878"></a><a name="ROOTDIR"></a>root dir</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579879"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#ROOTDIRECTORY">root directory</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2579909"></a>
+
+root directory (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2579910"></a><a name="ROOTDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The server will <code class="literal">chroot()</code> (i.e.
Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is
not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the
server will deny access to files not in one of the service entries.
It may also check for, and deny access to, soft links to other
parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names
to access other directories (depending on the setting of the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id330408"></a>wide smbconfoptions parameter).
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WIDESMBCONFOPTIONS">wide smbconfoptions</a> parameter).
</p><p>Adding a <em class="parameter"><code>root directory</code></em> entry other
than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It
absolutely ensures that no access is given to files not in the
@@ -3920,25 +4795,59 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>root directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">/homes/smb</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPOSTEXEC"></a>root postexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2580033"></a>
+
+root postexec (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2580034"></a><a name="ROOTPOSTEXEC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is the same as the <em class="parameter"><code>postexec</code></em>
parameter except that the command is run as root. This is useful for
unmounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) after a connection is closed.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>root postexec</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPREEXEC"></a>root preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2580081"></a>
+
+root preexec close (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2580082"></a><a name="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is the same as the <em class="parameter"><code>preexec close
+ </code></em> parameter except that the command is run as root.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>root preexec close</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2580130"></a>
+
+root preexec (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2580131"></a><a name="ROOTPREEXEC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is the same as the <em class="parameter"><code>preexec</code></em>
parameter except that the command is run as root. This is useful for
mounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) when a connection is opened.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>root preexec</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"></a>root preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the same as the <em class="parameter"><code>preexec close
- </code></em> parameter except that the command is run as root.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>root preexec close</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2580178"></a>
+
+security mask (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2580179"></a><a name="SECURITYMASK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits will be set when a Windows NT client is manipulating the
+ UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog box.
+ </p><p>
+ This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the incoming permission bits, thus resetting
+ any bits not in this mask. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCESECURITYMODE">force security mode</a>, which works in a manner similar to this one but uses a logical OR instead of an AND.
+ </p><p>
+ Essentially, all bits set to zero in this mask will result in setting to zero the corresponding bits on the
+ file permissions regardless of the previous status of this bits on the file.
+ </p><p>
+ If not set explicitly this parameter is 0777, allowing a user to set all the user/group/world permissions on a file.
+ </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
+ Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this
+ restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
+ most normal systems will probably want to leave it set to <code class="constant">0777</code>.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>security mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0777</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITY"></a>security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option affects how clients respond to
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>security mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0770</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2580285"></a>
+
+security (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2580286"></a><a name="SECURITY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option affects how clients respond to
Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <code class="filename">
smb.conf</code> file.</p><p>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to
- protocol negotiations with <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide
+ protocol negotiations with <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide
based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password
information to the server.</p><p>The default is <code class="literal">security = user</code>, as this is
the most common setting needed when talking to Windows 98 and
@@ -3959,9 +4868,9 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
want to mainly setup shares without a password (guest shares). This
is commonly used for a shared printer server. It is more difficult
to setup guest shares with <code class="literal">security = user</code>, see
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id330741"></a>map to guestparameter for details.</p><p>It is possible to use <code class="literal">smbd</code> in a <span class="emphasis"><em>
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST">map to guest</a>parameter for details.</p><p>It is possible to use <code class="literal">smbd</code> in a <span class="emphasis"><em>
hybrid mode</em></span> where it is offers both user and share
- level security under different <a class="indexterm" name="id330762"></a>NetBIOS aliases. </p><p>The different settings will now be explained.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SHARE</em></span></p><p>When clients connect to a share level security server they
+ level security under different <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSALIASES">NetBIOS aliases</a>. </p><p>The different settings will now be explained.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SHARE</em></span></p><p>When clients connect to a share level security server they
need not log onto the server with a valid username and password before
attempting to connect to a shared resource (although modern clients
such as Windows 95/98 and Windows NT will send a logon request with
@@ -3974,10 +4883,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
in share level security, <code class="literal">smbd</code> uses several
techniques to determine the correct UNIX user to use on behalf
of the client.</p><p>A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
- client password is constructed using the following methods :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If the <a class="indexterm" name="id330838"></a>guest only parameter is set, then all the other
- stages are missed and only the <a class="indexterm" name="id330845"></a>guest account username is checked.
+ client password is constructed using the following methods :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTONLY">guest only</a> parameter is set, then all the other
+ stages are missed and only the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a> username is checked.
</p></li><li><p>Is a username is sent with the share connection
- request, then this username (after mapping - see <a class="indexterm" name="id330860"></a>username map),
+ request, then this username (after mapping - see <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMEMAP">username map</a>),
is added as a potential username.
</p></li><li><p>If the client did a previous <span class="emphasis"><em>logon
</em></span> request (the SessionSetup SMB call) then the
@@ -3986,7 +4895,7 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
added as a potential username.
</p></li><li><p>The NetBIOS name of the client is added to
the list as a potential username.
- </p></li><li><p>Any users on the <a class="indexterm" name="id330900"></a>user list are added as potential usernames.
+ </p></li><li><p>Any users on the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USER">user</a> list are added as potential usernames.
</p></li></ul></div><p>If the <em class="parameter"><code>guest only</code></em> parameter is
not set, then this list is then tried with the supplied password.
The first user for whom the password matches will be used as the
@@ -3995,20 +4904,20 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
as available to the <em class="parameter"><code>guest account</code></em>, then this
guest user will be used, otherwise access is denied.</p><p>Note that it can be <span class="emphasis"><em>very</em></span> confusing
in share-level security as to which UNIX username will eventually
- be used in granting access.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
+ be used in granting access.</p><p>See also the section <a class="link" href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = USER</em></span></p><p>This is the default security setting in Samba 3.0.
With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a
- valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <a class="indexterm" name="id330969"></a>username map
- parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <a class="indexterm" name="id330977"></a>encrypted passwords parameter) can also
- be used in this security mode. Parameters such as <a class="indexterm" name="id330985"></a>user and <a class="indexterm" name="id330992"></a>guest only if set are then applied and
+ valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMEMAP">username map</a>
+ parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTEDPASSWORDS">encrypted passwords</a> parameter) can also
+ be used in this security mode. Parameters such as <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USER">user</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTONLY">guest only</a> if set are then applied and
may change the UNIX user to use on this connection, but only after
the user has been successfully authenticated.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being
requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after
the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="indexterm" name="id331011"></a>guest account.
- See the <a class="indexterm" name="id331019"></a>map to guest parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = DOMAIN</em></span></p><p>This mode will only work correctly if <a href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a> has been used to add this
- machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <a class="indexterm" name="id331057"></a>encrypted passwords
+ the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>.
+ See the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST">map to guest</a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a class="link" href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = DOMAIN</em></span></p><p>This mode will only work correctly if <a class="citerefentry" href="net.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">net</span>(8)</span></a> has been used to add this
+ machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTEDPASSWORDS">encrypted passwords</a>
parameter to be set to <code class="constant">yes</code>. In this
mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing
it to a Windows NT Primary or Backup Domain Controller, in exactly
@@ -4022,13 +4931,13 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after
the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="indexterm" name="id331107"></a>guest account.
- See the <a class="indexterm" name="id331114"></a>map to guest parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
- NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id331135"></a>password server parameter and
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id331142"></a>encrypted passwords parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SERVER</em></span></p><p>
+ the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>.
+ See the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST">map to guest</a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a class="link" href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
+ NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER">password server</a> parameter and
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTEDPASSWORDS">encrypted passwords</a> parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = SERVER</em></span></p><p>
In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing it to another SMB server, such as an
NT box. If this fails it will revert to <code class="literal">security = user</code>. It expects the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id331169"></a>encrypted passwords parameter to be set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, unless the remote
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTEDPASSWORDS">encrypted passwords</a> parameter to be set to <code class="constant">yes</code>, unless the remote
server does not support them. However note that if encrypted passwords have been negotiated then Samba cannot
revert back to checking the UNIX password file, it must have a valid <code class="filename">smbpasswd</code> file to check users against. See the chapter about the User Database in
the Samba HOWTO Collection for details on how to set this up.
@@ -4048,10 +4957,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after
the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
- the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="indexterm" name="id331226"></a>guest account.
- See the <a class="indexterm" name="id331234"></a>map to guest parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
- NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a class="indexterm" name="id331255"></a>password server parameter and the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id331262"></a>encrypted passwords parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSADS"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = ADS</em></span></p><p>In this mode, Samba will act as a domain member in an ADS realm. To operate
+ the server to automatically map unknown users into the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>.
+ See the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST">map to guest</a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a class="link" href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">
+ NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER">password server</a> parameter and the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTEDPASSWORDS">encrypted passwords</a> parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSADS"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = ADS</em></span></p><p>In this mode, Samba will act as a domain member in an ADS realm. To operate
in this mode, the machine running Samba will need to have Kerberos installed
and configured and Samba will need to be joined to the ADS realm using the
net utility. </p><p>Note that this mode does NOT make Samba operate as a Active Directory Domain
@@ -4059,28 +4968,12 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>security</code></em> = <code class="literal">DOMAIN</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITYMASK"></a>security mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits will be set when a Windows NT client is manipulating the
- UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog box.
- </p><p>
- This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the incoming permission bits, thus resetting
- any bits not in this mask. Make sure not to mix up this parameter with <a class="indexterm" name="id331354"></a>force security mode, which works in a manner similar to this one but uses a logical OR instead of an AND.
- </p><p>
- Essentially, all bits set to zero in this mask will result in setting to zero the corresponding bits on the
- file permissions regardless of the previous status of this bits on the file.
- </p><p>
- If not set explicitly this parameter is 0777, allowing a user to set all the user/group/world permissions on a file.
- </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>
- Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this
- restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
- most normal systems will probably want to leave it set to <code class="constant">0777</code>.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>security mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0777</code>
-</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>security mask</code></em> = <code class="literal">0770</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSCHANNEL"></a>server schannel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581163"></a>
+
+server schannel (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581164"></a><a name="SERVERSCHANNEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This controls whether the server offers or even demands the use of the netlogon schannel.
- <a class="indexterm" name="id331438"></a>server schannel = no does not offer the schannel, <a class="indexterm" name="id331446"></a>server schannel = auto offers the schannel but does not enforce it, and <a class="indexterm" name="id331453"></a>server schannel = yes denies access if the client is not able to speak netlogon schannel.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SERVERSCHANNEL">server schannel = no</a> does not offer the schannel, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SERVERSCHANNEL">server schannel = auto</a> offers the schannel but does not enforce it, and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SERVERSCHANNEL">server schannel = yes</a> denies access if the client is not able to speak netlogon schannel.
This is only the case for Windows NT4 before SP4.
</p><p>
Please note that with this set to <code class="literal">no</code> you will have to apply the WindowsXP
@@ -4089,7 +4982,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>server schannel</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSIGNING"></a>server signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the server offers or requires
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581279"></a>
+
+server signing (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581280"></a><a name="SERVERSIGNING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the server offers or requires
the client it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values
are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span>
and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>.
@@ -4097,7 +4993,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
When set to mandatory, SMB signing is required and if set
to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>server signing</code></em> = <code class="literal">Disabled</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSTRING"></a>server string (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in print
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581340"></a>
+
+server string (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581341"></a><a name="SERVERSTRING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in print
manager and next to the IPC connection in <code class="literal">net view</code>. It
can be any string that you wish to show to your users.</p><p>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next
to the machine name.</p><p>A <em class="parameter"><code>%v</code></em> will be replaced with the Samba
@@ -4106,7 +5005,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>server string</code></em> = <code class="literal">University of GNUs Samba Server</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETDIRECTORY"></a>set directory (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581431"></a>
+
+set directory (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581432"></a><a name="SETDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
If <code class="literal">set directory = no</code>, then users of the
service may not use the setdir command to change directory.
</p><p>
@@ -4115,7 +5017,10 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
for details.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>set directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETPRIMARYGROUPSCRIPT"></a>set primary group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Thanks to the Posix subsystem in NT a Windows User has a
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581492"></a>
+
+set primary group script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581493"></a><a name="SETPRIMARYGROUPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Thanks to the Posix subsystem in NT a Windows User has a
primary group in addition to the auxiliary groups. This script
sets the primary group in the unix userdatase when an
administrator sets the primary group from the windows user
@@ -4127,18 +5032,23 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>set primary group script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/sbin/usermod -g '%g' '%u'</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>set quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">set quota command</code> should only be used
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581574"></a>
+
+set quota command (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581575"></a><a name="SETQUOTACOMMAND"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>The <code class="literal">set quota command</code> should only be used
whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that
samba can use.</p><p>This option is only available if Samba was configured with the argument <code class="literal">--with-sys-quotas</code> or
on linux when <code class="literal">./configure --with-quotas</code> was used and a working quota api
was found in the system. Most packages are configured with these options already.</p><p>This parameter should specify the path to a script that
can set quota for the specified arguments.</p><p>The specified script should take the following arguments:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>1 - quota type
- </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div><p>
- </p></li><li><p>2 - id (uid for user, gid for group, -1 if N/A)</p></li><li><p>3 - quota state (0 = disable, 1 = enable, 2 = enable and enforce)</p></li><li><p>4 - block softlimit</p></li><li><p>5 - block hardlimit</p></li><li><p>6 - inode softlimit</p></li><li><p>7 - inode hardlimit</p></li><li><p>8(optional) - block size, defaults to 1024</p></li></ul></div><p>The script should output at least one line of data on success. And nothing on failure.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>set quota command</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+ </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div></li><li><p>2 - id (uid for user, gid for group, -1 if N/A)</p></li><li><p>3 - quota state (0 = disable, 1 = enable, 2 = enable and enforce)</p></li><li><p>4 - block softlimit</p></li><li><p>5 - block hardlimit</p></li><li><p>6 - inode softlimit</p></li><li><p>7 - inode hardlimit</p></li><li><p>8(optional) - block size, defaults to 1024</p></li></ul></div><p>The script should output at least one line of data on success. And nothing on failure.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>set quota command</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>set quota command</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/sbin/set_quota</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHAREMODES"></a>share modes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This enables or disables the honoring of
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581736"></a>
+
+share modes (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581738"></a><a name="SHAREMODES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This enables or disables the honoring of
the <em class="parameter"><code>share modes</code></em> during a file open. These
modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access
to a file.</p><p>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so
@@ -4151,14 +5061,20 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
by default.</p><p>You should <span class="emphasis"><em>NEVER</em></span> turn this parameter
off as many Windows applications will break if you do so.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>share modes</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHORTPRESERVECASE"></a>short preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581830"></a>
+
+short preserve case (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581831"></a><a name="SHORTPRESERVECASE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This boolean parameter controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of
- suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced to be the <a class="indexterm" name="id332044"></a>default case.
- This option can be use with <a class="indexterm" name="id332051"></a>preserve case = yes to permit long filenames
+ suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced to be the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEFAULTCASE">default case</a>.
+ This option can be use with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PRESERVECASE">preserve case = yes</a> to permit long filenames
to retain their case, while short names are lowered.
- </p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>short preserve case</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
+ </p><p>See the section on <a class="link" href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>short preserve case</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"></a>show add printer wizard (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581910"></a>
+
+show add printer wizard (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581911"></a><a name="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support
for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will
appear on Samba hosts in the share listing. Normally this folder will
contain an icon for the MS Add Printer Wizard (APW). However, it is
@@ -4176,8 +5092,11 @@ HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\
</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This does not prevent the same user from having
administrative privilege on an individual printer.</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>show add printer wizard</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This a full path name to a script called by
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2581994"></a>
+
+shutdown script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2581995"></a><a name="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This a full path name to a script called by
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that should
start a shutdown procedure.</p><p>If the connected user posseses the <code class="constant">SeRemoteShutdownPrivilege</code>,
right, this command will be run as user.</p><p>The %z %t %r %f variables are expanded as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>%z</code></em> will be substituted with the
shutdown message sent to the server.</p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>%t</code></em> will be substituted with the
@@ -4201,7 +5120,10 @@ let "time++"
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>shutdown script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SMBENCRYPT"></a>smb encrypt (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a new feature introduced with Samba 3.2 and above. It is an
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582147"></a>
+
+smb encrypt (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582148"></a><a name="SMBENCRYPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a new feature introduced with Samba 3.2 and above. It is an
extension to the SMB/CIFS protocol negotiated as part of the UNIX extensions.
SMB encryption uses the GSSAPI (SSPI on Windows) ability to encrypt
and sign every request/response in a SMB protocol stream. When
@@ -4224,13 +5146,16 @@ let "time++"
style read/writes allowed) as well as the overhead of encrypting
and signing all the data.
</p><p>If SMB encryption is selected, Windows style SMB signing (see
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id332354"></a>server signing option) is no longer necessary,
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SERVERSIGNING">server signing</a> option) is no longer necessary,
as the GSSAPI flags use select both signing and sealing of the data.
</p><p>When set to auto, SMB encryption is offered, but not enforced.
When set to mandatory, SMB encryption is required and if set
to disabled, SMB encryption can not be negotiated.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>smb encrypt</code></em> = <code class="literal">auto</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SMBPASSWDFILE"></a>smb passwd file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the path to the encrypted smbpasswd file. By
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582253"></a>
+
+smb passwd file (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582254"></a><a name="SMBPASSWDFILE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option sets the path to the encrypted smbpasswd file. By
default the path to the smbpasswd file is compiled into Samba.</p><p>
An example of use is:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -4238,9 +5163,15 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>smb passwd file</code></em> = <code class="literal">${prefix}/private/smbpasswd</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SMBPORTS"></a>smb ports (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies which ports the server should listen on for SMB traffic.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>smb ports</code></em> = <code class="literal">445 139</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582307"></a>
+
+smb ports (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582308"></a><a name="SMBPORTS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies which ports the server should listen on for SMB traffic.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>smb ports</code></em> = <code class="literal">445 139</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SOCKETADDRESS"></a>socket address (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to control what
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582349"></a>
+
+socket address (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582350"></a><a name="SOCKETADDRESS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to control what
address Samba will listen for connections on. This is used to
support multiple virtual interfaces on the one server, each
with a different configuration.</p><p>By default Samba will accept connections on any
@@ -4248,7 +5179,10 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>socket address</code></em> = <code class="literal">192.168.2.20</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SOCKETOPTIONS"></a>socket options (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to set socket options
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582414"></a>
+
+socket options (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582415"></a><a name="SOCKETOPTIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to set socket options
to be used when talking with the client.</p><p>Socket options are controls on the networking layer
of the operating systems which allow the connection to be
tuned.</p><p>This option will typically be used to tune your Samba server
@@ -4261,7 +5195,7 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
"Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you
either incorrectly typed it or you need to add an include file
to includes.h for your OS. If the latter is the case please
- send the patch to <a href="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org" target="_top">
+ send the patch to <a class="ulink" href="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org" target="_top">
samba-technical@samba.org</a>.</p><p>Any of the supported socket options may be combined
in any way you like, as long as your OS allows it.</p><p>This is the list of socket options currently settable
using this option:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>SO_KEEPALIVE</p></li><li><p>SO_REUSEADDR</p></li><li><p>SO_BROADCAST</p></li><li><p>TCP_NODELAY</p></li><li><p>IPTOS_LOWDELAY</p></li><li><p>IPTOS_THROUGHPUT</p></li><li><p>SO_SNDBUF *</p></li><li><p>SO_RCVBUF *</p></li><li><p>SO_SNDLOWAT *</p></li><li><p>SO_RCVLOWAT *</p></li></ul></div><p>Those marked with a <span class="emphasis"><em>'*'</em></span> take an integer
@@ -4276,23 +5210,32 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>socket options</code></em> = <code class="literal">IPTOS_LOWDELAY</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STATCACHE"></a>stat cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will use a cache in order to
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582624"></a>
+
+stat cache (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582625"></a><a name="STATCACHE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will use a cache in order to
speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need
to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>stat cache</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STOREDOSATTRIBUTES"></a>store dos attributes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582675"></a>
+
+store dos attributes (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582676"></a><a name="STOREDOSATTRIBUTES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
If this parameter is set Samba attempts to first read DOS attributes (SYSTEM, HIDDEN, ARCHIVE or
READ-ONLY) from a filesystem extended attribute, before mapping DOS attributes to UNIX permission bits (such
- as occurs with <a class="indexterm" name="id332794"></a>map hidden and <a class="indexterm" name="id332801"></a>map readonly). When set, DOS
+ as occurs with <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPHIDDEN">map hidden</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPREADONLY">map readonly</a>). When set, DOS
attributes will be stored onto an extended attribute in the UNIX filesystem, associated with the file or
- directory. For no other mapping to occur as a fall-back, the parameters <a class="indexterm" name="id332810"></a>map hidden,
- <a class="indexterm" name="id332817"></a>map system, <a class="indexterm" name="id332824"></a>map archive and <a class="indexterm" name="id332831"></a>map readonly must be set to off. This parameter writes the DOS attributes as a string into the extended
+ directory. For no other mapping to occur as a fall-back, the parameters <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPHIDDEN">map hidden</a>,
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPSYSTEM">map system</a>, <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPARCHIVE">map archive</a> and <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#MAPREADONLY">map readonly</a> must be set to off. This parameter writes the DOS attributes as a string into the extended
attribute named "user.DOSATTRIB". This extended attribute is explicitly hidden from smbd clients requesting an
EA list. On Linux the filesystem must have been mounted with the mount option user_xattr in order for
extended attributes to work, also extended attributes must be compiled into the Linux kernel.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>store dos attributes</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTALLOCATE"></a>strict allocate (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582797"></a>
+
+strict allocate (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582798"></a><a name="STRICTALLOCATE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of
disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>
the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real
disk storage blocks when a file is extended to the Windows behaviour
@@ -4304,7 +5247,10 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
out of quota messages on systems that are restricting the disk quota
of users.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>strict allocate</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTLOCKING"></a>strict locking (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582867"></a>
+
+strict locking (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582868"></a><a name="STRICTLOCKING"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is an enumerated type that controls the handling of file locking in the server. When this is set to <code class="constant">yes</code>,
the server will check every read and write access for file locks, and deny access if locks exist. This can be slow on
some systems.
@@ -4320,21 +5266,27 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
<code class="literal">strict locking = no</code> is acceptable.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>strict locking</code></em> = <code class="literal">Auto</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTSYNC"></a>strict sync (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Many Windows applications (including the Windows 98 explorer
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2582946"></a>
+
+strict sync (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2582947"></a><a name="STRICTSYNC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Many Windows applications (including the Windows 98 explorer
shell) seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to disk with doing
a sync to disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces the process to be
suspended until the kernel has ensured that all outstanding data in
kernel disk buffers has been safely stored onto stable storage.
This is very slow and should only be done rarely. Setting this
parameter to <code class="constant">no</code> (the default) means that
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> ignores the Windows
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> ignores the Windows
applications requests for a sync call. There is only a possibility
of losing data if the operating system itself that Samba is running
on crashes, so there is little danger in this default setting. In
addition, this fixes many performance problems that people have
reported with the new Windows98 explorer shell file copies.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>strict sync</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SVCCTLLIST"></a>svcctl list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option defines a list of init scripts that smbd
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583011"></a>
+
+svcctl list (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583012"></a><a name="SVCCTLLIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option defines a list of init scripts that smbd
will use for starting and stopping Unix services via the Win32
ServiceControl API. This allows Windows administrators to
utilize the MS Management Console plug-ins to manage a
@@ -4347,7 +5299,10 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>svcctl list</code></em> = <code class="literal">cups postfix portmap httpd</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYNCALWAYS"></a>sync always (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583096"></a>
+
+sync always (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583098"></a><a name="SYNCALWAYS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean parameter that controls
whether writes will always be written to stable storage before
the write call returns. If this is <code class="constant">no</code> then the server will be
guided by the client's request in each write call (clients can
@@ -4358,7 +5313,19 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
<code class="constant">yes</code> in order for this parameter to have
any affect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>sync always</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYSLOG"></a>syslog (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583167"></a>
+
+syslog only (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583168"></a><a name="SYSLOGONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ If this parameter is set then Samba debug messages are logged into the system
+ syslog only, and not to the debug log files. There still will be some
+ logging to log.[sn]mbd even if <span class="emphasis"><em>syslog only</em></span> is enabled.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>syslog only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583214"></a>
+
+syslog (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583215"></a><a name="SYSLOG"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter maps how Samba debug messages are logged onto the system syslog logging levels.
Samba debug level zero maps onto syslog <code class="constant">LOG_ERR</code>, debug level one maps onto
<code class="constant">LOG_WARNING</code>, debug level two maps onto <code class="constant">LOG_NOTICE</code>,
@@ -4369,33 +5336,42 @@ smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
logging to log.[sn]mbd even if <span class="emphasis"><em>syslog only</em></span> is enabled.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>syslog</code></em> = <code class="literal">1</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SYSLOGONLY"></a>syslog only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- If this parameter is set then Samba debug messages are logged into the system
- syslog only, and not to the debug log files. There still will be some
- logging to log.[sn]mbd even if <span class="emphasis"><em>syslog only</em></span> is enabled.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>syslog only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"></a>template homedir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
- user, the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583285"></a>
+
+template homedir (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583286"></a><a name="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
+ user, the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this
parameter to fill in the home directory for that user. If the
string <em class="parameter"><code>%D</code></em> is present it
is substituted with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the
string <em class="parameter"><code>%U</code></em> is present it
is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>template homedir</code></em> = <code class="literal">/home/%D/%U</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATESHELL"></a>template shell (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
- user, the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this
- parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMEOFFSET"></a>time offset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583350"></a>
+
+template shell (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583352"></a><a name="TEMPLATESHELL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
+ user, the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this
+ parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583390"></a>
+
+time offset (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583391"></a><a name="TIMEOFFSET"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add
to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if
you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight
saving time handling.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>time offset</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>time offset</code></em> = <code class="literal">60</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESERVER"></a>time server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> advertises itself as a time server to Windows
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583449"></a>
+
+time server (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583450"></a><a name="TIMESERVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> advertises itself as a time server to Windows
clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>time server</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXCHARSET"></a>unix charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the charset the unix machine
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583500"></a>
+
+unix charset (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583501"></a><a name="UNIXCHARSET"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Specifies the charset the unix machine
Samba runs on uses. Samba needs to know this in order to be able to
convert text to the charsets other SMB clients use.
</p><p>This is also the charset Samba will use when specifying arguments
@@ -4404,14 +5380,20 @@ clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>t
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>unix charset</code></em> = <code class="literal">ASCII</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXEXTENSIONS"></a>unix extensions (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583566"></a>
+
+unix extensions (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583567"></a><a name="UNIXEXTENSIONS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
implments the CIFS UNIX extensions, as defined by HP.
These extensions enable Samba to better serve UNIX CIFS clients
by supporting features such as symbolic links, hard links, etc...
These extensions require a similarly enabled client, and are of
no current use to Windows clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>unix extensions</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"></a>unix password sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583613"></a>
+
+unix password sync (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583614"></a><a name="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password
when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed.
If this is set to <code class="constant">yes</code> the program specified in the <em class="parameter"><code>passwd
@@ -4420,7 +5402,10 @@ clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>t
old UNIX password (as the SMB password change code has no
access to the old password cleartext, only the new).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>unix password sync</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UPDATEENCRYPTED"></a>update encrypted (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583674"></a>
+
+update encrypted (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583675"></a><a name="UPDATEENCRYPTED"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This boolean parameter allows a user logging on with a plaintext password to have their encrypted (hashed)
password in the smbpasswd file to be updated automatically as they log on. This option allows a site to
migrate from plaintext password authentication (users authenticate with plaintext password over the
@@ -4430,15 +5415,18 @@ clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>t
passwords to be made over a longer period. Once all users have encrypted representations of their passwords
in the smbpasswd file this parameter should be set to <code class="constant">no</code>.
</p><p>
- In order for this parameter to be operative the <a class="indexterm" name="id333687"></a>encrypt passwords parameter must
- be set to <code class="constant">no</code>. The default value of <a class="indexterm" name="id333698"></a>encrypt passwords = Yes. Note: This must be set to <code class="constant">no</code> for this <a class="indexterm" name="id333709"></a>update encrypted to work.
+ In order for this parameter to be operative the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords</a> parameter must
+ be set to <code class="constant">no</code>. The default value of <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords = Yes</a>. Note: This must be set to <code class="constant">no</code> for this <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#UPDATEENCRYPTED">update encrypted</a> to work.
</p><p>
Note that even when this parameter is set a user authenticating to <code class="literal">smbd</code>
must still enter a valid password in order to connect correctly, and to update their hashed (smbpasswd)
passwords.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>update encrypted</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USECLIENTDRIVER"></a>use client driver (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583806"></a>
+
+use client driver (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583807"></a><a name="USECLIENTDRIVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000
clients. It has no effect on Windows 95/98/ME clients. When
serving a printer to Windows NT/2000 clients without first installing
a valid printer driver on the Samba host, the client will be required
@@ -4463,7 +5451,10 @@ clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>t
on a print share which has valid print driver installed on the Samba
server.</em></span></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>use client driver</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USEKERBEROSKEYTAB"></a>use kerberos keytab (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583887"></a>
+
+use kerberos keytab (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583888"></a><a name="USEKERBEROSKEYTAB"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Specifies whether Samba should attempt to maintain service principals in the systems
keytab file for <code class="constant">host/FQDN</code> and <code class="constant">cifs/FQDN</code>.
</p><p>
@@ -4475,7 +5466,10 @@ default_keytab_name = FILE:/etc/krb5.keytab
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>use kerberos keytab</code></em> = <code class="literal">False</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USEMMAP"></a>use mmap (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2583955"></a>
+
+use mmap (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2583956"></a><a name="USEMMAP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can
depend on mmap working correctly on the running system. Samba requires a coherent
mmap/read-write system memory cache. Currently only HPUX does not have such a
coherent cache, and so this parameter is set to <code class="constant">no</code> by
@@ -4484,45 +5478,10 @@ default_keytab_name = FILE:/etc/krb5.keytab
the tdb internal code.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>use mmap</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USER"></a>user</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERS"></a>users</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAME"></a>username (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited
- list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against
- each username in turn (left to right).</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line is needed only when
- the PC is unable to supply its own username. This is the case
- for the COREPLUS protocol or where your users have different WfWg
- usernames to UNIX usernames. In both these cases you may also be
- better using the \\server\share%user syntax instead.</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line is not a great
- solution in many cases as it means Samba will try to validate
- the supplied password against each of the usernames in the
- <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line in turn. This is slow and
- a bad idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords.
- You may get timeouts or security breaches using this parameter
- unwisely.</p><p>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This
- parameter does not restrict who can login, it just offers hints
- to the Samba server as to what usernames might correspond to the
- supplied password. Users can login as whoever they please and
- they will be able to do no more damage than if they started a
- telnet session. The daemon runs as the user that they log in as,
- so they cannot do anything that user cannot do.</p><p>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you
- can use the <a class="indexterm" name="id334024"></a>valid users parameter.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '@' then the name
- will be looked up first in the NIS netgroups list (if Samba
- is compiled with netgroup support), followed by a lookup in
- the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list of all users
- in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '+' then the name
- will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will
- expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '&amp;' then the name
- will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba
- is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list
- of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</p><p>Note that searching though a groups database can take
- quite some time, and some clients may time out during the
- search.</p><p>See the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">NOTE ABOUT
- USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a> for more information on how
- this parameter determines access to the services.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> = <code class="literal">
-# The guest account if a guest service,
- else &lt;empty string&gt;.</code>
-</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> = <code class="literal">fred, mary, jack, jane, @users, @pcgroup</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAMELEVEL"></a>username level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584008"></a>
+
+username level (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584009"></a><a name="USERNAMELEVEL"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at
the real UNIX username, as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase
username. By default Samba tries all lowercase, followed by the
username with the first letter capitalized, and fails if the
@@ -4537,7 +5496,24 @@ default_keytab_name = FILE:/etc/krb5.keytab
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username level</code></em> = <code class="literal">5</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAMEMAP"></a>username map (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584089"></a>
+
+username map script (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584090"></a><a name="USERNAMEMAPSCRIPT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This script is a mutually exclusive alternative to the
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMEMAP">username map</a> parameter. This parameter
+ specifies and external program or script that must accept a single
+ command line option (the username transmitted in the authentication
+ request) and return a line line on standard output (the name to which
+ the account should mapped). In this way, it is possible to store
+ username map tables in an LDAP or NIS directory services.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username map script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+</em></span>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username map script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/etc/samba/scripts/mapusers.sh</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584166"></a>
+
+username map (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584167"></a><a name="USERNAMEMAP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This option allows you to specify a file containing a mapping of usernames from the clients to the server.
This can be used for several purposes. The most common is to map usernames that users use on DOS or Windows
machines to those that the UNIX box uses. The other is to map multiple users to a single username so that they
@@ -4546,7 +5522,7 @@ default_keytab_name = FILE:/etc/krb5.keytab
Please note that for user or share mode security, the username map is applied prior to validating the user
credentials. Domain member servers (domain or ads) apply the username map after the user has been
successfully authenticated by the domain controller and require fully qualified enties in the map table (e.g.
- biddle = DOMAIN\foo).
+ biddle = <code class="literal">DOMAIN\foo</code>).
</p><p>
The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should contain a single UNIX username on the left then a '='
followed by a list of usernames on the right. The list of usernames on the right may contain names of the form
@@ -4593,14 +5569,15 @@ guest = *
Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences of usernames. Thus if you connect to \\server\fred and
<code class="constant">fred</code> is remapped to <code class="constant">mary</code> then you will actually be connecting to
\\server\mary and will need to supply a password suitable for <code class="constant">mary</code> not
- <code class="constant">fred</code>. The only exception to this is the username passed to the <a class="indexterm" name="id334332"></a>password server (if you have one). The password server will receive whatever username the client
+ <code class="constant">fred</code>. The only exception to this is the username passed to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER">password server</a> (if you have one). The password server will receive whatever username the client
supplies without modification.
</p><p>
Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect this has is with printing. Users who have been
mapped may have trouble deleting print jobs as PrintManager under WfWg will think they don't own the print
job.
</p><p>
- Samba versions prior to 3.0.8 would only support reading the fully qualified username (e.g.: DOMAIN\user) from
+ Samba versions prior to 3.0.8 would only support reading the fully qualified username
+ (e.g.: <code class="literal">DOMAIN\user</code>) from
the username map when performing a kerberos login from a client. However, when looking up a map entry for a
user authenticated by NTLM[SSP], only the login name would be used for matches. This resulted in inconsistent
behavior sometimes even on the same server.
@@ -4611,7 +5588,7 @@ guest = *
the connection.
</p><p>
When relying upon a external domain controller for validating authentication requests, smbd will apply the username map
- to the fully qualified username (i.e. DOMAIN\user) only after the user has been successfully authenticated.
+ to the fully qualified username (i.e. <code class="literal">DOMAIN\user</code>) only after the user has been successfully authenticated.
</p><p>
An example of use is:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
@@ -4620,30 +5597,69 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username map</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# no username map</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERNAMEMAPSCRIPT"></a>username map script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This script is a mutually exclusive alternative to the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id334414"></a>username map parameter. This parameter
- specifies and external program or script that must accept a single
- command line option (the username transmitted in the authentication
- request) and return a line line on standard output (the name to which
- the account should mapped). In this way, it is possible to store
- username map tables in an LDAP or NIS directory services.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username map script</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584451"></a><a name="USER"></a>user</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584452"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#USERNAME">username</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584482"></a><a name="USERS"></a>users</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584483"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#USERNAME">username</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584513"></a>
+
+username (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584514"></a><a name="USERNAME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited
+ list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against
+ each username in turn (left to right).</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line is needed only when
+ the PC is unable to supply its own username. This is the case
+ for the COREPLUS protocol or where your users have different WfWg
+ usernames to UNIX usernames. In both these cases you may also be
+ better using the \\server\share%user syntax instead.</p><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line is not a great
+ solution in many cases as it means Samba will try to validate
+ the supplied password against each of the usernames in the
+ <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> line in turn. This is slow and
+ a bad idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords.
+ You may get timeouts or security breaches using this parameter
+ unwisely.</p><p>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This
+ parameter does not restrict who can login, it just offers hints
+ to the Samba server as to what usernames might correspond to the
+ supplied password. Users can login as whoever they please and
+ they will be able to do no more damage than if they started a
+ telnet session. The daemon runs as the user that they log in as,
+ so they cannot do anything that user cannot do.</p><p>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you
+ can use the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VALIDUSERS">valid users</a> parameter.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '@' then the name
+ will be looked up first in the NIS netgroups list (if Samba
+ is compiled with netgroup support), followed by a lookup in
+ the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list of all users
+ in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '+' then the name
+ will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will
+ expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</p><p>If any of the usernames begin with a '&amp;' then the name
+ will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba
+ is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list
+ of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</p><p>Note that searching though a groups database can take
+ quite some time, and some clients may time out during the
+ search.</p><p>See the section <a class="link" href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION">NOTE ABOUT
+ USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a> for more information on how
+ this parameter determines access to the services.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> = <code class="literal">
+# The guest account if a guest service,
+ else &lt;empty string&gt;.</code>
</em></span>
-</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username map script</code></em> = <code class="literal">/etc/samba/scripts/mapusers.sh</code>
+</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> = <code class="literal">fred, mary, jack, jane, @users, @pcgroup</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREALLOWGUESTS"></a>usershare allow guests (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether user defined shares are allowed
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584683"></a>
+
+usershare allow guests (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584684"></a><a name="USERSHAREALLOWGUESTS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether user defined shares are allowed
to be accessed by non-authenticated users or not. It is the equivalent
of allowing people who can create a share the option of setting
<em class="parameter"><code>guest ok = yes</code></em> in a share
definition. Due to the security sensitive nature of this the default
is set to off.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare allow guests</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREMAXSHARES"></a>usershare max shares (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of user defined shares
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584736"></a>
+
+usershare max shares (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584737"></a><a name="USERSHAREMAXSHARES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of user defined shares
that are allowed to be created by users belonging to the group owning the
usershare directory. If set to zero (the default) user defined shares are ignored.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare max shares</code></em> = <code class="literal">0</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREOWNERONLY"></a>usershare owner only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether the pathname exported by
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584781"></a>
+
+usershare owner only (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584782"></a><a name="USERSHAREOWNERONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether the pathname exported by
a user defined shares must be owned by the user creating the
user defined share or not. If set to True (the default) then
smbd checks that the directory path being shared is owned by
@@ -4653,7 +5669,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
regardless of who owns it.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare owner only</code></em> = <code class="literal">True</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREPATH"></a>usershare path (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the absolute path of the directory on the
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584831"></a>
+
+usershare path (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584832"></a><a name="USERSHAREPATH"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the absolute path of the directory on the
filesystem used to store the user defined share definition files.
This directory must be owned by root, and have no access for
other, and be writable only by the group owner. In addition the
@@ -4674,7 +5693,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
In this case, only members of the group "power_users" can create user defined shares.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare path</code></em> = <code class="literal">NULL</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREPREFIXALLOWLIST"></a>usershare prefix allow list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a list of absolute pathnames
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584911"></a>
+
+usershare prefix allow list (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584912"></a><a name="USERSHAREPREFIXALLOWLIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a list of absolute pathnames
the root of which are allowed to be exported by user defined share definitions.
If the pathname exported doesn't start with one of the strings in this
list the user defined share will not be allowed. This allows the Samba
@@ -4689,7 +5711,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare prefix allow list</code></em> = <code class="literal">/home /data /space</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHAREPREFIXDENYLIST"></a>usershare prefix deny list (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a list of absolute pathnames
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2584984"></a>
+
+usershare prefix deny list (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2584985"></a><a name="USERSHAREPREFIXDENYLIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies a list of absolute pathnames
the root of which are NOT allowed to be exported by user defined share definitions.
If the pathname exported starts with one of the strings in this
list the user defined share will not be allowed. Any pathname not
@@ -4705,7 +5730,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare prefix deny list</code></em> = <code class="literal">/etc /dev /private</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USERSHARETEMPLATESHARE"></a>usershare template share (G)</span></dt><dd><p>User defined shares only have limited possible parameters
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585059"></a>
+
+usershare template share (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585060"></a><a name="USERSHARETEMPLATESHARE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>User defined shares only have limited possible parameters
such as path, guest ok etc. This parameter allows usershares to
"cloned" from an existing share. If "usershare template share"
is set to the name of an existing share, then all usershares
@@ -4720,7 +5748,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>usershare template share</code></em> = <code class="literal">template_share</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USESENDFILE"></a>use sendfile (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, and the <code class="constant">sendfile()</code>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585131"></a>
+
+use sendfile (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585132"></a><a name="USESENDFILE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <code class="constant">yes</code>, and the <code class="constant">sendfile()</code>
system call is supported by the underlying operating system, then some SMB read calls
(mainly ReadAndX and ReadRaw) will use the more efficient sendfile system call for files that
are exclusively oplocked. This may make more efficient use of the system CPU's
@@ -4729,7 +5760,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
Windows 9x (using sendfile from Linux will cause these clients to fail).
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>use sendfile</code></em> = <code class="literal">false</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="USESPNEGO"></a>use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This variable controls controls whether samba will try
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585188"></a>
+
+use spnego (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585190"></a><a name="USESPNEGO"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This variable controls controls whether samba will try
to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with
WindowsXP and Windows2000 clients to agree upon an authentication mechanism.
</p><p>
@@ -4737,19 +5771,10 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
implementation, there is no reason this should ever be
disabled.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>use spnego</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UTMP"></a>utmp (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This boolean parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
- with the option <code class="literal">--with-utmp</code>. If set to
- <code class="constant">yes</code> then Samba will attempt to add utmp or utmpx records
- (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a connection is made to a Samba server.
- Sites may use this to record the user connecting to a Samba share.
- </p><p>
- Due to the requirements of the utmp record, we are required to create a unique
- identifier for the incoming user. Enabling this option creates an n^2 algorithm
- to find this number. This may impede performance on large installations.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>utmp</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
-</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UTMPDIRECTORY"></a>utmp directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585238"></a>
+
+utmp directory (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585239"></a><a name="UTMPDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba has
been configured and compiled with the option <code class="literal">
--with-utmp</code>. It specifies a directory pathname that is
used to store the utmp or utmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
@@ -4761,16 +5786,25 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>utmp directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">/var/run/utmp</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="-VALID"></a>-valid (S)</span></dt><dd><p> This parameter indicates whether a share is
- valid and thus can be used. When this parameter is set to false,
- the share will be in no way visible nor accessible.
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585316"></a>
+
+utmp (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585317"></a><a name="UTMP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This boolean parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
+ with the option <code class="literal">--with-utmp</code>. If set to
+ <code class="constant">yes</code> then Samba will attempt to add utmp or utmpx records
+ (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a connection is made to a Samba server.
+ Sites may use this to record the user connecting to a Samba share.
</p><p>
- This option should not be
- used by regular users but might be of help to developers.
- Samba uses this option internally to mark shares as deleted.
- </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>-valid</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
+ Due to the requirements of the utmp record, we are required to create a unique
+ identifier for the incoming user. Enabling this option creates an n^2 algorithm
+ to find this number. This may impede performance on large installations.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>utmp</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VALIDUSERS"></a>valid users (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585379"></a>
+
+valid users (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585380"></a><a name="VALIDUSERS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is a list of users that should be allowed to login to this service. Names starting with
'@', '+' and '&amp;' are interpreted using the same rules as described in the
<em class="parameter"><code>invalid users</code></em> parameter.
@@ -4786,7 +5820,22 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>valid users</code></em> = <code class="literal">greg, @pcusers</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VETOFILES"></a>veto files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585470"></a>
+
+-valid (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585471"></a><a name="-VALID"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p> This parameter indicates whether a share is
+ valid and thus can be used. When this parameter is set to false,
+ the share will be in no way visible nor accessible.
+ </p><p>
+ This option should not be
+ used by regular users but might be of help to developers.
+ Samba uses this option internally to mark shares as deleted.
+ </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>-valid</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
+</em></span>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585519"></a>
+
+veto files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585520"></a><a name="VETOFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is a list of files and directories that are neither visible nor accessible. Each entry in
the list must be separated by a '/', which allows spaces to be included in the entry. '*' and '?'
can be used to specify multiple files or directories as in DOS wildcards.
@@ -4794,11 +5843,11 @@ username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> include the
unix directory separator '/'.
</p><p>
- Note that the <a class="indexterm" name="id335230"></a>case sensitive option is applicable in vetoing files.
+ Note that the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive</a> option is applicable in vetoing files.
</p><p>
One feature of the veto files parameter that it is important to be aware of is Samba's behaviour when
trying to delete a directory. If a directory that is to be deleted contains nothing but veto files this
- deletion will <span class="emphasis"><em>fail</em></span> unless you also set the <a class="indexterm" name="id335247"></a>delete veto files
+ deletion will <span class="emphasis"><em>fail</em></span> unless you also set the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEVETOFILES">delete veto files</a>
parameter to <em class="parameter"><code>yes</code></em>.
</p><p>
Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, as it will be forced to check all files
@@ -4817,12 +5866,15 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/
</pre><p>
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>veto files</code></em> = <code class="literal">No files or directories are vetoed.</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VETOOPLOCKFILES"></a>veto oplock files (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
- This parameter is only valid when the <a class="indexterm" name="id335315"></a>oplocks
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585638"></a>
+
+veto oplock files (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585639"></a><a name="VETOOPLOCKFILES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
+ This parameter is only valid when the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#OPLOCKS">oplocks</a>
parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator
to selectively turn off the granting of oplocks on selected files that
match a wildcarded list, similar to the wildcarded list used in the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id335324"></a>veto files parameter.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VETOFILES">veto files</a> parameter.
</p><p>
You might want to do this on files that you know will be heavily contended
for by clients. A good example of this is in the NetBench SMB benchmark
@@ -4838,19 +5890,28 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>veto oplock files</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# No files are vetoed for oplock grants</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VFSOBJECT"></a>vfs object</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for vfs objects.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VFSOBJECTS"></a>vfs objects (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the backend names which
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585731"></a><a name="VFSOBJECT"></a>vfs object</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585732"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585762"></a>
+
+vfs objects (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585763"></a><a name="VFSOBJECTS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the backend names which
are used for Samba VFS I/O operations. By default, normal
disk I/O operations are used but these can be overloaded
with one or more VFS objects. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>vfs objects</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>vfs objects</code></em> = <code class="literal">extd_audit recycle</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="VOLUME"></a>volume (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the volume label
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585822"></a>
+
+volume (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585823"></a><a name="VOLUME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This allows you to override the volume label
returned for a share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs
that insist on a particular volume label.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>volume</code></em> = <code class="literal">
# the name of the share</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WIDELINKS"></a>wide links (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not links
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585866"></a>
+
+wide links (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585867"></a><a name="WIDELINKS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not links
in the UNIX file system may be followed by the server. Links
that point to areas within the directory tree exported by the
server are always allowed; this parameter controls access only
@@ -4858,15 +5919,21 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
effect on your server performance due to the extra system calls
that Samba has to do in order to perform the link checks.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>wide links</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDCACHETIME"></a>winbind cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of
- seconds the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon will cache
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585918"></a>
+
+winbind cache time (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585919"></a><a name="WINBINDCACHETIME"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of
+ seconds the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon will cache
user and group information before querying a Windows NT server
again.</p><p>
This does not apply to authentication requests, these are always
- evaluated in real time unless the <a class="indexterm" name="id335568"></a>winbind offline logon option has been enabled.
+ evaluated in real time unless the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDOFFLINELOGON">winbind offline logon</a> option has been enabled.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind cache time</code></em> = <code class="literal">300</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"></a>winbind enum groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be necessary to suppress
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2585989"></a>
+
+winbind enum groups (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2585990"></a><a name="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be necessary to suppress
the enumeration of groups through the <code class="literal">setgrent()</code>,
<code class="literal">getgrent()</code> and
<code class="literal">endgrent()</code> group of system calls. If
@@ -4874,7 +5941,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
<code class="constant">no</code>, calls to the <code class="literal">getgrent()</code> system
call will not return any data. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>Turning off group enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly. </p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind enum groups</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMUSERS"></a>winbind enum users (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586080"></a>
+
+winbind enum users (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586081"></a><a name="WINBINDENUMUSERS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be
necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the <code class="literal">setpwent()</code>,
<code class="literal">getpwent()</code> and
<code class="literal">endpwent()</code> group of system calls. If
@@ -4886,10 +5956,13 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
full user list when searching for matching
usernames. </p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind enum users</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDEXPANDGROUPS"></a>winbind expand groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum depth that winbindd
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586173"></a>
+
+winbind expand groups (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586174"></a><a name="WINBINDEXPANDGROUPS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This option controls the maximum depth that winbindd
will traverse when flattening nested group memberships
of Windows domain groups. This is different from the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id335788"></a>winbind nested groups option
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDNESTEDGROUPS">winbind nested groups</a> option
which implements the Windows NT4 model of local group
nesting. The "winbind expand groups"
parameter specifically applies to the membership of
@@ -4898,7 +5971,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
must perform the group unrolling and will be unable to answer
incoming NSS or authentication requests during this time.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind expand groups</code></em> = <code class="literal">1</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDNESTEDGROUPS"></a>winbind nested groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If set to yes, this parameter activates the support for nested
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586242"></a>
+
+winbind nested groups (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586243"></a><a name="WINBINDNESTEDGROUPS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If set to yes, this parameter activates the support for nested
groups. Nested groups are also called local groups or
aliases. They work like their counterparts in Windows: Nested
groups are defined locally on any machine (they are shared
@@ -4906,7 +5982,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
global groups from any trusted SAM. To be able to use nested
groups, you need to run nss_winbind.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind nested groups</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDNORMALIZENAMES"></a>winbind normalize names (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether winbindd will replace
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586291"></a>
+
+winbind normalize names (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586292"></a><a name="WINBINDNORMALIZENAMES"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether winbindd will replace
whitespace in user and group names with an underscore (_) character.
For example, whether the name "Space Kadet" should be
replaced with the string "space_kadet".
@@ -4918,14 +5997,17 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind normalize names</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDNSSINFO"></a>winbind nss info (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control how Winbind retrieves Name
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586358"></a>
+
+winbind nss info (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586359"></a><a name="WINBINDNSSINFO"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control how Winbind retrieves Name
Service Information to construct a user's home directory and login shell.
Currently the following settings are available:
</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>template</code></em>
- The default, using the parameters of <em class="parameter"><code>template
shell</code></em> and <em class="parameter"><code>template homedir</code></em>)
- </p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>sfu</code></em>
+ </p></li><li><p><em class="parameter"><code>&lt;sfu | rfc2307 &gt;</code></em>
- When Samba is running in security = ads and your Active Directory
Domain Controller does support the Microsoft "Services for Unix" (SFU)
LDAP schema, winbind can retrieve the login shell and the home
@@ -4940,7 +6022,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind nss info</code></em> = <code class="literal">template sfu</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDOFFLINELOGON"></a>winbind offline logon (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control whether Winbind should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586478"></a>
+
+winbind offline logon (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586479"></a><a name="WINBINDOFFLINELOGON"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control whether Winbind should
allow to login with the <em class="parameter"><code>pam_winbind</code></em>
module using Cached Credentials. If enabled, winbindd will store user credentials
from successful logins encrypted in a local cache.
@@ -4948,20 +6033,29 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind offline logon</code></em> = <code class="literal">true</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDREFRESHTICKETS"></a>winbind refresh tickets (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control whether Winbind should refresh Kerberos Tickets
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586547"></a>
+
+winbind refresh tickets (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586548"></a><a name="WINBINDREFRESHTICKETS"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to control whether Winbind should refresh Kerberos Tickets
retrieved using the <em class="parameter"><code>pam_winbind</code></em> module.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind refresh tickets</code></em> = <code class="literal">false</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind refresh tickets</code></em> = <code class="literal">true</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDRPCONLY"></a>winbind rpc only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586614"></a>
+
+winbind rpc only (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586615"></a><a name="WINBINDRPCONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
Setting this parameter to <code class="literal">yes</code> forces
winbindd to use RPC instead of LDAP to retrieve information from Domain
Controllers.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind rpc only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDSEPARATOR"></a>winbind separator (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows an admin to define the character
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586662"></a>
+
+winbind separator (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586663"></a><a name="WINBINDSEPARATOR"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows an admin to define the character
used when listing a username of the form of <em class="replaceable"><code>DOMAIN
</code></em>\<em class="replaceable"><code>user</code></em>. This parameter
is only applicable when using the <code class="filename">pam_winbind.so</code>
@@ -4972,7 +6066,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind separator</code></em> = <code class="literal">+</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDTRUSTEDDOMAINSONLY"></a>winbind trusted domains only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586750"></a>
+
+winbind trusted domains only (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586751"></a><a name="WINBINDTRUSTEDDOMAINSONLY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter is designed to allow Samba servers that are members
of a Samba controlled domain to use UNIX accounts distributed via NIS,
rsync, or LDAP as the uid's for winbindd users in the hosts primary domain.
@@ -4980,12 +6077,15 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
the account user1 in /etc/passwd instead of allocating a new uid for him or her.
</p><p>
This parameter is now deprecated in favor of the newer idmap_nss backend.
- Refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id336317"></a>idmap domains smb.conf option and
- the <a href="idmap_nss.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_nss</span>(8)</span></a> man page for more information.
+ Refer to the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a> smb.conf option and
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="idmap_nss.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">idmap_nss</span>(8)</span></a> man page for more information.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind trusted domains only</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"></a>winbind use default domain (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether the
- <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon should operate on users
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586828"></a>
+
+winbind use default domain (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586829"></a><a name="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon should operate on users
without domain component in their username. Users without a domain
component are treated as is part of the winbindd server's own
domain. While this does not benifit Windows users, it makes SSH, FTP and
@@ -4994,7 +6094,10 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>winbind use default domain</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSHOOK"></a>wins hook (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When Samba is running as a WINS server this
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2586901"></a>
+
+wins hook (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2586902"></a><a name="WINSHOOK"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>When Samba is running as a WINS server this
allows you to call an external program for all changes to the
WINS database. The primary use for this option is to allow the
dynamic update of external name resolution databases such as
@@ -5015,12 +6118,18 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
addresses currently registered for that name. If this list is
empty then the name should be deleted.</p></li></ul></div><p>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update
program <code class="literal">nsupdate</code> is provided in the examples
- directory of the Samba source code. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSPROXY"></a>wins proxy (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will respond to broadcast name
+ directory of the Samba source code. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587007"></a>
+
+wins proxy (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587008"></a><a name="WINSPROXY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls if <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will respond to broadcast name
queries on behalf of other hosts. You may need to set this
to <code class="constant">yes</code> for some older clients.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>wins proxy</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSSERVER"></a>wins server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP
- address for preference) of the WINS server that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> should register with. If you have a WINS server on
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587062"></a>
+
+wins server (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587063"></a><a name="WINSSERVER"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP
+ address for preference) of the WINS server that <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> should register with. If you have a WINS server on
your network then you should set this to the WINS server's IP.</p><p>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
multi-subnetted network.</p><p>If you want to work in multiple namespaces, you can
give every wins server a 'tag'. For each tag, only one
@@ -5038,21 +6147,33 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>wins server</code></em> = <code class="literal">192.9.200.1 192.168.2.61</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSSUPPORT"></a>wins support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587172"></a>
+
+wins support (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587173"></a><a name="WINSSUPPORT"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls if the <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should
not set this to <code class="constant">yes</code> unless you have a multi-subnetted network and
you wish a particular <code class="literal">nmbd</code> to be your WINS server.
Note that you should <span class="emphasis"><em>NEVER</em></span> set this to <code class="constant">yes</code>
on more than one machine in your network.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>wins support</code></em> = <code class="literal">no</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WORKGROUP"></a>workgroup (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what workgroup your server will
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587242"></a>
+
+workgroup (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587243"></a><a name="WORKGROUP"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This controls what workgroup your server will
appear to be in when queried by clients. Note that this parameter
also controls the Domain name used with
- the <a class="indexterm" name="id336750"></a>security = domain
+ the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = domain</a>
setting.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>workgroup</code></em> = <code class="literal">WORKGROUP</code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>workgroup</code></em> = <code class="literal">MYGROUP</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITABLE"></a>writable</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITEABLE"></a>writeable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Inverted synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id336834"></a>read only.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITECACHESIZE"></a>write cache size (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587314"></a><a name="WRITABLE"></a>writable</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587315"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a synonym for <a class="link" href="#WRITEABLE">writeable</a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587344"></a>
+
+writeable (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587345"></a><a name="WRITEABLE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>Inverted synonym for <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</a>.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>No default</em></span></p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587383"></a>
+
+write cache size (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587384"></a><a name="WRITECACHESIZE"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
Samba will create an in-memory cache for each oplocked file
(it does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> do this for
non-oplocked files). All writes that the client does not request
@@ -5070,26 +6191,35 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>write cache size</code></em> = <code class="literal">262144
# for a 256k cache size per file</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITELIST"></a>write list (S)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587473"></a>
+
+write list (S)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587474"></a><a name="WRITELIST"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This is a list of users that are given read-write access to a service. If the
connecting user is in this list then they will be given write access, no matter
- what the <a class="indexterm" name="id336942"></a>read only option is set to. The list can
+ what the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</a> option is set to. The list can
include group names using the @group syntax.
</p><p>
Note that if a user is in both the read list and the write list then they will be
given write access.
</p><p>
By design, this parameter will not work with the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id336958"></a>security = share in Samba 3.0.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY">security = share</a> in Samba 3.0.
</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>write list</code></em> = <code class="literal"></code>
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>write list</code></em> = <code class="literal">admin, root, @staff</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WRITERAW"></a>write raw (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587566"></a>
+
+write raw (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587567"></a><a name="WRITERAW"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not the server
will support raw write SMB's when transferring data from clients.
You should never need to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>write raw</code></em> = <code class="literal">yes</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WTMPDIRECTORY"></a>wtmp directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="section" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2587610"></a>
+
+wtmp directory (G)
+</h3></div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2587611"></a><a name="WTMPDIRECTORY"></a><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt></dt><dd><p>
This parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled with the option <code class="literal">
--with-utmp</code>. It specifies a directory pathname that is used to store the wtmp or wtmpx files (depending on
the UNIX system) that record user connections to a Samba server. The difference with the utmp directory is the fact
@@ -5101,12 +6231,12 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
</em></span>
</p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em><em class="parameter"><code>wtmp directory</code></em> = <code class="literal">/var/log/wtmp</code>
</em></span>
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id337116"></a><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p>
+</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2587693"></a><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p>
Although the configuration file permits service names to contain spaces, your client software may not.
Spaces will be ignored in comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a problem - but be aware of the possibility.
</p><p>
On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients - limit service names to eight characters.
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has no such
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> has no such
limitation, but attempts to connect from such clients will fail if they truncate the service names. For this
reason you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters in length.
</p><p>
@@ -5114,13 +6244,13 @@ veto oplock files = /.*SEM/
for an administrator easy, but the various combinations of default attributes can be tricky. Take extreme
care when designing these sections. In particular, ensure that the permissions on spool directories are
correct.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id337159"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id337169"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id337249"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2587743"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2587754"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="swat.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">swat</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="nmblookup.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmblookup</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2587834"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
</p><p>
The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion
to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by
Alexander Bokovoy.
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcacls.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcacls.1.html
index ffbf336c0b..9166d52fac 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcacls.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcacls.1.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcacls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcacls.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcacls &#8212; Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcacls</code> {//server/share} {filename} [-D acls] [-M acls] [-a acls] [-S acls] [-C name] [-G name] [--numeric] [-t] [-U username] [-h] [-d]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299261"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program manipulates NT Access Control
- Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266723"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>The following options are available to the <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcacls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcacls.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcacls &#8212; Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcacls</code> {//server/share} {filename} [-D acls] [-M acls] [-a acls] [-S acls] [-C name] [-G name] [--numeric] [-t] [-U username] [-h] [-d]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507237"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program manipulates NT Access Control
+ Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507266"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>The following options are available to the <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program.
The format of ACLs is described in the section ACL FORMAT </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a acls</span></dt><dd><p>Add the ACLs specified to the ACL list. Existing
access control entries are unchanged. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-M acls</span></dt><dd><p>Modify the mask value (permissions) for the ACLs
specified on the command line. An error will be printed for each
@@ -12,7 +12,7 @@
type, owner and group for the call to succeed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies a username used to connect to the
specified service. The username may be of the form "username" in
which case the user is prompted to enter in a password and the
- workgroup specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file is
+ workgroup specified in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file is
used, or "username%password" or "DOMAIN\username%password" and the
password and workgroup names are used as provided. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C name</span></dt><dd><p>The owner of a file or directory can be changed
to the name given using the <em class="parameter"><code>-C</code></em> option.
@@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266940"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ The default configuration file name is determined at
compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</span></dt><dd><p>Base directory name for log/debug files. The extension
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267004"></a><h2>ACL FORMAT</h2><p>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506379"></a><h2>ACL FORMAT</h2><p>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </p><pre class="programlisting">
REVISION:&lt;revision number&gt;
OWNER:&lt;sid or name&gt;
@@ -68,23 +68,22 @@ ACL:&lt;sid or name&gt;:&lt;type&gt;/&lt;flags&gt;/&lt;mask&gt;
can be specified in S-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case
it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory
resides. The type, flags and mask values determine the type of
- access granted to the SID. </p><p>The type can be either 0 or 1 corresponding to ALLOWED or
- DENIED access to the SID. The flags values are generally
- zero for file ACLs and either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs. Some
- common flags are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT 0x1</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT 0x2</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT 0x4</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY 0x8</code></p></li></ul></div><p>At present flags can only be specified as decimal or
+ access granted to the SID. </p><p>The type can be either ALLOWED or DENIED to allow/deny access
+ to the SID. The flags values are generally zero for file ACLs and
+ either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs. Some common flags are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT 0x1</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT 0x2</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT 0x4</code></p></li><li><p><code class="constant">#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY 0x8</code></p></li></ul></div><p>At present flags can only be specified as decimal or
hexadecimal values.</p><p>The mask is a value which expresses the access right
granted to the SID. It can be given as a decimal or hexadecimal value,
or by using one of the following text strings which map to the NT
file permissions of the same name. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>R</em></span> - Allow read access </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>W</em></span> - Allow write access</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> - Execute permission on the object</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - Delete the object</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>P</em></span> - Change permissions</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>O</em></span> - Take ownership</p></li></ul></div><p>The following combined permissions can be specified:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>READ</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RX'
permissions</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>CHANGE</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RXWD' permissions
</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>FULL</em></span> - Equivalent to 'RWXDPO'
- permissions</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308009"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program sets the exit status
+ permissions</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506544"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> program sets the exit status
depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
The exit status may be one of the following values. </p><p>If the operation succeeded, smbcacls returns and exit
status of 0. If <code class="literal">smbcacls</code> couldn't connect to the specified server,
or there was an error getting or setting the ACLs, an exit status
of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
- arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308038"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308049"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506577"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506588"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><code class="literal">smbcacls</code> was written by Andrew Tridgell
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbclient.1.html
index e965d241a3..8e5629def0 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbclient.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbclient.1.html
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbclient &#8212; ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
- on servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-e] [-L &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-U username] [-I destinationIP] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-k] [-P] [-c &lt;command&gt;]</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> {servicename} [password] [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-e] [-D Directory] [-U username] [-W workgroup] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-l log-basename] [-I destinationIP] [-E] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan] [-k]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266947"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> is a client that can
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbclient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbclient.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbclient &#8212; ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
+ on servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-e] [-L &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-U username] [-I destinationIP] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-k] [-P] [-c &lt;command&gt;]</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> {servicename} [password] [-b &lt;buffer size&gt;] [-d debuglevel] [-e] [-D Directory] [-U username] [-W workgroup] [-M &lt;netbios name&gt;] [-m maxprotocol] [-A authfile] [-N] [-l log-basename] [-I destinationIP] [-E] [-c &lt;command string&gt;] [-i scope] [-O &lt;socket options&gt;] [-p port] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan] [-k]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507473"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbclient</code> is a client that can
'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It offers an interface
- similar to that of the ftp program (see <a href="ftp.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ftp</span>(1)</span></a>).
+ similar to that of the ftp program (see <a class="citerefentry" href="ftp.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ftp</span>(1)</span></a>).
Operations include things like getting files from the server
to the local machine, putting files from the local machine to
the server, retrieving directory information from the server
- and so on. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266984"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">servicename</span></dt><dd><p>servicename is the name of the service
+ and so on. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507513"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">servicename</span></dt><dd><p>servicename is the name of the service
you want to use on the server. A service name takes the form
<code class="filename">//server/service</code> where <em class="parameter"><code>server
</code></em> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS server
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
</p><p>The server name is looked up according to either
the <em class="parameter"><code>-R</code></em> parameter to <code class="literal">smbclient</code> or
using the name resolve order parameter in
- the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file,
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file,
allowing an administrator to change the order and methods
by which server names are looked up. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password</span></dt><dd><p>The password required to access the specified
service on the specified server. If this parameter is
@@ -43,7 +43,7 @@
cause names to be resolved as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">lmhosts</code>: Lookup an IP
address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see
- the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
any name type matches for lookup.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">host</code>: Do a standard host
name to IP address resolution, using the system <code class="filename">/etc/hosts
</code>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
@@ -60,10 +60,10 @@
parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
- defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file parameter
+ defined in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file parameter
(name resolve order) will be used. </p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without
this parameter or any entry in the <em class="parameter"><code>name resolve order
- </code></em> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution
+ </code></em> parameter of the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution
methods will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-M NetBIOS name</span></dt><dd><p>This options allows you to send messages, using
the "WinPopup" protocol, to another computer. Once a connection is
established you then type your message, pressing ^D (control-D) to
@@ -79,7 +79,7 @@
machine FRED.
</p><p>You may also find the <em class="parameter"><code>-U</code></em> and
<em class="parameter"><code>-I</code></em> options useful, as they allow you to
- control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </p><p>See the <em class="parameter"><code>message command</code></em> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for a description of how to handle incoming
+ control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </p><p>See the <em class="parameter"><code>message command</code></em> parameter in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for a description of how to handle incoming
WinPopup messages in Samba. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span>: Copy WinPopup into the startup group
on your WfWg PCs if you want them to always be able to receive
messages. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p port</span></dt><dd><p>This number is the TCP port number that will be used
@@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id308361"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ via the <code class="literal">ps</code> command. To be safe always allow
<code class="literal">rpcclient</code> to prompt for a password and type
it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n &lt;primary NetBIOS name&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override
the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical
-to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id308547"></a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
+to setting the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</a> parameter in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.
However, a command
line setting will take precedence over settings in
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i &lt;scope&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that
@@ -267,7 +267,7 @@ options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbcli
only of any use with the tar -T option. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c command string</span></dt><dd><p>command string is a semicolon-separated list of
commands to be executed instead of prompting from stdin. <em class="parameter"><code>
-N</code></em> is implied by <em class="parameter"><code>-c</code></em>.</p><p>This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin
- to the server, e.g. <code class="literal">-c 'print -'</code>. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id309059"></a><h2>OPERATIONS</h2><p>Once the client is running, the user is presented with
+ to the server, e.g. <code class="literal">-c 'print -'</code>. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554331"></a><h2>OPERATIONS</h2><p>Once the client is running, the user is presented with
a prompt : </p><p><code class="prompt">smb:\&gt; </code></p><p>The backslash ("\\") indicates the current working directory
on the server, and will change if the current working directory
is changed. </p><p>The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to
@@ -464,14 +464,14 @@ options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbcli
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">vuid &lt;number&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Changes the currently used vuid in the protocol to
the given arbitrary number. Without an argument prints out the current
vuid being used. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310037"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555435"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
passwords, share names (AKA service names) and machine names.
If you fail to connect try giving all parameters in uppercase.
</p><p>It is often necessary to use the -n option when connecting
to some types of servers. For example OS/2 LanManager insists
on a valid NetBIOS name being used, so you need to supply a valid
name that would be known to the server.</p><p>smbclient supports long file names where the server
- supports the LANMAN2 protocol or above. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310058"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The variable <code class="envar">USER</code> may contain the
+ supports the LANMAN2 protocol or above. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555460"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The variable <code class="envar">USER</code> may contain the
username of the person using the client. This information is
used only if the protocol level is high enough to support
session-level passwords.</p><p>The variable <code class="envar">PASSWD</code> may contain
@@ -481,7 +481,7 @@ options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbcli
the path, executed with system(), which the client should connect
to instead of connecting to a server. This functionality is primarily
intended as a development aid, and works best when using a LMHOSTS
- file</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310091"></a><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>The location of the client program is a matter for
+ file</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555499"></a><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>The location of the client program is a matter for
individual system administrators. The following are thus
suggestions only. </p><p>It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed
in the <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin/</code> or <code class="filename">
@@ -490,18 +490,18 @@ options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbcli
be executable by all. The client should <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be
setuid or setgid! </p><p>The client log files should be put in a directory readable
and writeable only by the user. </p><p>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a
- running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon
+ running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon
on a user-accessible port (typically any port number over 1024)
- would provide a suitable test server. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310140"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a
+ would provide a suitable test server. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555554"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a
specified log file. The log file name is specified at compile time,
but may be overridden on the command line. </p><p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
on the debug level used by the client. If you have problems,
- set the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310156"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.2 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id310167"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ set the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555573"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.2 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2555584"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcontrol.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcontrol.1.html
index 0c092546d1..013be4f7de 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcontrol.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcontrol.1.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcontrol</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcontrol.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcontrol &#8212; send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> [-i] [-s]</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> [destination] [message-type] [parameter]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299210"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> is a very small program, which
- sends messages to a <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, a <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, or a <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon running on the system.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299260"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcontrol</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcontrol.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcontrol &#8212; send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> [-i] [-s]</p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> [destination] [message-type] [parameter]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507196"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbcontrol</code> is a very small program, which
+ sends messages to a <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, a <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, or a <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon running on the system.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507247"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
information in this file includes server-specific
@@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Run interactiv
<code class="filename">nmbd.pid</code> file.</p><p>If a single process ID is given, the message is sent
to only that process.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">message-type</span></dt><dd><p>Type of message to send. See
the section <code class="constant">MESSAGE-TYPES</code> for details.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">parameters</span></dt><dd><p>any parameters required for the message-type</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266827"></a><h2>MESSAGE-TYPES</h2><p>Available message types are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">close-share</span></dt><dd><p>Order smbd to close the client
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">parameters</span></dt><dd><p>any parameters required for the message-type</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507389"></a><h2>MESSAGE-TYPES</h2><p>Available message types are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">close-share</span></dt><dd><p>Order smbd to close the client
connections to the named share. Note that this doesn't affect client
connections to any other shares. This message-type takes an argument of the
share name for which client connections will be closed, or the
@@ -59,13 +59,13 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Run interactiv
to update their local version of the driver. Can only be
sent to smbd.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">reload-config</span></dt><dd><p>Force daemon to reload smb.conf configuration file. Can be sent
to <code class="constant">smbd</code>, <code class="constant">nmbd</code>, or <code class="constant">winbindd</code>.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308032"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308042"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308067"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506454"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506465"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506489"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcquotas.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcquotas.1.html
index 80dcf4b2a4..036033ba4b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcquotas.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbcquotas.1.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcquotas</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcquotas.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcquotas &#8212; Set or get QUOTAs of NTFS 5 shares</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> {//server/share} [-u user] [-L] [-F] [-S QUOTA_SET_COMMAND] [-n] [-t] [-v] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-l logdir] [-V] [-U username] [-N] [-k] [-A]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266718"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program manipulates NT Quotas on SMB file shares. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266745"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>The following options are available to the <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-u user</span></dt><dd><p> Specifies the user of whom the quotas are get or set.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbcquotas</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbcquotas.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbcquotas &#8212; Set or get QUOTAs of NTFS 5 shares</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> {//server/share} [-u user] [-L] [-F] [-S QUOTA_SET_COMMAND] [-n] [-t] [-v] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-l logdir] [-V] [-U username] [-N] [-k] [-A]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507267"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program manipulates NT Quotas on SMB file shares. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507296"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>The following options are available to the <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-u user</span></dt><dd><p> Specifies the user of whom the quotas are get or set.
By default the current user's username will be used.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L</span></dt><dd><p>Lists all quota records of the share.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>Show the share quota status and default limits.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S QUOTA_SET_COMMAND</span></dt><dd><p>This command sets/modifies quotas for a user or on the share,
depending on the QUOTA_SET_COMMAND parameter which is described later.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n</span></dt><dd><p>This option displays all QUOTA information in numeric
format. The default is to convert SIDs to names and QUOTA limits
@@ -19,7 +19,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266903"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ on the file restrict access from unwanted users. See the
many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
via the <code class="literal">ps</code> command. To be safe always allow
<code class="literal">rpcclient</code> to prompt for a password and type
-it in directly. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307936"></a><h2>QUOTA_SET_COMAND</h2><p>The format of an the QUOTA_SET_COMMAND is an operation
+it in directly. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506470"></a><h2>QUOTA_SET_COMAND</h2><p>The format of an the QUOTA_SET_COMMAND is an operation
name followed by a set of parameters specific to that operation.
</p><p>To set user quotas for the user specified by -u or for the
current username: </p><p><strong class="userinput"><code>
@@ -74,13 +74,13 @@ it in directly. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a nam
To change the share quota settings:
</p><p><strong class="userinput"><code>
FSQFLAGS:QUOTA_ENABLED/DENY_DISK/LOG_SOFTLIMIT/LOG_HARD_LIMIT
- </code></strong></p><p>All limits are specified as a number of bytes.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307984"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program sets the exit status
+ </code></strong></p><p>All limits are specified as a number of bytes.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506522"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> program sets the exit status
depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
The exit status may be one of the following values. </p><p>If the operation succeeded, smbcquotas returns an exit
status of 0. If <code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> couldn't connect to the specified server,
or when there was an error getting or setting the quota(s), an exit status
of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
- arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308013"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308024"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506555"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506566"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><code class="literal">smbcquotas</code> was written by Stefan Metzmacher.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbd.8.html
index d7aa0fcc6b..1c7fb288bc 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbd.8.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbd &#8212; server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-h] [-V] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-p &lt;port number(s)&gt;] [-P &lt;profiling level&gt;] [-O &lt;socket option&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267087"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbd</code> is the server daemon that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbd &#8212; server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-h] [-V] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l &lt;log directory&gt;] [-p &lt;port number(s)&gt;] [-P &lt;profiling level&gt;] [-O &lt;socket option&gt;] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507242"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbd</code> is the server daemon that
provides filesharing and printing services to Windows clients.
The server provides filespace and printer services to
clients using the SMB (or CIFS) protocol. This is compatible
@@ -8,10 +8,10 @@
OS/2, DAVE for Macintosh, and smbfs for Linux.</p><p>An extensive description of the services that the
server can provide is given in the man page for the
configuration file controlling the attributes of those
- services (see <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>. This man page will not describe the
+ services (see <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>. This man page will not describe the
services, but will concentrate on the administrative aspects
of running the server.</p><p>Please note that there are significant security
- implications to running this server, and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page should be regarded as mandatory reading before
+ implications to running this server, and the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page should be regarded as mandatory reading before
proceeding with installation.</p><p>A session is created whenever a client requests one.
Each client gets a copy of the server for each session. This
copy then services all connections made by the client during
@@ -21,7 +21,7 @@
can force a reload by sending a SIGHUP to the server. Reloading
the configuration file will not affect connections to any service
that is already established. Either the user will have to
- disconnect from the service, or <code class="literal">smbd</code> killed and restarted.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299258"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+ disconnect from the service, or <code class="literal">smbd</code> killed and restarted.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507329"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
the server to operate as a daemon. That is, it detaches
itself and runs in the background, fielding requests
on the appropriate port. Operating the server as a
@@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266843"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -76,13 +76,13 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b</span></dt><dd><p>Prints information about how
Samba was built.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p|--port&lt;port number(s)&gt;</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>port number(s)</code></em> is a
space or comma-separated list of TCP ports smbd should listen on.
- The default value is taken from the <a class="indexterm" name="id307893"></a>ports parameter in <code class="filename">smb.conf</code></p><p>The default ports are 139 (used for SMB over NetBIOS over TCP)
+ The default value is taken from the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PORTS">ports</a> parameter in <code class="filename">smb.conf</code></p><p>The default ports are 139 (used for SMB over NetBIOS over TCP)
and port 445 (used for plain SMB over TCP).
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P|--profiling-level&lt;profiling level&gt;</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>profiling level</code></em> is a
number specifying the level of profiling data to be collected.
0 turns off profiling, 1 turns on counter profiling only,
2 turns on complete profiling, and 3 resets all profiling data.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307926"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506464"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the
<code class="literal">inetd</code> meta-daemon, this file
must contain suitable startup information for the
meta-daemon.
@@ -93,23 +93,23 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
meta-daemon <code class="literal">inetd</code>, this file
must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems
install this file are <code class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
and <code class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</p><p>This file describes all the services the server
- is to make available to clients. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for more information.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308046"></a><h2>LIMITATIONS</h2><p>On some systems <code class="literal">smbd</code> cannot change uid back
+ is to make available to clients. See <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for more information.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506591"></a><h2>LIMITATIONS</h2><p>On some systems <code class="literal">smbd</code> cannot change uid back
to root after a setuid() call. Such systems are called
trapdoor uid systems. If you have such a system,
you will be unable to connect from a client (such as a PC) as
two different users at once. Attempts to connect the
second user will result in access denied or
- similar.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308065"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="envar">PRINTER</code></span></dt><dd><p>If no printer name is specified to
+ similar.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506613"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="envar">PRINTER</code></span></dt><dd><p>If no printer name is specified to
printable services, most systems will use the value of
this variable (or <code class="constant">lp</code> if this variable is
not defined) as the name of the printer to use. This
- is not specific to the server, however.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308092"></a><h2>PAM INTERACTION</h2><p>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext
+ is not specific to the server, however.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506642"></a><h2>PAM INTERACTION</h2><p>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext
password), for account checking (is this account disabled?) and for
session management. The degree too which samba supports PAM is restricted
- by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <a class="indexterm" name="id308102"></a>obey pam restrictions <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply:
+ by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS">obey pam restrictions</a> <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply:
</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Account Validation</em></span>: All accesses to a
samba server are checked
against PAM to see if the account is vaild, not disabled and is permitted to
@@ -119,8 +119,8 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
is granted. Note however, that this is bypassed in share level secuirty.
Note also that some older pam configuration files may need a line
added for session support.
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308141"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308151"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506704"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506714"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged
in a specified log file. The log file name is specified
at compile time, but may be overridden on the command line.</p><p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
on the debug level used by the server. If you have problems, set
@@ -129,10 +129,10 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
available in the source code to warrant describing each and every
diagnostic. At this stage your best bet is still to grep the
source code and inspect the conditions that gave rise to the
- diagnostics you are seeing.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308174"></a><h2>TDB FILES</h2><p>Samba stores it's data in several TDB (Trivial Database) files, usually located in <code class="filename">/var/lib/samba</code>.</p><p>
+ diagnostics you are seeing.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506743"></a><h2>TDB FILES</h2><p>Samba stores it's data in several TDB (Trivial Database) files, usually located in <code class="filename">/var/lib/samba</code>.</p><p>
(*) information persistent across restarts (but not
necessarily important to backup).
- </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">account_policy.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>NT account policy settings such as pw expiration, etc...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">brlock.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>byte range locks</p></dd><dt><span class="term">browse.dat</span></dt><dd><p>browse lists</p></dd><dt><span class="term">connections.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>share connections (used to enforce max connections, etc...)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">gencache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>generic caching db</p></dd><dt><span class="term">group_mapping.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>group mapping information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">locking.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>share modes &amp; oplocks</p></dd><dt><span class="term">login_cache.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>bad pw attempts</p></dd><dt><span class="term">messages.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Samba messaging system</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netsamlogon_cache.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>cache of user net_info_3 struct from net_samlogon() request (as a domain member)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntdrivers.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer drivers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntforms.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer forms</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntprinters.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">printing/</span></dt><dd><p>directory containing tdb per print queue of cached lpq output</p></dd><dt><span class="term">registry.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Windows registry skeleton (connect via regedit.exe)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">sessionid.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>session information (e.g. support for 'utmp = yes')</p></dd><dt><span class="term">share_info.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>share acls</p></dd><dt><span class="term">winbindd_cache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>winbindd's cache of user lists, etc...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">winbindd_idmap.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>winbindd's local idmap db</p></dd><dt><span class="term">wins.dat*</span></dt><dd><p>wins database when 'wins support = yes'</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308406"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>Sending the <code class="literal">smbd</code> a SIGHUP will cause it to
+ </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">account_policy.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>NT account policy settings such as pw expiration, etc...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">brlock.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>byte range locks</p></dd><dt><span class="term">browse.dat</span></dt><dd><p>browse lists</p></dd><dt><span class="term">connections.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>share connections (used to enforce max connections, etc...)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">gencache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>generic caching db</p></dd><dt><span class="term">group_mapping.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>group mapping information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">locking.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>share modes &amp; oplocks</p></dd><dt><span class="term">login_cache.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>bad pw attempts</p></dd><dt><span class="term">messages.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Samba messaging system</p></dd><dt><span class="term">netsamlogon_cache.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>cache of user net_info_3 struct from net_samlogon() request (as a domain member)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntdrivers.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer drivers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntforms.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer forms</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntprinters.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>installed printer information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">printing/</span></dt><dd><p>directory containing tdb per print queue of cached lpq output</p></dd><dt><span class="term">registry.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Windows registry skeleton (connect via regedit.exe)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">sessionid.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>session information (e.g. support for 'utmp = yes')</p></dd><dt><span class="term">share_info.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>share acls</p></dd><dt><span class="term">winbindd_cache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>winbindd's cache of user lists, etc...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">winbindd_idmap.tdb*</span></dt><dd><p>winbindd's local idmap db</p></dd><dt><span class="term">wins.dat*</span></dt><dd><p>wins database when 'wins support = yes'</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553687"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>Sending the <code class="literal">smbd</code> a SIGHUP will cause it to
reload its <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> configuration
file within a short period of time.</p><p>To shut down a user's <code class="literal">smbd</code> process it is recommended
that <code class="literal">SIGKILL (-9)</code> <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span>
@@ -140,23 +140,23 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
memory area in an inconsistent state. The safe way to terminate
an <code class="literal">smbd</code> is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for
it to die on its own.</p><p>The debug log level of <code class="literal">smbd</code> may be raised
- or lowered using <a href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer
+ or lowered using <a class="citerefentry" href="smbcontrol.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbcontrol</span>(1)</span></a> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer
used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,
whilst still running at a normally low log level.</p><p>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write,
they are not re-entrant in <code class="literal">smbd</code>. This you should wait until
<code class="literal">smbd</code> is in a state of waiting for an incoming SMB before
issuing them. It is possible to make the signal handlers safe
by un-blocking the signals before the select call and re-blocking
- them after, however this would affect performance.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308492"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="hosts_access.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">hosts_access</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the
+ them after, however this would affect performance.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553781"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="hosts_access.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">hosts_access</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="inetd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">inetd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="testprns.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testprns</span>(1)</span></a>, and the
Internet RFC's <code class="filename">rfc1001.txt</code>, <code class="filename">rfc1002.txt</code>.
In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
- as a link from the Web page <a href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
- http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308576"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ as a link from the Web page <a class="ulink" href="http://samba.org/cifs/" target="_top">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553867"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbget.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbget.1.html
index ebe9e9419e..ecf3b08fb9 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbget.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbget.1.html
@@ -1,14 +1,14 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbget</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbget.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbget &#8212; wget-like utility for download files over SMB</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbget</code> [-a, --guest] [-r, --resume] [-R, --recursive] [-u, --username=STRING] [-p, --password=STRING] [-w, --workgroup=STRING] [-n, --nonprompt] [-d, --debuglevel=INT] [-D, --dots] [-P, --keep-permissions] [-o, --outputfile] [-f, --rcfile] [-q, --quiet] [-v, --verbose] [-b, --blocksize] [-?, --help] [--usage] {smb://host/share/path/to/file} [smb://url2/] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266750"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbget is a simple utility with wget-like semantics, that can download files from SMB servers. You can specify the files you would like to download on the command-line.
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbget</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbget.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbget &#8212; wget-like utility for download files over SMB</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbget</code> [-a, --guest] [-r, --resume] [-R, --recursive] [-u, --username=STRING] [-p, --password=STRING] [-w, --workgroup=STRING] [-n, --nonprompt] [-d, --debuglevel=INT] [-D, --dots] [-P, --keep-permissions] [-o, --outputfile] [-f, --rcfile] [-q, --quiet] [-v, --verbose] [-b, --blocksize] [-?, --help] [--usage] {smb://host/share/path/to/file} [smb://url2/] [...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507294"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbget is a simple utility with wget-like semantics, that can download files from SMB servers. You can specify the files you would like to download on the command-line.
</p><p>
The files should be in the smb-URL standard, e.g. use smb://host/share/file
for the UNC path <span class="emphasis"><em>\\\\HOST\\SHARE\\file</em></span>.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266781"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><dt><span class="term">-a, --guest</span></dt><dd><p>Work as user guest</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r, --resume</span></dt><dd><p>Automatically resume aborted files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R, --recursive</span></dt><dd><p>Recursively download files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u, --username=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Username to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p, --password=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Password to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w, --workgroup=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Workgroup to use (optional)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n, --nonprompt</span></dt><dd><p>Don't ask anything (non-interactive)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d, --debuglevel=INT</span></dt><dd><p>Debuglevel to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D, --dots</span></dt><dd><p>Show dots as progress indication</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P, --keep-permissions</span></dt><dd><p>Set same permissions on local file as are set on remote file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-o, --outputfile</span></dt><dd><p>Write the file that is being download to the specified file. Can not be used together with -R.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f, --rcfile</span></dt><dd><p>Use specified rcfile. This will be loaded in the order it was specified - e.g. if you specify any options before this one, they might get overriden by the contents of the rcfile.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-q, --quiet</span></dt><dd><p>Be quiet</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v, --verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Be verbose</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b, --blocksize</span></dt><dd><p>Number of bytes to download in a block. Defaults to 64000.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-?, --help</span></dt><dd><p>Show help message</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--usage</span></dt><dd><p>Display brief usage message</p></dd></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267003"></a><h2>SMB URLS</h2><p> SMB URL's should be specified in the following format:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507327"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><dt><span class="term">-a, --guest</span></dt><dd><p>Work as user guest</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r, --resume</span></dt><dd><p>Automatically resume aborted files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R, --recursive</span></dt><dd><p>Recursively download files</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u, --username=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Username to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p, --password=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Password to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w, --workgroup=STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Workgroup to use (optional)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n, --nonprompt</span></dt><dd><p>Don't ask anything (non-interactive)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d, --debuglevel=INT</span></dt><dd><p>Debuglevel to use</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D, --dots</span></dt><dd><p>Show dots as progress indication</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P, --keep-permissions</span></dt><dd><p>Set same permissions on local file as are set on remote file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-o, --outputfile</span></dt><dd><p>Write the file that is being download to the specified file. Can not be used together with -R.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f, --rcfile</span></dt><dd><p>Use specified rcfile. This will be loaded in the order it was specified - e.g. if you specify any options before this one, they might get overriden by the contents of the rcfile.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-q, --quiet</span></dt><dd><p>Be quiet</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v, --verbose</span></dt><dd><p>Be verbose</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b, --blocksize</span></dt><dd><p>Number of bytes to download in a block. Defaults to 64000.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-?, --help</span></dt><dd><p>Show help message</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--usage</span></dt><dd><p>Display brief usage message</p></dd></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506250"></a><h2>SMB URLS</h2><p> SMB URL's should be specified in the following format:</p><pre class="programlisting">
smb://[[[domain;]user[:password@]]server[/share[/path[/file]]]]
</pre><pre class="programlisting">
smb:// means all the workgroups
</pre><pre class="programlisting">
smb://name/ means, if <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> is a workgroup, all the servers in this workgroup, or if <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em> is a server, all the shares on this server.
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307898"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506291"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
# Recursively download 'src' directory
smbget -R smb://rhonwyn/jelmer/src
# Download FreeBSD ISO and enable resuming
@@ -17,10 +17,10 @@ smbget -r smb://rhonwyn/isos/FreeBSD5.1.iso
smbget -Rr smb://rhonwyn/isos
# Backup my data on rhonwyn
smbget -Rr smb://rhonwyn/
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307912"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Permission denied is returned in some cases where the cause of the error is unknown
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506309"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Permission denied is returned in some cases where the cause of the error is unknown
(such as an illegally formatted smb:// url or trying to get a directory without -R
-turned on).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307923"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307934"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+turned on).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506322"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506333"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The smbget manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbgetrc.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbgetrc.5.html
index ecc95a8ec3..f4f67c6ba5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbgetrc.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbgetrc.5.html
@@ -1,17 +1,17 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbgetrc</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbgetrc.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbgetrc &#8212; configuration file for smbget</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">smbgetrc</code></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267669"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbgetrc</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbgetrc.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbgetrc &#8212; configuration file for smbget</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">smbgetrc</code></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544114"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>
This manual page documents the format and options of the <span class="emphasis"><em>smbgetrc</em></span>
- file. This is the configuration file used by the <a href="smbget.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbget</span>(1)</span></a>
+ file. This is the configuration file used by the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbget.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbget</span>(1)</span></a>
utility. The file contains of key-value pairs, one pair on each line. The key
and value should be separated by a space.
</p><p>By default, smbget reads its configuration from <span class="emphasis"><em>$HOME/.smbgetrc</em></span>, though
- other locations can be specified using the command-line options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267698"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
+ other locations can be specified using the command-line options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544147"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><p>
The following keys can be set:
</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">resume on|off</span></dt><dd><p>
Whether aborted downloads should be automatically resumed.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recursive on|off</span></dt><dd><p>Whether directories should be downloaded recursively</p></dd><dt><span class="term">username <em class="replaceable"><code>name</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Username to use when logging in to the remote server. Use an empty string for anonymous access.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password <em class="replaceable"><code>pass</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Password to use when logging in.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">workgroup <em class="replaceable"><code>wg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Workgroup to use when logging in</p></dd><dt><span class="term">nonprompt on|off</span></dt><dd><p>Turns off asking for username and password. Useful for scripts.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">debuglevel <em class="replaceable"><code>int</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>(Samba) debuglevel to run at. Useful for tracking down protocol level problems.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dots on|off</span></dt><dd><p>Whether a single dot should be printed for each block that has been downloaded, instead of the default progress indicator.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">blocksize <em class="replaceable"><code>int</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Number of bytes to put in a block. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266742"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266752"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbget.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbget</span>(1)</span></a> and <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266777"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password <em class="replaceable"><code>pass</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Password to use when logging in.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">workgroup <em class="replaceable"><code>wg</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Workgroup to use when logging in</p></dd><dt><span class="term">nonprompt on|off</span></dt><dd><p>Turns off asking for username and password. Useful for scripts.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">debuglevel <em class="replaceable"><code>int</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>(Samba) debuglevel to run at. Useful for tracking down protocol level problems.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dots on|off</span></dt><dd><p>Whether a single dot should be printed for each block that has been downloaded, instead of the default progress indicator.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">blocksize <em class="replaceable"><code>int</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Number of bytes to put in a block. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507290"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507301"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbget.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbget</span>(1)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507326"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>This manual page was written by Jelmer Vernooij</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmnt.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmnt.8.html
deleted file mode 100644
index 2706d6f556..0000000000
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmnt.8.html
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbmnt</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbmnt.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbmnt &#8212; helper utility for mounting SMB filesystems</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbmnt</code> {mount-point} [-s &lt;share&gt;] [-r] [-u &lt;uid&gt;] [-g &lt;gid&gt;] [-f &lt;mask&gt;] [-d &lt;mask&gt;] [-o &lt;options&gt;] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299231"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p><code class="literal">smbmnt</code> is a helper application used
- by the smbmount program to do the actual mounting of SMB shares.
- <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> can be installed setuid root if you want
- normal users to be able to mount their SMB shares.</p><p>A setuid smbmnt will only allow mounts on directories owned
- by the user, and that the user has write permission on.</p><p>The <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> program is normally invoked
- by <a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>. It should not be invoked directly by users. </p><p>smbmount searches the normal PATH for smbmnt. You must ensure
- that the smbmnt version in your path matches the smbmount used.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266713"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>mount the filesystem read-only
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u uid</span></dt><dd><p>specify the uid that the files will
- be owned by </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g gid</span></dt><dd><p>specify the gid that the files will be
- owned by </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f mask</span></dt><dd><p>specify the octal file mask applied
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d mask</span></dt><dd><p>specify the octal directory mask
- applied </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-o options</span></dt><dd><p>
- list of options that are passed as-is to smbfs, if this
- command is run on a 2.4 or higher Linux kernel.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266803"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <code class="literal">smbmount</code>, <code class="literal">smbumount</code>,
- and <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
- The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
- is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
- was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmount.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmount.8.html
deleted file mode 100644
index 4ff97eaecf..0000000000
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbmount.8.html
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,110 +0,0 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbmount</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbmount.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbmount &#8212; mount an smbfs filesystem</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbmount</code> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267695"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p><code class="literal">smbmount</code> mounts a Linux SMB filesystem. It
- is usually invoked as <code class="literal">mount.smbfs</code> by
- the <a href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the
- "-t smbfs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must
- support the smbfs filesystem.</p><p>WARNING: <code class="literal">smbmount</code> is deprecated and not
- maintained any longer. <code class="literal">mount.cifs</code> (mount -t cifs)
- should be used instead of <code class="literal">smbmount</code>.</p><p>Options to <code class="literal">smbmount</code> are specified as a comma-separated
- list of key=value pairs. It is possible to send options other
- than those listed here, assuming that smbfs supports them. If
- you get mount failures, check your kernel log for errors on
- unknown options.</p><p><code class="literal">smbmount</code> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until
- the mounted smbfs is umounted. It will log things that happen
- when in daemon mode using the "machine name" smbmount, so
- typically this output will end up in <code class="filename">log.smbmount</code>. The <code class="literal">
- smbmount</code> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> <code class="literal">smbmount</code>
- calls <a href="smbmnt.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmnt</span>(8)</span></a> to do the actual mount. You
- must make sure that <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> is in the path so
- that it can be found. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266728"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">username=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
- specifies the username to connect as. If this is not given, then the environment variable <code class="envar"> USER</code>
- is used. This option can also take the form "user%password" or "user/workgroup" or "user/workgroup%password"
- to allow the password and workgroup to be specified as part of the username.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
- specifies the SMB password. If this option is not given then the environment
- variable <code class="literal">PASSWD</code> is used. If it can find no password
- <code class="literal">smbmount</code> will prompt for a password, unless the guest option is given.
- </p><p>
- Note that passwords which contain the argument delimiter character (i.e. a comma ',') will failed to be parsed
- correctly on the command line. However, the same password defined in the PASSWD environment variable or a
- credentials file (see below) will be read correctly.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">credentials=&lt;filename&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>specifies a file that contains a username and/or password.
-The format of the file is:
-</p><pre class="programlisting">
-username=value
-password=value
-</pre><p>This is preferred over having passwords in plaintext in a
- shared file, such as <code class="filename">/etc/fstab</code>. Be sure to protect any
- credentials file properly.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">krb</span></dt><dd><p>Use kerberos (Active Directory). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">netbiosname=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the source NetBIOS name. It defaults
- to the local hostname. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">uid=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the uid that will own all files on
- the mounted filesystem.
- It may be specified as either a username or a numeric uid.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">gid=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the gid that will own all files on
- the mounted filesystem.
- It may be specified as either a groupname or a numeric
- gid. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">port=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the remote SMB port number. The default
- is 445, fallback is 139. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">fmask=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>sets the file mask. This determines the
- permissions that remote files have in the local filesystem.
- This is not a umask, but the actual permissions for the files.
- The default is based on the current umask. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">dmask=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the directory mask. This determines the
- permissions that remote directories have in the local filesystem.
- This is not a umask, but the actual permissions for the directories.
- The default is based on the current umask. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">debug=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the debug level. This is useful for
- tracking down SMB connection problems. A suggested value to
- start with is 4. If set too high there will be a lot of
- output, possibly hiding the useful output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ip=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the destination host or IP address.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">workgroup=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the workgroup on the destination </p></dd><dt><span class="term">sockopt=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the TCP socket options. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS" target="_top"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></a> <em class="parameter"><code>socket options</code></em> option.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">scope=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the NetBIOS scope </p></dd><dt><span class="term">guest</span></dt><dd><p>Don't prompt for a password </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ro</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-only </p></dd><dt><span class="term">rw</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-write </p></dd><dt><span class="term">iocharset=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
- sets the charset used by the Linux side for codepage
- to charset translations (NLS). Argument should be the
- name of a charset, like iso8859-1. (Note: only kernel
- 2.4.0 or later)
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">codepage=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
- sets the codepage the server uses. See the iocharset
- option. Example value cp850. (Note: only kernel 2.4.0
- or later)
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ttl=&lt;arg&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>
- sets how long a directory listing is cached in milliseconds
- (also affects visibility of file size and date
- changes). A higher value means that changes on the
- server take longer to be noticed but it can give
- better performance on large directories, especially
- over long distances. Default is 1000ms but something
- like 10000ms (10 seconds) is probably more reasonable
- in many cases.
- (Note: only kernel 2.4.2 or later)
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307924"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The variable <code class="envar">USER</code> may contain the username of the
- person using the client. This information is used only if the
- protocol level is high enough to support session-level
- passwords. The variable can be used to set both username and
- password by using the format username%password.</p><p>The variable <code class="envar">PASSWD</code> may contain the password of the
- person using the client. This information is used only if the
- protocol level is high enough to support session-level
- passwords.</p><p>The variable <code class="envar">PASSWD_FILE</code> may contain the pathname
- of a file to read the password from. A single line of input is
- read and used as the password.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307955"></a><h2>OTHER COMMANDS</h2><p>
- File systems that have been mounted using the <code class="literal">smbmount</code>
- can be unmounted using the <code class="literal">smbumount</code> or the UNIX system
- <code class="literal">umount</code> command.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307984"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Passwords and other options containing , can not be handled.
- For passwords an alternative way of passing them is in a credentials
- file or in the PASSWD environment.</p><p>The credentials file does not handle usernames or passwords with
- leading space.</p><p>One smbfs bug is important enough to mention here, even if it
- is a bit misplaced:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Mounts sometimes stop working. This is usually
- caused by smbmount terminating. Since smbfs needs smbmount to
- reconnect when the server disconnects, the mount will eventually go
- dead. An umount/mount normally fixes this. At least 2 ways to
- trigger this bug are known.</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that the typical response to a bug report is suggestion
- to try the latest version first. So please try doing that first,
- and always include which versions you use of relevant software
- when reporting bugs (minimum: samba, kernel, distribution)</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308018"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>Documentation/filesystems/smbfs.txt in the linux kernel
- source tree may contain additional options and information.</p><p>FreeBSD also has a smbfs, but it is not related to smbmount</p><p>For Solaris, HP-UX and others you may want to look at <a href="smbsh.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbsh</span>(1)</span></a> or at other solutions, such as
- Sharity or perhaps replacing the SMB server with a NFS server.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308046"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <code class="literal">smbmount</code>, <code class="literal">smbumount</code>,
- and <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
- The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
- is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
- was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.5.html
index 53073de8ff..31715513f1 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.5.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; The Samba encrypted password file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">smbpasswd</code></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267669"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.5"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; The Samba encrypted password file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><p><code class="filename">smbpasswd</code></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544114"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains
the username, Unix user id and the SMB hashed passwords of the
user, as well as account flag information and the time the
password was last changed. This file format has been evolving with
- Samba and has had several different formats in the past. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267694"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.2
+ Samba and has had several different formats in the past. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544141"></a><h2>FILE FORMAT</h2><p>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.2
is very similar to the familiar Unix <code class="filename">passwd(5)</code>
file. It is an ASCII file containing one line for each user. Each field
ithin each line is separated from the next by a colon. Any entry
@@ -64,7 +64,7 @@
Password Hash and NT Password Hash are ignored). Note that this
will only allow users to log on with no password if the <em class="parameter"><code>
null passwords</code></em> parameter is set in the
- <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> config file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - This means the account
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> config file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - This means the account
is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins will be allowed for this user. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> - This means the password
does not expire. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>W</em></span> - This means this account
is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used
@@ -76,15 +76,15 @@
last modified. It consists of the characters 'LCT-' (standing for
"Last Change Time") followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time
in seconds since the epoch (1970) that the last change was made.
- </p></dd></dl></div><p>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266838"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266848"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and
+ </p></dd></dl></div><p>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507420"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507431"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and
the Internet RFC1321 for details on the MD4 algorithm.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266895"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507457"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.8.html
index 6c200b6e9e..d857153f41 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbpasswd.8.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; change a user's SMB password</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> [-a] [-c &lt;config file&gt;] [-x] [-d] [-e] [-D debuglevel] [-n] [-r &lt;remote machine&gt;] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-m] [-U username[%password]] [-h] [-s] [-w pass] [-W] [-i] [-L] [username]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266733"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The smbpasswd program has several different
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbpasswd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbpasswd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbpasswd &#8212; change a user's SMB password</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> [-a] [-c &lt;config file&gt;] [-x] [-d] [-e] [-D debuglevel] [-n] [-r &lt;remote machine&gt;] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-m] [-U username[%password]] [-h] [-s] [-w pass] [-W] [-i] [-L] [username]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507275"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The smbpasswd program has several different
functions, depending on whether it is run by the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> user
or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change
the password used for their SMB sessions on any machines that store
@@ -8,10 +8,10 @@
smbpasswd</code> differs from how the passwd program works
however in that it is not <span class="emphasis"><em>setuid root</em></span> but works in
a client-server mode and communicates with a
- locally running <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>. As a consequence in order for this to
+ locally running <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>. As a consequence in order for this to
succeed the smbd daemon must be running on the local machine. On a
UNIX machine the encrypted SMB passwords are usually stored in
- the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file. </p><p>When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file. </p><p>When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd
will prompt them for their old SMB password and then ask them
for their new password twice, to ensure that the new password
was typed correctly. No passwords will be echoed on the screen
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@
the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root, <code class="literal">
smbpasswd</code> accesses the local smbpasswd file
directly, thus enabling changes to be made even if smbd is not
- running. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266836"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>
+ running. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507396"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>
This option specifies that the username following should be added to the local smbpasswd file, with the new
password typed (type &lt;Enter&gt; for the old password). This option is ignored if the username following
already exists in the smbpasswd file and it is treated like a regular change password command. Note that the
@@ -46,7 +46,7 @@
is done all attempts to authenticate via SMB using this username
will fail. </p><p>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format (pre-Samba 2.0
format) there is no space in the user's password entry to write
- this information and the command will FAIL. See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.
+ this information and the command will FAIL. See <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.
</p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-e</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username following
should be <code class="constant">enabled</code> in the local smbpasswd file,
@@ -54,7 +54,7 @@
disabled this option has no effect. Once the account is enabled then
the user will be able to authenticate via SMB once again. </p><p>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format, then <code class="literal">
smbpasswd</code> will FAIL to enable the account.
- See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for
+ See <a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> for
details on the 'old' and new password file formats. </p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>debuglevel</code></em> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is not specified
@@ -94,7 +94,7 @@
name of the host being connected to. </p><p>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
cause names to be resolved as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="constant">lmhosts</code>: Lookup an IP
address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
- no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
+ no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a class="citerefentry" href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then
any name type matches for lookup.</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">host</code>: Do a standard host
name to IP address resolution, using the system <code class="filename">/etc/hosts
</code>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
@@ -110,7 +110,7 @@
<em class="parameter"><code>interfaces</code></em> parameter. This is the least
reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the
target host being on a locally connected subnet.</p></li></ul></div><p>The default order is <code class="literal">lmhosts, host, wins, bcast</code>
- and without this parameter or any entry in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution methods will
+ and without this parameter or any entry in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file the name resolution methods will
be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>This option tells smbpasswd that the account
being changed is a MACHINE account. Currently this is used
when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.</p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
@@ -128,7 +128,7 @@
is to aid people writing scripts to drive smbpasswd</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-w password</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is only available if Samba
has been compiled with LDAP support. The <em class="parameter"><code>-w</code></em>
switch is used to specify the password to be used with the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308169"></a>ldap admin dn. Note that the password is stored in
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a>. Note that the password is stored in
the <code class="filename">secrets.tdb</code> and is keyed off
of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <em class="parameter"><code>ldap
admin dn</code></em> ever changes, the password will need to be
@@ -138,7 +138,7 @@
</p><p>This parameter is only available if Samba
has been compiled with LDAP support. The <em class="parameter"><code>-W</code></em>
switch is used to specify the password to be used with the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308217"></a>ldap admin dn. Note that the password is stored in
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</a>. Note that the password is stored in
the <code class="filename">secrets.tdb</code> and is keyed off
of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <em class="parameter"><code>ldap
admin dn</code></em> ever changes, the password will need to be
@@ -151,20 +151,20 @@
<span class="emphasis"><em>root only</em></span> options to operate on. Only root
can specify this parameter as only root has the permission needed
to modify attributes directly in the local smbpasswd file.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308287"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Since <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> works in client-server
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553574"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>Since <code class="literal">smbpasswd</code> works in client-server
mode communicating with a local smbd for a non-root user then
the smbd daemon must be running for this to work. A common problem
is to add a restriction to the hosts that may access the <code class="literal">
smbd</code> running on the local machine by specifying either <em class="parameter"><code>allow
hosts</code></em> or <em class="parameter"><code>deny hosts</code></em> entry in
- the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and neglecting to
+ the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and neglecting to
allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </p><p>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba
- has been set up to use encrypted passwords. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308336"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308346"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308371"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ has been set up to use encrypted passwords. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553626"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553637"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553662"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbsh.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbsh.1.html
index 461a87d909..99c4ec3997 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbsh.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbsh.1.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbsh</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbsh.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbsh &#8212; Allows access to remote SMB shares
- using UNIX commands</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> [-W workgroup] [-U username] [-P prefix] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l logdir] [-L libdir]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267042"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> allows you to access an NT filesystem
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbsh</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbsh.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbsh &#8212; Allows access to remote SMB shares
+ using UNIX commands</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> [-W workgroup] [-U username] [-P prefix] [-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-l logdir] [-L libdir]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507193"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> allows you to access an NT filesystem
using UNIX commands such as <code class="literal">ls</code>, <code class="literal">
egrep</code>, and <code class="literal">rcp</code>. You must use a
shell that is dynamically linked in order for <code class="literal">smbsh</code>
- to work correctly.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267092"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-W WORKGROUP</span></dt><dd><p>Override the default workgroup specified in the
- workgroup parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file
+ to work correctly.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507246"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-W WORKGROUP</span></dt><dd><p>Override the default workgroup specified in the
+ workgroup parameter of the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file
for this session. This may be needed to connect to some
servers. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username[%pass]</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the SMB username or username and password.
If this option is not specified, the user will be prompted for
@@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266730"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to determine what naming
services and in what order to resolve
host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated
@@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ They cause names to be resolved as follows :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul ty
Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the
line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the
NetBIOS name
-(see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details)
+(see the <a class="citerefentry" href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details)
then any name type matches for lookup.
</p></li><li><p><code class="constant">host</code>:
Do a standard host name to IP address resolution, using
@@ -66,13 +66,13 @@ resolution methods as it depends on the target host
being on a locally connected subnet.
</p></li></ul></div><p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
defined in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file parameter
-(<a class="indexterm" name="id266838"></a>) will be used.
+(<a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order</a>) will be used.
</p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without
-this parameter or any entry in the <a class="indexterm" name="id266848"></a> parameter of the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file, the name
+this parameter or any entry in the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order</a> parameter of the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file, the name
resolution methods will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L libdir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the location of the
shared libraries used by <code class="literal">smbsh</code>. The default
value is specified at compile time.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266882"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>To use the <code class="literal">smbsh</code> command, execute <code class="literal">
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506371"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>To use the <code class="literal">smbsh</code> command, execute <code class="literal">
smbsh</code> from the prompt and enter the username and password
that authenticates you to the machine running the Windows NT
operating system.
@@ -89,19 +89,19 @@ resolution methods will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="te
<code class="literal">ls /smb/MYGROUP/&lt;machine-name&gt;</code> will show the share
names for that machine. You could then, for example, use the <code class="literal">
cd</code> command to change directories, <code class="literal">vi</code> to
- edit files, and <code class="literal">rcp</code> to copy files.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307941"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307951"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> works by intercepting the standard
+ edit files, and <code class="literal">rcp</code> to copy files.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506482"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506493"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p><code class="literal">smbsh</code> works by intercepting the standard
libc calls with the dynamically loaded versions in <code class="filename">
smbwrapper.o</code>. Not all calls have been "wrapped", so
some programs may not function correctly under <code class="literal">smbsh
</code>.</p><p>Programs which are not dynamically linked cannot make
use of <code class="literal">smbsh</code>'s functionality. Most versions
of UNIX have a <code class="literal">file</code> command that will
- describe how a program was linked.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307996"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308019"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ describe how a program was linked.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506539"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506562"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbspool.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbspool.8.html
index f3cd58c85f..b95dc7a249 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbspool.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbspool.8.html
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbspool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbspool.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbspool &#8212; send a print file to an SMB printer</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> {job} {user} {title} {copies} {options} [filename]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299208"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbspool is a very small print spooling program that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbspool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbspool.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbspool &#8212; send a print file to an SMB printer</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> {job} {user} {title} {copies} {options} [filename]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507184"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>smbspool is a very small print spooling program that
sends a print file to an SMB printer. The command-line arguments
are position-dependent for compatibility with the Common UNIX
Printing System, but you can use smbspool with any printing system
@@ -10,7 +10,7 @@
or argv[1] if that is not the case.</p><p>Programs using the <code class="literal">exec(2)</code> functions can
pass the URI in argv[0], while shell scripts must set the
<code class="envar">DEVICE_URI</code> environment variable prior to
- running smbspool.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266725"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The job argument (argv[1]) contains the
+ running smbspool.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507274"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The job argument (argv[1]) contains the
job ID number and is presently not used by smbspool.
</p></li><li><p>The user argument (argv[2]) contains the
print user's name and is presently not used by smbspool.
@@ -23,13 +23,13 @@
the print options in a single string and is currently
not used by smbspool.</p></li><li><p>The filename argument (argv[6]) contains the
name of the file to print. If this argument is not specified
- then the print file is read from the standard input.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266769"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266779"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266804"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> was written by Michael Sweet
+ then the print file is read from the standard input.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507325"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507336"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507360"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p><code class="literal">smbspool</code> was written by Michael Sweet
at Easy Software Products.</p><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbstatus.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbstatus.1.html
index abef01c4f9..714a31f3e6 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbstatus.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbstatus.1.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbstatus</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbstatus.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbstatus &#8212; report on current Samba connections</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbstatus</code> [-P] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-v] [-L] [-B] [-p] [-S] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;] [-u &lt;username&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299237"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbstatus</code> is a very simple program to
- list the current Samba connections.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299264"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-P|--profile</span></dt><dd><p>If samba has been compiled with the
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbstatus</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbstatus.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbstatus &#8212; report on current Samba connections</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbstatus</code> [-P] [-b] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-v] [-L] [-B] [-p] [-S] [-s &lt;configuration file&gt;] [-u &lt;username&gt;]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507214"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbstatus</code> is a very simple program to
+ list the current Samba connections.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507242"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-P|--profile</span></dt><dd><p>If samba has been compiled with the
profiling option, print only the contents of the profiling
shared memory area.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b|--brief</span></dt><dd><p>gives brief output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debuglevel=level</span></dt><dd><p><em class="replaceable"><code>level</code></em> is an integer
from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is
@@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266758"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -26,15 +26,15 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</spa
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v|--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>gives verbose output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L|--locks</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to only list locks.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B|--byterange</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to include byte range locks.
- </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p|--processes</span></dt><dd><p>print a list of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes and exit.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p|--processes</span></dt><dd><p>print a list of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes and exit.
Useful for scripting.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S|--shares</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to only list shares.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u|--user=&lt;username&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>selects information relevant to <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> only.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266940"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266951"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266976"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u|--user=&lt;username&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>selects information relevant to <em class="parameter"><code>username</code></em> only.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506302"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506313"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506338"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtar.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtar.1.html
index 1049c82908..2ab1df276a 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtar.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtar.1.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtar</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtar.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtar &#8212; shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
- directly to UNIX tape drives</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbtar</code> [-r] [-i] [-a] [-v] {-s server} [-p password] [-x services] [-X] [-N filename] [-b blocksize] [-d directory] [-l loglevel] [-u user] [-t tape] {filenames}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299276"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbtar</code> is a very small shell script on top
- of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266744"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s server</span></dt><dd><p>The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtar</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtar.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtar &#8212; shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
+ directly to UNIX tape drives</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbtar</code> [-r] [-i] [-a] [-v] {-s server} [-p password] [-x services] [-X] [-N filename] [-b blocksize] [-d directory] [-l loglevel] [-u user] [-t tape] {filenames}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507253"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbtar</code> is a very small shell script on top
+ of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507287"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s server</span></dt><dd><p>The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides
upon.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x service</span></dt><dd><p>The share name on the server to connect to.
The default is "backup".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-X</span></dt><dd><p>Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar
create or restore. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d directory</span></dt><dd><p>Change to initial <em class="parameter"><code>directory
@@ -17,22 +17,22 @@
up if they have the archive bit set. The archive bit is reset
after each file is read. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r</span></dt><dd><p>Restore. Files are restored to the share
from the tar file. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l log level</span></dt><dd><p>Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
- <em class="parameter"><code>-d</code></em> flag of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266975"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>$TAPE</code></em> variable specifies the
+ <em class="parameter"><code>-d</code></em> flag of <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507505"></a><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>$TAPE</code></em> variable specifies the
default tape device to write to. May be overridden
- with the -t option. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266992"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbtar</code> script has different
- options from ordinary tar and from smbclient's tar command. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267008"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>Sites that are more careful about security may not like
+ with the -t option. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506240"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>The <code class="literal">smbtar</code> script has different
+ options from ordinary tar and from smbclient's tar command. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506258"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>Sites that are more careful about security may not like
the way the script handles PC passwords. Backup and restore work
on entire shares; should work on file lists. smbtar works best
- with GNU tar and may not work well with other versions. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267020"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>See the <span class="emphasis"><em>DIAGNOSTICS</em></span> section for the <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> command.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307900"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307910"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307943"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ with GNU tar and may not work well with other versions. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506272"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>See the <span class="emphasis"><em>DIAGNOSTICS</em></span> section for the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> command.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506295"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506306"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506339"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
- to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><a href="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk" target="_top">Ricky Poulten</a>
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><a class="ulink" href="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk" target="_top">Ricky Poulten</a>
wrote the tar extension and this man page. The <code class="literal">smbtar</code>
- script was heavily rewritten and improved by <a href="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de" target="_top">Martin Kraemer</a>. Many
+ script was heavily rewritten and improved by <a class="ulink" href="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de" target="_top">Martin Kraemer</a>. Many
thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug
fixes, etc. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtree.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtree.1.html
index c221a1b77b..b03c5d4762 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtree.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbtree.1.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtree</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtree.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtree &#8212; A text based smb network browser
- </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbtree</code> [-b] [-D] [-S]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267694"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbtree</code> is a smb browser program
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtree</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtree.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtree &#8212; A text based smb network browser
+ </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbtree</code> [-b] [-D] [-S]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544141"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">smbtree</code> is a smb browser program
in text mode. It is similar to the "Network Neighborhood" found
on Windows computers. It prints a tree with all
the known domains, the servers in those domains and
the shares on the servers.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299211"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-b</span></dt><dd><p>Query network nodes by sending requests
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507189"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-b</span></dt><dd><p>Query network nodes by sending requests
as broadcasts instead of querying the local master browser.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D</span></dt><dd><p>Only print a list of all
the domains known on broadcast or by the
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266718"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -67,8 +67,8 @@ many systems the command line of a running process may be seen
via the <code class="literal">ps</code> command. To be safe always allow
<code class="literal">rpcclient</code> to prompt for a password and type
it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266925"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266935"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506303"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506314"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The smbtree man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij. </p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbumount.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbumount.8.html
deleted file mode 100644
index 85b58cf5c2..0000000000
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/smbumount.8.html
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,17 +0,0 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbumount</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbumount.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbumount &#8212; smbfs umount for normal users</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">smbumount</code> {mount-point}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267679"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>With this program, normal users can unmount smb-filesystems,
- provided that it is suid root. <code class="literal">smbumount</code> has
- been written to give normal Linux users more control over their
- resources. It is safe to install this program suid root, because only
- the user who has mounted a filesystem is allowed to unmount it again.
- For root it is not necessary to use smbumount. The normal umount
- program works perfectly well.</p><p>WARNING: <code class="literal">smbumount</code> is deprecated and not
- maintained any longer. <code class="literal">umount.cifs</code>
- should be used instead of <code class="literal">smbumount</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299210"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">mount-point</span></dt><dd><p>The directory to unmount.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299231"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299246"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Volker Lendecke, Andrew Tridgell, Michael H. Warfield
- and others.</p><p>The current maintainer of smbfs and the userspace
- tools <code class="literal">smbmount</code>, <code class="literal">smbumount</code>,
- and <code class="literal">smbmnt</code> is <a href="mailto:urban@teststation.com" target="_top">Urban Widmark</a>.
- The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a>
- is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
- </p><p>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed
- by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
- was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/swat.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/swat.8.html
index 267e25db78..7323edaf2e 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/swat.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/swat.8.html
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>swat</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="swat.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>swat &#8212; Samba Web Administration Tool</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">swat</code> [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-a] [-P]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267689"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">swat</code> allows a Samba administrator to
- configure the complex <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file via a Web browser. In addition,
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>swat</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="swat.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>swat &#8212; Samba Web Administration Tool</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">swat</code> [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-a] [-P]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544142"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">swat</code> allows a Samba administrator to
+ configure the complex <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file via a Web browser. In addition,
a <code class="literal">swat</code> configuration page has help links
to all the configurable options in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file allowing an
- administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </p><p><code class="literal">swat</code> is run from <code class="literal">inetd</code> </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267070"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s smb configuration file</span></dt><dd><p>The default configuration file path is
+ administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </p><p><code class="literal">swat</code> is run from <code class="literal">inetd</code> </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507224"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s smb configuration file</span></dt><dd><p>The default configuration file path is
determined at compile time. The file specified contains
- the configuration details required by the <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> server. This is the file
+ the configuration details required by the <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> server. This is the file
that <code class="literal">swat</code> will modify.
The information in this file includes server-specific
information such as what printcap file to use, as well as
@@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266720"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -41,14 +41,14 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</spa
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266795"></a><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>Swat is included as binary package with most distributions. The
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506260"></a><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>Swat is included as binary package with most distributions. The
package manager in this case takes care of the installation and
configuration. This section is only for those who have compiled
swat from scratch.
</p><p>After you compile SWAT you need to run <code class="literal">make install
</code> to install the <code class="literal">swat</code> binary
and the various help files and images. A default install would put
- these in: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>/usr/local/samba/sbin/swat</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id266840"></a><h3>Inetd Installation</h3><p>You need to edit your <code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf
+ these in: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>/usr/local/samba/sbin/swat</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*</p></li><li><p>/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><a name="id2506308"></a><h3>Inetd Installation</h3><p>You need to edit your <code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf
</code> and <code class="filename">/etc/services</code>
to enable SWAT to be launched via <code class="literal">inetd</code>.</p><p>In <code class="filename">/etc/services</code> you need to
add a line like this: </p><p><code class="literal">swat 901/tcp</code></p><p>Note for NIS/YP and LDAP users - you may need to rebuild the
@@ -62,26 +62,26 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
/usr/local/samba/sbin/swat swat</code></p><p>Once you have edited <code class="filename">/etc/services</code>
and <code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code> you need to send a
HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <code class="literal">kill -1 PID
- </code> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307898"></a><h2>LAUNCHING</h2><p>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
+ </code> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506421"></a><h2>LAUNCHING</h2><p>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
point it at "http://localhost:901/".</p><p>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected
machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your
connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent
- in the clear over the wire. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307914"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain suitable startup
+ in the clear over the wire. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506439"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain suitable startup
information for the meta-daemon.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/services</code></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain a mapping of service name
(e.g., swat) to service port (e.g., 901) and protocol type
- (e.g., tcp). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file that swat edits. Other
+ (e.g., tcp). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file that swat edits. Other
common places that systems install this file are <code class="filename">
/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</code> and <code class="filename">/etc/smb.conf
</code>. This file describes all the services the server
- is to make available to clients. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307992"></a><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p><code class="literal">swat</code> will rewrite your <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all
+ is to make available to clients. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506521"></a><h2>WARNINGS</h2><p><code class="literal">swat</code> will rewrite your <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all
comments, <em class="parameter"><code>include=</code></em> and <em class="parameter"><code>copy=
</code></em> options. If you have a carefully crafted <code class="filename">
- smb.conf</code> then back it up or don't use swat! </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308034"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308045"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><code class="literal">inetd(5)</code>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308075"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ smb.conf</code> then back it up or don't use swat! </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506565"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506576"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><code class="literal">inetd(5)</code>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506606"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbbackup.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbbackup.8.html
index 6364bdf997..b77fc74348 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbbackup.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbbackup.8.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbbackup</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbbackup.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbbackup &#8212; tool for backing up and for validating the integrity of samba .tdb files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbbackup</code> [-s suffix] [-v] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267694"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbbackup</code> is a tool that may be used to backup samba .tdb
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbbackup</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbbackup.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbbackup &#8212; tool for backing up and for validating the integrity of samba .tdb files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbbackup</code> [-s suffix] [-v] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544143"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbbackup</code> is a tool that may be used to backup samba .tdb
files. This tool may also be used to verify the integrity of the .tdb files prior
to samba startup or during normal operation. If it finds file damage and it finds
a prior backup the backup file will be restored.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299213"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507192"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>
Get help information.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s suffix</span></dt><dd><p>
The <code class="literal">-s</code> option allows the adminisistrator to specify a file
@@ -11,7 +11,7 @@
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>
The <code class="literal">-v</code> will check the database for damages (currupt data)
which if detected causes the backup to be restored.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299270"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>GENERAL INFORMATION</em></span></p><p>
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507252"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>GENERAL INFORMATION</em></span></p><p>
The <code class="literal">tdbbackup</code> utility can safely be run at any time. It was designed so
that it can be used at any time to validate the integrity of tdb files, even during Samba
operation. Typical usage for the command will be:
@@ -29,7 +29,7 @@
</p></li><li><p>
<code class="literal">*.tdb</code> located in the /usr/local/samba/var directory or on some
systems in the /var/cache or /var/lib/samba directories.
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266779"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266788"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507332"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507343"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
the Linux kernel is developed.
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbdump.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbdump.8.html
index 9fd92dd9a1..b971fc4a4b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbdump.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbdump.8.html
@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbdump</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbdump.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbdump &#8212; tool for printing the contents of a TDB file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbdump</code> {filename}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267679"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbdump</code> is a very simple utility that 'dumps' the
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbdump</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbdump.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbdump &#8212; tool for printing the contents of a TDB file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbdump</code> {filename}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544128"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbdump</code> is a very simple utility that 'dumps' the
contents of a TDB (Trivial DataBase) file to standard output in a
human-readable format.
</p><p>This tool can be used when debugging problems with TDB files. It is
intended for those who are somewhat familiar with Samba internals.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299201"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299212"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544162"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507191"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
the Linux kernel is developed.
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbtool.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbtool.8.html
index 69f38adf91..12558728b2 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbtool.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/tdbtool.8.html
@@ -1,12 +1,12 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbtool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbtool.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbtool &#8212; manipulate the contents TDB files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code></p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>tdbtool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="tdbtool.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>tdbtool &#8212; manipulate the contents TDB files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code></p></div><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code>
<em class="replaceable"><code>TDBFILE</code></em>
[
<em class="replaceable"><code>COMMANDS</code></em>
- ...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267705"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the
- <a href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code> a tool for displaying and
+ ...]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544152"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(1)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">tdbtool</code> a tool for displaying and
altering the contents of Samba TDB (Trivial DataBase) files. Each
of the commands listed below can be entered interactively or
- provided on the command line.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299222"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">create</code>
+ provided on the command line.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507200"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">create</code>
<em class="replaceable"><code>TDBFILE</code></em></span></dt><dd><p>Create a new database named
<em class="replaceable"><code>TDBFILE</code></em>.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><code class="option">open</code>
@@ -56,10 +56,10 @@
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">
<code class="option">quit</code>
</span></dt><dd><p>Exit <code class="literal">tdbtool</code>.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266994"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>The contents of the Samba TDB files are private
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506236"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>The contents of the Samba TDB files are private
to the implementation and should not be altered with
<code class="literal">tdbtool</code>.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267010"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267021"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> The original Samba software and related utilities were
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506253"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506264"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p> The original Samba software and related utilities were
created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the
Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/testparm.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/testparm.1.html
index ff42f34ffe..9f991982bc 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/testparm.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/testparm.1.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>testparm</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="testparm.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>testparm &#8212; check an smb.conf configuration file for
- internal correctness</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">testparm</code> [-s] [-h] [-v] [-L &lt;servername&gt;] [-t &lt;encoding&gt;] {config filename} [hostname hostIP]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299215"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">testparm</code> is a very simple test program
- to check an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> configuration file for
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>testparm</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="testparm.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>testparm &#8212; check an smb.conf configuration file for
+ internal correctness</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">testparm</code> [-s] [-h] [-v] [-L &lt;servername&gt;] [-t &lt;encoding&gt;] {config filename} [hostname hostIP]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507192"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">testparm</code> is a very simple test program
+ to check an <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> configuration file for
internal correctness. If this program reports no problems, you
can use the configuration file with confidence that <code class="literal">smbd
</code> will successfully load the configuration file.</p><p>Note that this is <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> a guarantee that
@@ -11,14 +11,14 @@
has access to each service. </p><p>If <code class="literal">testparm</code> finds an error in the <code class="filename">
smb.conf</code> file it returns an exit code of 1 to the calling
program, else it returns an exit code of 0. This allows shell scripts
- to test the output from <code class="literal">testparm</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266726"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s</span></dt><dd><p>Without this option, <code class="literal">testparm</code>
+ to test the output from <code class="literal">testparm</code>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507275"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s</span></dt><dd><p>Without this option, <code class="literal">testparm</code>
will prompt for a carriage return after printing the service
names and before dumping the service definitions.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L servername</span></dt><dd><p>Sets the value of the %L macro to <em class="replaceable"><code>servername</code></em>.
This is useful for testing include files specified with the
%L macro. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>If this option is specified, testparm
- will also output all options that were not used in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> and are thus set to their defaults.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t encoding</span></dt><dd><p>
+ will also output all options that were not used in <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> and are thus set to their defaults.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t encoding</span></dt><dd><p>
Output data in specified encoding.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--parameter-name parametername</span></dt><dd><p>
Dumps the named parameter. If no section-name is set the view
@@ -31,29 +31,29 @@
Dumps the named section.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">configfilename</span></dt><dd><p>This is the name of the configuration file
to check. If this parameter is not present then the
- default <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file will be checked.
+ default <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file will be checked.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">hostname</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter and the following are
specified, then <code class="literal">testparm</code> will examine the <em class="parameter"><code>hosts
allow</code></em> and <em class="parameter"><code>hosts deny</code></em>
- parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file to
+ parameters in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file to
determine if the hostname with this IP address would be
allowed access to the <code class="literal">smbd</code> server. If
this parameter is supplied, the hostIP parameter must also
be supplied.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">hostIP</span></dt><dd><p>This is the IP address of the host specified
in the previous parameter. This address must be supplied
- if the hostname parameter is supplied. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266947"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>This is usually the name of the configuration
- file used by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266982"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>The program will issue a message saying whether the
+ if the hostname parameter is supplied. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507485"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p>This is usually the name of the configuration
+ file used by <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506238"></a><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>The program will issue a message saying whether the
configuration file loaded OK or not. This message may be preceded by
errors and warnings if the file did not load. If the file was
loaded OK, the program then dumps all known service details
- to stdout. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266994"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267005"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307889"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ to stdout. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506253"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506264"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506289"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
- excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <a class="ulink" href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/" target="_top">
ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</a>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/umount.cifs.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/umount.cifs.8.html
index fc61900300..2fdd2c5cc8 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/umount.cifs.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/umount.cifs.8.html
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>umount.cifs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="umount.cifs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>umount.cifs &#8212; for normal, non-root users, to unmount their own Common Internet File System (CIFS) mounts</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">umount.cifs</code> {mount-point} [-nVvhfle]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267688"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>umount.cifs unmounts a Linux CIFS filesystem. It can be invoked
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>umount.cifs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="umount.cifs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>umount.cifs &#8212; for normal, non-root users, to unmount their own Common Internet File System (CIFS) mounts</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">umount.cifs</code> {mount-point} [-nVvhfle]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544142"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>umount.cifs unmounts a Linux CIFS filesystem. It can be invoked
indirectly by the
-<a href="umount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">umount</span>(8)</span></a> command
+<a class="citerefentry" href="umount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">umount</span>(8)</span></a> command
when umount.cifs is in /sbin directory, unless you specify the "-i" option to umount. Specifying -i to umount avoids execution of umount helpers such as umount.cifs. The umount.cifs command only works in Linux, and the kernel must
support the cifs filesystem. The CIFS protocol is the successor to the
SMB protocol and is supported by most Windows servers and many other
@@ -11,25 +11,25 @@ by the popular Open Source server Samba.
It is possible to set the mode for umount.cifs to
setuid root (or equivalently update the /etc/permissions file) to allow non-root users to umount shares to directories for which they have write permission. The umount.cifs utility is typically
not needed if unmounts need only be performed by root users, or if user mounts and unmounts
-can rely on specifying explicit entries in /etc/fstab See</p><p><a href="fstab.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">fstab</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299229"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>print additional debugging information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--no-mtab</span></dt><dd><p>Do not update the mtab even if unmount completes successfully (/proc/mounts will still display the correct information)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299262"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command is normally intended to be installed setuid (since root users can already run unmount). An alternative to using umount.cifs is to add specfic entries for the user mounts that you wish a particular user or users to mount and unmount to /etc/fstab</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299275"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
+can rely on specifying explicit entries in /etc/fstab See</p><p><a class="citerefentry" href="fstab.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">fstab</span>(5)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507228"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>print additional debugging information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--no-mtab</span></dt><dd><p>Do not update the mtab even if unmount completes successfully (/proc/mounts will still display the correct information)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507262"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command is normally intended to be installed setuid (since root users can already run unmount). An alternative to using umount.cifs is to add specfic entries for the user mounts that you wish a particular user or users to mount and unmount to /etc/fstab</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507276"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>
The primary mechanism for making configuration changes and for reading
debug information for the cifs vfs is via the Linux /proc filesystem.
In the directory <code class="filename">/proc/fs/cifs</code> are various
configuration files and pseudo files which can display debug information.
For more information see the kernel file <code class="filename">fs/cifs/README</code>.
-</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266734"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>At this time umount.cifs does not lock the mount table using the same lock as the umount utility does, so do not attempt to do multiple unmounts from different processes (and in particular unmounts of a cifs mount and another type of filesystem mount at the same time).
+</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507302"></a><h2>BUGS</h2><p>At this time umount.cifs does not lock the mount table using the same lock as the umount utility does, so do not attempt to do multiple unmounts from different processes (and in particular unmounts of a cifs mount and another type of filesystem mount at the same time).
</p><p>If the same mount point is mounted multiple times by cifs, umount.cifs will remove all of the matching entries from the mount table (although umount.cifs will actually only unmount the last one), rather than only removing the last matching entry in /etc/mtab. The pseudofile /proc/mounts will display correct information though, and the lack of an entry in /etc/mtab does not prevent subsequent unmounts.</p><p>
Note that the typical response to a bug report is a suggestion
to try the latest version first. So please try doing that first,
and always include which versions you use of relevant software
when reporting bugs (minimum: umount.cifs (try umount.cifs -V), kernel (see /proc/version) and
server type you are trying to contact.
-</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266759"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 1.34 of
- the cifs vfs filesystem (roughly Linux kernel 2.6.12).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266770"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
+</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507336"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 1.34 of
+ the cifs vfs filesystem (roughly Linux kernel 2.6.12).</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507348"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p>
Documentation/filesystems/cifs.txt and fs/cifs/README in the linux kernel
source tree may contain additional options and information.
-</p><p><a href="mount.cifs.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount.cifs</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266790"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Steve French</p><p>The syntax was loosely based on the umount utility and the manpage was loosely based on that of mount.cifs.8. The man page was created by Steve French</p><p>The maintainer of the Linux cifs vfs and the userspace
- tool <span class="emphasis"><em>umount.cifs</em></span> is <a href="mailto:sfrench@samba.org" target="_top">Steve French</a>.
- The <a href="mailto:linux-cifs-client@lists.samba.org" target="_top">Linux CIFS Mailing list</a>
+</p><p><a class="citerefentry" href="mount.cifs.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount.cifs</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507369"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Steve French</p><p>The syntax was loosely based on the umount utility and the manpage was loosely based on that of mount.cifs.8. The man page was created by Steve French</p><p>The maintainer of the Linux cifs vfs and the userspace
+ tool <span class="emphasis"><em>umount.cifs</em></span> is <a class="ulink" href="mailto:sfrench@samba.org" target="_top">Steve French</a>.
+ The <a class="ulink" href="mailto:linux-cifs-client@lists.samba.org" target="_top">Linux CIFS Mailing list</a>
is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs.
</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_audit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_audit.8.html
index 3a7922853e..fdbc2087ea 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_audit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_audit.8.html
@@ -1,19 +1,19 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_audit &#8212; record selected Samba VFS operations in the system log</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_audit</code> VFS module records selected
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_audit &#8212; record selected Samba VFS operations in the system log</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544120"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_audit</code> VFS module records selected
client operations to the system log using
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>.</p><p>The following Samba VFS operations are recorded:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>connect</td></tr><tr><td>disconnect</td></tr><tr><td>opendir</td></tr><tr><td>mkdir</td></tr><tr><td>rmdir</td></tr><tr><td>open</td></tr><tr><td>close</td></tr><tr><td>rename</td></tr><tr><td>unlink</td></tr><tr><td>chmod</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod</td></tr><tr><td>chmod_acl</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod_acl</td></tr></table><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299254"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">audit:facility = FACILITY</span></dt><dd><p>Log messages to the named
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> facility.
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>.</p><p>The following Samba VFS operations are recorded:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>connect</td></tr><tr><td>disconnect</td></tr><tr><td>opendir</td></tr><tr><td>mkdir</td></tr><tr><td>rmdir</td></tr><tr><td>open</td></tr><tr><td>close</td></tr><tr><td>rename</td></tr><tr><td>unlink</td></tr><tr><td>chmod</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod</td></tr><tr><td>chmod_acl</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod_acl</td></tr></table><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507232"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">audit:facility = FACILITY</span></dt><dd><p>Log messages to the named
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> facility.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">audit:priority = PRIORITY</span></dt><dd><p>Log messages with the named
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> priority.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266742"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log operations on all shares using the LOCAL1 facility
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> priority.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507285"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log operations on all shares using the LOCAL1 facility
and NOTICE priority:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266761"></a>vfs objects = audit
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266768"></a>audit:facility = LOCAL1
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266776"></a>audit:priority = NOTICE
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266785"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266796"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = audit</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#AUDIT:FACILITY">audit:facility = LOCAL1</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#AUDIT:PRIORITY">audit:priority = NOTICE</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507447"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507458"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.html
index 73b4fb2f7a..113c42710f 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_cacheprime</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_cacheprime.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_cacheprime &#8212; prime the kernel file data cache</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = cacheprime</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_cacheprime</code> VFS module reads chunks
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_cacheprime</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_cacheprime.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_cacheprime &#8212; prime the kernel file data cache</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = cacheprime</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_cacheprime</code> VFS module reads chunks
of file data near the range requested by clients in order to
make sure the data is present in the kernel file data cache at
the time when it is actually requested by clients. </p><p>The size of the disk read operations performed
@@ -7,20 +7,20 @@
cacheprime:rsize option. All disk read operations are aligned
on boundaries that are a multiple of this size. Each range of
the file data is primed at most once during the time the client
- has the file open. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299206"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">cacheprime:rsize = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>The number of bytes with which to prime
- the kernel data cache.</p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299262"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>For a hypothetical disk array, it is necessary to ensure
+ has the file open. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507195"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">cacheprime:rsize = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>The number of bytes with which to prime
+ the kernel data cache.</p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507254"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>For a hypothetical disk array, it is necessary to ensure
that all read operations are of size 1 megabyte (1048576 bytes),
and aligned on 1 megabyte boundaries:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[hypothetical]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266718"></a>vfs objects = cacheprime
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266725"></a>cacheprime:rsize = 1M
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266734"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p><code class="literal">cacheprime</code> is not a a substitute for
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = cacheprime</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#CACHEPRIME:RSIZE">cacheprime:rsize = 1M</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507407"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p><code class="literal">cacheprime</code> is not a a substitute for
a general-purpose readahead mechanism. It is intended for use
only in very specific environments where disk operations must
be aligned and sized to known values (as much as that is possible).
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266751"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266761"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507425"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507436"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cap.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cap.8.html
index 4c6cf7c6c8..7e8ae0158e 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cap.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_cap.8.html
@@ -1,17 +1,17 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_cap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_cap.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_cap &#8212; CAP encode filenames</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = cap</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>CAP (Columbia Appletalk Protocol) encoding is a
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_cap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_cap.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_cap &#8212; CAP encode filenames</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = cap</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544119"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>CAP (Columbia Appletalk Protocol) encoding is a
technique for representing non-ASCII filenames in ASCII. The
<code class="literal">vfs_cap</code> VFS module translates filenames to and
from CAP format, allowing users to name files in their native
encoding. </p><p>CAP encoding is most commonly
- used in Japanese language environments. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299198"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>On a system using GNU libiconv, use CAP encoding to support
+ used in Japanese language environments. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544158"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>On a system using GNU libiconv, use CAP encoding to support
users in the Shift_JIS locale:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299217"></a>dos charset = CP932
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299224"></a>dos charset = CP932
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299232"></a>vfs objects = cap
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299241"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299251"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOSCHARSET">dos charset = CP932</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DOSCHARSET">dos charset = CP932</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = cap</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507336"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507347"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_catia.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_catia.8.html
index eb83c79511..84a53bb1d5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_catia.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_catia.8.html
@@ -1,14 +1,14 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_catia</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_catia.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_catia &#8212; translate illegal characters in Catia filenames</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = catia</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The Catia CAD package commonly creates filenames that
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_catia</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_catia.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_catia &#8212; translate illegal characters in Catia filenames</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = catia</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544120"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The Catia CAD package commonly creates filenames that
use characters that are illegal in CIFS filenames. The
<code class="literal">vfs_catia</code> VFS module implements a fixed character
mapping so that these files can be shared with CIFS clients.
- </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267704"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Map Catia filenames on the [CAD] share:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544154"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Map Catia filenames on the [CAD] share:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[CAD]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299213"></a>path = /data/cad
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299220"></a>vfs objects = catia
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299229"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299240"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /data/cad</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = catia</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507319"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507330"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_commit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_commit.8.html
index 203f420122..59fd831f13 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_commit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_commit.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_commit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_commit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_commit &#8212; flush dirty data at specified intervals</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = commit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_commit</code> VFS module keeps track of
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_commit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_commit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_commit &#8212; flush dirty data at specified intervals</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = commit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_commit</code> VFS module keeps track of
the amount of data written to a file and synchronizes it to
disk when a specified amount accumulates.
</p><p><code class="literal">vfs_commit</code> is useful in two
@@ -7,18 +7,18 @@
impact of unexpected power loss can be minimized by a small
commit:dthresh value. Secondly, write performance can be
improved on some systems by flushing file data early and at
- regular intervals.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299204"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">commit:dthresh = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>Synchronize file data each time the specified
+ regular intervals.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507194"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">commit:dthresh = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>Synchronize file data each time the specified
number of bytes has been written.
- </p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299260"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Synchronize the file data on the [precious] share after
+ </p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507251"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Synchronize the file data on the [precious] share after
every 512 kilobytes (524288 bytes) of data is written:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[precious]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266714"></a>path = /data/precious
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266722"></a>vfs objects = commit
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266729"></a>commit:dthresh = 512K
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266738"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>On some systems, the data synchronization performed by
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /data/precious</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = commit</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#COMMIT:DTHRESH">commit:dthresh = 512K</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507414"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>On some systems, the data synchronization performed by
<code class="literal">commit</code> may reduce performance.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266754"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266765"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507431"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507442"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.html
index d0560dbf37..e774ec3784 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_default_quota</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_default_quota.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_default_quota &#8212; store default quota records for Windows clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = default_quota</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_default_quota</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_default_quota.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_default_quota &#8212; store default quota records for Windows clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = default_quota</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>
suite.</p><p>Many common quota implementations only store
quotas for users and groups, but do not store a default quota. The
<code class="literal">vfs_default_quota</code> module allows Samba to store
@@ -9,7 +9,7 @@
refuses to update them. <code class="literal">vfs_default_quota</code> maps
the default quota to the quota record of a user. By default the
root user is taken because quota limits for root are typically
- not enforced.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299204"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">default_quota:uid = UID</span></dt><dd><p>UID specifies the user ID of the quota record where the
+ not enforced.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507196"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">default_quota:uid = UID</span></dt><dd><p>UID specifies the user ID of the quota record where the
default user quota values are stored.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">default_quota:gid = GID</span></dt><dd><p>GID specifies the group ID of the quota record where the
default group quota values are stored.
@@ -21,15 +21,15 @@
quota record is storing the default group quota will
be reported as having a quota of NO_LIMIT. Otherwise,
the stored values will be reported.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299271"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Store the default quota record in the quota record for
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507269"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Store the default quota record in the quota record for
the user with ID 65535 and report that user as having no quota
limits:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266726"></a>vfs objects = default_quota
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266733"></a>default_quota:uid = 65535
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266740"></a>default_quota:uid nolimit = yes
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266750"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266760"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = default_quota</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEFAULT_QUOTA:UID">default_quota:uid = 65535</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#DEFAULT_QUOTA:UIDNOLIMIT">default_quota:uid nolimit = yes</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507433"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507444"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.html
index 9cd78a2e32..5e7598ae95 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.html
@@ -1,14 +1,14 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_extd_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_extd_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_extd_audit &#8212; record selected Samba VFS operations</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = extd_audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">extd_audit</code> VFS module records selected
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_extd_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_extd_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_extd_audit &#8212; record selected Samba VFS operations</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = extd_audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">extd_audit</code> VFS module records selected
client operations to both the
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log and
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log and
system log (using
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>).</p><p>Other than logging to the
- <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log,
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>).</p><p>Other than logging to the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log,
<code class="literal">vfs_extd_audit</code> is identical to
- <a href="vfs_audit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfs_audit</span>(8)</span></a>.
- </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299233"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299243"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="vfs_audit.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfs_audit</span>(8)</span></a>.
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507219"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507230"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.html
index 86d1c74129..3b543052fe 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.html
@@ -1,17 +1,17 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_fake_perms</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_fake_perms.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_fake_perms &#8212; enable read only Roaming Profiles</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = fake_perms</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_fake_perms</code> VFS module was created
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_fake_perms</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_fake_perms.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_fake_perms &#8212; enable read only Roaming Profiles</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = fake_perms</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_fake_perms</code> VFS module was created
to allow Roaming Profile files and directories to be set (on
the Samba server under UNIX) as read only. This module will,
if installed on the Profiles share, report to the client that
the Profile files and directories are writeable. This satisfies
the client even though the files will never be overwritten as
the client logs out or shuts down.
- </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267706"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544162"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[Profiles]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299211"></a>path = /profiles
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299218"></a>vfs objects = fake_perms
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299228"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299238"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /profiles</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = fake_perms</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507329"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507340"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.html
index e49baf70ac..d8bf1f229e 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.html
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_full_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_full_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_full_audit &#8212; record Samba VFS operations in the system log</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = full_audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_full_audit</code> VFS module records selected
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_full_audit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_full_audit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_full_audit &#8212; record Samba VFS operations in the system log</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = full_audit</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_full_audit</code> VFS module records selected
client operations to the system log using
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>.</p><p><code class="literal">vfs_full_audit</code> is able to record the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a>.</p><p><code class="literal">vfs_full_audit</code> is able to record the
complete set of Samba VFS operations:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>aio_cancel</td></tr><tr><td>aio_error</td></tr><tr><td>aio_fsync</td></tr><tr><td>aio_read</td></tr><tr><td>aio_return</td></tr><tr><td>aio_suspend</td></tr><tr><td>aio_write</td></tr><tr><td>chdir</td></tr><tr><td>chflags</td></tr><tr><td>chmod</td></tr><tr><td>chmod_acl</td></tr><tr><td>chown</td></tr><tr><td>close</td></tr><tr><td>closedir</td></tr><tr><td>connect</td></tr><tr><td>disconnect</td></tr><tr><td>disk_free</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod</td></tr><tr><td>fchmod_acl</td></tr><tr><td>fchown</td></tr><tr><td>fget_nt_acl</td></tr><tr><td>fgetxattr</td></tr><tr><td>flistxattr</td></tr><tr><td>fremovexattr</td></tr><tr><td>fset_nt_acl</td></tr><tr><td>fsetxattr</td></tr><tr><td>fstat</td></tr><tr><td>fsync</td></tr><tr><td>ftruncate</td></tr><tr><td>get_nt_acl</td></tr><tr><td>get_quota</td></tr><tr><td>get_shadow_copy_data</td></tr><tr><td>getlock</td></tr><tr><td>getwd</td></tr><tr><td>getxattr</td></tr><tr><td>kernel_flock</td></tr><tr><td>lgetxattr</td></tr><tr><td>link</td></tr><tr><td>linux_setlease</td></tr><tr><td>listxattr</td></tr><tr><td>llistxattr</td></tr><tr><td>lock</td></tr><tr><td>lremovexattr</td></tr><tr><td>lseek</td></tr><tr><td>lsetxattr</td></tr><tr><td>lstat</td></tr><tr><td>mkdir</td></tr><tr><td>mknod</td></tr><tr><td>open</td></tr><tr><td>opendir</td></tr><tr><td>pread</td></tr><tr><td>pwrite</td></tr><tr><td>read</td></tr><tr><td>readdir</td></tr><tr><td>readlink</td></tr><tr><td>realpath</td></tr><tr><td>removexattr</td></tr><tr><td>rename</td></tr><tr><td>rewinddir</td></tr><tr><td>rmdir</td></tr><tr><td>seekdir</td></tr><tr><td>sendfile</td></tr><tr><td>set_nt_acl</td></tr><tr><td>set_quota</td></tr><tr><td>setxattr</td></tr><tr><td>stat</td></tr><tr><td>statvfs</td></tr><tr><td>symlink</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_add_perm</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_clear_perms</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_create_entry</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_delete_def_file</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_free_acl</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_free_qualifier</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_free_text</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_entry</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_fd</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_file</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_perm</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_permset</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_qualifier</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_get_tag_type</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_init</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_set_fd</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_set_file</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_set_permset</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_set_qualifier</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_set_tag_type</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_to_text</td></tr><tr><td>sys_acl_valid</td></tr><tr><td>telldir</td></tr><tr><td>unlink</td></tr><tr><td>utime</td></tr><tr><td>write</td></tr></table><p>In addition to these operations,
<code class="literal">vfs_full_audit</code> recognizes the special operation
names "all" and "none ", which refer to all
@@ -10,9 +10,9 @@
format consisting of fields separated by '|' characters. The
format is: </p><pre class="programlisting">
smbd_audit: PREFIX|OPERATION|RESULT|FILE
- </pre><p>The record fields are:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">PREFIX</code> - the result of the full_audit:prefix string after variable substitutions</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">OPERATION</code> - the name of the VFS operation</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">RESULT</code> - whether the operation succeeded or failed</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">FILE</code> - the name of the file or directory the operation was performed on</p></li></ul></div><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id307921"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">vfs_full_audit:prefix = STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Prepend audit messages with STRING. STRING is
+ </pre><p>The record fields are:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">PREFIX</code> - the result of the full_audit:prefix string after variable substitutions</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">OPERATION</code> - the name of the VFS operation</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">RESULT</code> - whether the operation succeeded or failed</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">FILE</code> - the name of the file or directory the operation was performed on</p></li></ul></div><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506323"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">vfs_full_audit:prefix = STRING</span></dt><dd><p>Prepend audit messages with STRING. STRING is
processed for standard substitution variables listed in
- <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>. The default
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>. The default
prefix is "%u|%I". </p></dd><dt><span class="term">vfs_full_audit:success = LIST</span></dt><dd><p>LIST is a list of VFS operations that should be
recorded if they succeed. Operations are specified using
the names listed above.
@@ -20,23 +20,23 @@
recorded if they failed. Operations are specified using
the names listed above.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">full_audit:facility = FACILITY</span></dt><dd><p>Log messages to the named
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> facility.
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> facility.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">full_audit:priority = PRIORITY</span></dt><dd><p>Log messages with the named
- <a href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> priority.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308026"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log file and directory open operations on the [records]
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="syslog.3.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">syslog</span>(3)</span></a> priority.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506432"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log file and directory open operations on the [records]
share using the LOCAL7 facility and ALERT priority, including
the username and IP address:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[records]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308046"></a>path = /data/records
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308053"></a>vfs objects = full_audit
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308060"></a>full_audit:prefix = %u|%I
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308068"></a>full_audit:success = open opendir
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308075"></a>full_audit:failure = all
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308082"></a>full_audit:facility = LOCAL7
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308089"></a>full_audit:priority = ALERT
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308098"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308109"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /data/records</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = full_audit</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FULL_AUDIT:PREFIX">full_audit:prefix = %u|%I</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FULL_AUDIT:SUCCESS">full_audit:success = open opendir</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FULL_AUDIT:FAILURE">full_audit:failure = all</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FULL_AUDIT:FACILITY">full_audit:facility = LOCAL7</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#FULL_AUDIT:PRIORITY">full_audit:priority = ALERT</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506647"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506658"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.html
index 27aba67d74..6df627dff5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_gpfs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_gpfs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_gpfs &#8212; gpfs specific samba extensions like acls and prealloc</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = gpfs</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">gpfs</code> VFS module is the home
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_gpfs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_gpfs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_gpfs &#8212; gpfs specific samba extensions like acls and prealloc</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = gpfs</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544120"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">gpfs</code> VFS module is the home
for all gpfs extensions that Samba requires for proper integration
with GPFS. It uses the GPL library interfaces provided by GPFS.
</p><p>Currently the gpfs vfs module provides extensions in following areas :
@@ -8,7 +8,7 @@
and hence allows permission stealing via chown. Samba might allow at a later
point in time, to restrict the chown via this module as such restrictions
are the responsibility of the underlying filesystem than of Samba.
- </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299224"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">nfs4:mode = [ simple | special ]</span></dt><dd><p>
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507207"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">nfs4:mode = [ simple | special ]</span></dt><dd><p>
Enable/Disable substitution of special IDs on GPFS. This parameter
should not affect the windows users in anyway. It only ensures that Samba
sets the special IDs - OWNER@ and GROUP@ ( mappings to simple uids )
@@ -19,17 +19,17 @@
</p><p>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different values :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">dontcare (default)</code> - copy the ACEs as they come</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">reject</code> - stop operation and exit with error on ACL set op</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ignore</code> - don't include the second matching ACE</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">merge</code> - bitwise OR the 2 ace.flag fields and 2 ace.mask fields of the 2 duplicate ACEs into 1 ACE</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">nfs4:chown = [yes|no]</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows enabling or disabling the chown supported
by the underlying filesystem. This parameter should be enabled with
care as it might leave your system insecure.</p><p>Some filesystems allow chown as a) giving b) stealing. It is the latter
- that is considered a risk.</p><p>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different values : </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">yes</code> - Enable chown if as supported by the under filesystem</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">no (default)</code> - Disable chown</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266814"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>A GPFS mount can be exported via Samba as follows :</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ that is considered a risk.</p><p>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different values : </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">yes</code> - Enable chown if as supported by the under filesystem</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">no (default)</code> - Disable chown</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507371"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>A GPFS mount can be exported via Samba as follows :</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[samba_gpfs_share]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266834"></a>vfs objects = gpfs
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266841"></a>path = /test/gpfs_mount
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266848"></a>nfs4: mode = special
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266877"></a>nfs4: acedup = merge
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266886"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>The gpfs gpl libraries are required by <code class="literal">gpfs</code> VFS
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = gpfs</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /test/gpfs_mount</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NFS4:MODE">nfs4: mode = special</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#NFS4:ACEDUP">nfs4: acedup = merge</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506262"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>The gpfs gpl libraries are required by <code class="literal">gpfs</code> VFS
module during both compilation and runtime.
Also this VFS module is tested to work on SLES 9/10 and RHEL 4.4
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266903"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266914"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506279"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506290"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The GPFS VFS module was created with contributions from
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.html
index 99bfec138c..f25209272c 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.html
@@ -1,15 +1,15 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_netatalk</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_netatalk.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_netatalk &#8212; hide .AppleDouble files from CIFS clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = netatalk</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_netatalk</code> VFS module dynamically
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_netatalk</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_netatalk.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_netatalk &#8212; hide .AppleDouble files from CIFS clients</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = netatalk</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_netatalk</code> VFS module dynamically
hides .AppleDouble files, preventing spurious errors on some
CIFS clients. .AppleDouble files may be created by historic
- implementations of AFP (Apple Filing Protocol) on servers. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267704"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Hide .AppleDouble files on the [data] share:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ implementations of AFP (Apple Filing Protocol) on servers. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544160"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Hide .AppleDouble files on the [data] share:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[data]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299213"></a>vfs objects = netatalk
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299222"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>This module is largely historic and unlikely to be of use
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = netatalk</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507318"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>This module is largely historic and unlikely to be of use
in modern networks since current Apple systems are able to mount CIFS
shares natively.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299233"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299244"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507330"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507341"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.html
index 67ee47ea70..cd5051af4a 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.html
@@ -1,12 +1,12 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_notify_fam</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_notify_fam.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_notify_fam &#8212; FAM support for file change notifications</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = notify_fam</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267671"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_notify_fam</code> module makes use of
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_notify_fam</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_notify_fam.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_notify_fam &#8212; FAM support for file change notifications</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = notify_fam</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_notify_fam</code> module makes use of
the system FAM (File Alteration Monitor) daemon to implement
file change notifications for Windows clients. FAM is generally
- present only on IRIX and some BSD systems.</p><p>This module is not stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267703"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Support FAM notifications globally:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ present only on IRIX and some BSD systems.</p><p>This module is not stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544159"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Support FAM notifications globally:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299212"></a>vfs objects = notify_fam
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299222"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299232"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = notify_fam</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507318"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507328"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.html
index fde6653a66..53cd95eabb 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.html
@@ -1,22 +1,22 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_prealloc</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_prealloc.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_prealloc &#8212; preallocate matching files to a predetermined size</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = prealloc</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_prealloc</code> VFS module preallocates
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_prealloc</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_prealloc.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_prealloc &#8212; preallocate matching files to a predetermined size</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = prealloc</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_prealloc</code> VFS module preallocates
files to a specified size each time a new file is created. This
is useful in environments where files are of a predetermined
size will be written to a disk subsystem where extending file
- allocations is expensive. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267704"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">prealloc:EXT = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>Preallocate all files with the extension EXT to
+ allocations is expensive. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544161"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">prealloc:EXT = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>Preallocate all files with the extension EXT to
the size specified by BYTES.
- </p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299251"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>A process writes TIFF files to a Samba share, and the
+ </p><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507241"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>A process writes TIFF files to a Samba share, and the
is known these files will almost always be around 4 megabytes
(4194304 bytes): </p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[frames]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299271"></a>path = /data/frames
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266713"></a>vfs objects = prealloc
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266721"></a>prealloc:tiff = 4M
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266730"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p><code class="literal">vfs_prealloc</code> is not supported on all
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /data/frames</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = prealloc</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PREALLOC:TIFF">prealloc:tiff = 4M</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507404"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p><code class="literal">vfs_prealloc</code> is not supported on all
platforms and filesystems. Currently only XFS filesystems on
Linux and IRIX are supported.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266745"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266755"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507421"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507432"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.html
index bb61e8ad07..10a9ef2e2a 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_readahead</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_readahead.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_readahead &#8212; pre-load the kernel buffer cache</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = readahead</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>This <code class="literal">vfs_readahead</code> VFS module detects
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_readahead</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_readahead.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_readahead &#8212; pre-load the kernel buffer cache</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = readahead</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544125"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>This <code class="literal">vfs_readahead</code> VFS module detects
read requests at multiples of a given offset (hex 0x80000 by
default) and then tells the kernel via either the readahead
system call (on Linux) or the posix_fadvise system call to
@@ -12,14 +12,14 @@
readahead:length option. By default this is set to the
same value as the readahead:offset option and if not
set explicitly will use the current value of
- readahead:offset.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299214"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div><dl><dt><span class="term">readahead:offset = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>The offset multiple that causes readahead to be
+ readahead:offset.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507206"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><p>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">K</code> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">M</code> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">G</code> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</p></li></ul></div><dl><dt><span class="term">readahead:offset = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>The offset multiple that causes readahead to be
requested of the kernel buffer cache.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">readahead:length = BYTES</span></dt><dd><p>The number of bytes requested to be
read into the kernel buffer cache on each
- readahead call.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266720"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
+ readahead call.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507280"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[hypothetical]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266736"></a>vfs objects = readahead
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266745"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266755"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = readahead</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507415"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507425"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.html
index 7f8ed6b3db..bc3c2f65b5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.html
@@ -1,24 +1,24 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_readonly</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_readonly.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_readonly &#8212; make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = readonly</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_readonly</code> VFS module marks a share
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_readonly</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_readonly.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_readonly &#8212; make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = readonly</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_readonly</code> VFS module marks a share
as read only for all clients connecting within the configured
time period. Clients connecting during this time will be denied
write access to all files in the share, irrespective of ther
- actual access privileges.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267704"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">readonly:period = BEGIN, END</span></dt><dd><p>Only mark the share as read only if the client
+ actual access privileges.</p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544161"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">readonly:period = BEGIN, END</span></dt><dd><p>Only mark the share as read only if the client
connection was made between the times marked by the
BEGIN and END date specifiers.
The syntax of these date specifiers is the
same as that accepted by the -d option of GNU
- <a href="date.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">date</span>(1)</span></a>.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299226"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Mark all shares read only:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="date.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">date</span>(1)</span></a>.
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507217"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Mark all shares read only:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299245"></a>vfs objects = readonly
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = readonly</a>
</pre><p>Mark the [backup] share as read only during business hours:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[backup]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299268"></a>path = /readonly
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299275"></a>vfs objects = readonly
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266717"></a>readonly:period = readonly:period = "today 9:00","today 17:00"
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266726"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266736"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path = /readonly</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = readonly</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY:PERIOD">readonly:period = readonly:period = "today 9:00","today 17:00"</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507405"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507416"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.html
index 4d3901b43a..1c295c449b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.html
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_recycle</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_recycle.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_recycle &#8212; Samba VFS recycle bin</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = recycle</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_recycle</code> intercepts file deletion
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_recycle</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_recycle.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_recycle &#8212; Samba VFS recycle bin</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = recycle</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544127"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_recycle</code> intercepts file deletion
requests and moves the affected files to a temporary repository
rather than deleting them immediately. This gives the same effect
as the Recycle Bin on Windows computers. </p><p>The Recycle Bin will not appear in Windows Explorer
@@ -10,7 +10,7 @@
of the created directory depends on recycle:repository. Users
can recover files from the recycle bin. If the recycle:keeptree
option has been specified, deleted files will be found in a path
- identical with that from which the file was deleted. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299202"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository = PATH</span></dt><dd><p>Path of the directory where deleted files should be moved.
+ identical with that from which the file was deleted. </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507195"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository = PATH</span></dt><dd><p>Path of the directory where deleted files should be moved.
</p><p>If this option is not set, the default path .recycle
is used. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:directory_mode = MODE</span></dt><dd><p>Set MODE to the octal mode the recycle repository
should be created with. The recycle repository will be
@@ -47,14 +47,14 @@
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions = LIST</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies a list of paths (wildcards such as *
and ? are supported) for which no versioning should
be used. Only useful when recycle:versions is enabled.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266831"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log operations on all shares using the LOCAL1 facility
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507407"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Log operations on all shares using the LOCAL1 facility
and NOTICE priority:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[global]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266850"></a>vfs objects = recycle
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266880"></a>recycle:facility = LOCAL1
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266887"></a>recycle:priority = NOTICE
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266896"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266907"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = recycle</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#RECYCLE:FACILITY">recycle:facility = LOCAL1</a>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#RECYCLE:PRIORITY">recycle:priority = NOTICE</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507466"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507477"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.html
index 463787db98..5b9bdf61c1 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.html
@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_shadow_copy</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_shadow_copy.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_shadow_copy &#8212; Make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = shadow_copy</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267672"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
- <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> VFS module functionality
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_shadow_copy</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_shadow_copy.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_shadow_copy &#8212; Make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = shadow_copy</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544127"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> VFS module functionality
that is similar to Microsoft Shadow Copy services. When setup properly,
this module allows Microsoft Shadow Copy clients to browse
"shadow copies" on Samba shares.
- </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267704"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p><code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> relies on a filesystem
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544161"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p><code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> relies on a filesystem
snapshot implementation. Many common filesystems have native
support for this.
</p><p>Filesystem snapshots must be mounted on
@@ -13,20 +13,20 @@
where:
</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">YYYY</code> is the 4 digit year</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">MM</code> is the 2 digit month</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">DD</code> is the 2 digit day</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">hh</code> is the 2 digit hour</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">mm</code> is the 2 digit minute</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ss</code> is the 2 digit second.</p></li></ul></div><p>
</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> snapshot naming convention can be produced with the following
- <a href="date.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">date</span>(1)</span></a> command:
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="date.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">date</span>(1)</span></a> command:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
TZ=GMT date +@GMT-%Y.%m.%d-%H.%M.%S
- </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266738"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Add shadow copy support to user home directories:</p><pre class="programlisting">
+ </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507300"></a><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Add shadow copy support to user home directories:</p><pre class="programlisting">
<em class="parameter"><code>[homes]</code></em>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266757"></a>vfs objects = shadow_copy
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266766"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>This is not a backup, archival, or version control solution.
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#VFSOBJECTS">vfs objects = shadow_copy</a>
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507436"></a><h2>CAVEATS</h2><p>This is not a backup, archival, or version control solution.
</p><p>With Samba or Windows servers,
<code class="literal">vfs_shadow_copy</code> is designed to be an end-user
tool only. It does not replace or enhance your backup and
archival solutions and should in no way be considered as
such. Additionally, if you need version control, implement a
- version control system.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266788"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266799"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ version control system.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507460"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507471"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.html
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..923f4973ae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.html
@@ -0,0 +1,12 @@
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfs_xattr_tdb</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfs_xattr_tdb.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfs_xattr_tdb &#8212; Save Extended Attributes (EAs) in a tdb file</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfs objects = xattr_tdb</code></p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544126"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This VFS module is part of the
+ <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">vfs_xattr_tdb</code> VFS module stores
+ Extended Attributes (EAs) in a tdb file.
+ This enables the usage of Extended Attributes on OS and
+ filesystems which do not support Extended Attributes
+ by themselves.
+ </p><p>This module is stackable.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544160"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">xattr_tdb:file = PATH</span></dt><dd><p>Name of the tdb file the EAs are stored in.
+ If this option is not set, the default filename
+ <code class="filename">xattr.tdb</code> is used.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507212"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfstest.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfstest.1.html
index bcd1b802e8..53ceaa80a7 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfstest.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/vfstest.1.html
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfstest</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfstest.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfstest &#8212; tool for testing samba VFS modules </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> [-d debuglevel] [-c command] [-l logdir] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id267702"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> is a small command line
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>vfstest</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="vfstest.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>vfstest &#8212; tool for testing samba VFS modules </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> [-d debuglevel] [-c command] [-l logdir] [-h]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2544149"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">vfstest</code> is a small command line
utility that has the ability to test dso samba VFS modules. It gives the
user the ability to call the various VFS functions manually and
supports cascaded VFS modules.
- </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299220"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-c|--command=command</span></dt><dd><p>Execute the specified (colon-separated) commands.
+ </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507197"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-c|--command=command</span></dt><dd><p>Execute the specified (colon-separated) commands.
See below for the commands that are available.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id266729"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -32,10 +32,10 @@ The default configuration file name is determined at
compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--log-basename=logdirectory</span></dt><dd><p>Base directory name for log/debug files. The extension
<code class="constant">".progname"</code> will be appended (e.g. log.smbclient,
log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266793"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>VFS COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">load &lt;module.so&gt;</code> - Load specified VFS module </p></li><li><p><code class="literal">populate &lt;char&gt; &lt;size&gt;</code> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507459"></a><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>VFS COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">load &lt;module.so&gt;</code> - Load specified VFS module </p></li><li><p><code class="literal">populate &lt;char&gt; &lt;size&gt;</code> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data
</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">showdata [&lt;offset&gt; &lt;len&gt;]</code> - Show data currently in data buffer
- </p></li><li><p><code class="literal">connect</code> - VFS connect()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">disconnect</code> - VFS disconnect()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">disk_free</code> - VFS disk_free()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">opendir</code> - VFS opendir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">readdir</code> - VFS readdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">mkdir</code> - VFS mkdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">rmdir</code> - VFS rmdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">closedir</code> - VFS closedir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">open</code> - VFS open()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">close</code> - VFS close()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">read</code> - VFS read()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">write</code> - VFS write()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lseek</code> - VFS lseek()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">rename</code> - VFS rename()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fsync</code> - VFS fsync()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">stat</code> - VFS stat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fstat</code> - VFS fstat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lstat</code> - VFS lstat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">unlink</code> - VFS unlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chmod</code> - VFS chmod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fchmod</code> - VFS fchmod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chown</code> - VFS chown()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fchown</code> - VFS fchown()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chdir</code> - VFS chdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">getwd</code> - VFS getwd()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">utime</code> - VFS utime()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ftruncate</code> - VFS ftruncate()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lock</code> - VFS lock()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">symlink</code> - VFS symlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">readlink</code> - VFS readlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">link</code> - VFS link()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">mknod</code> - VFS mknod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">realpath</code> - VFS realpath()</p></li></ul></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>GENERAL COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">conf &lt;smb.conf&gt;</code> - Load a different configuration file</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">help [&lt;command&gt;]</code> - Get list of commands or info about specified command</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">debuglevel &lt;level&gt;</code> - Set debug level</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">freemem</code> - Free memory currently in use</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">exit</code> - Exit vfstest</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308072"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba
- suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308083"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></li><li><p><code class="literal">connect</code> - VFS connect()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">disconnect</code> - VFS disconnect()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">disk_free</code> - VFS disk_free()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">opendir</code> - VFS opendir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">readdir</code> - VFS readdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">mkdir</code> - VFS mkdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">rmdir</code> - VFS rmdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">closedir</code> - VFS closedir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">open</code> - VFS open()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">close</code> - VFS close()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">read</code> - VFS read()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">write</code> - VFS write()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lseek</code> - VFS lseek()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">rename</code> - VFS rename()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fsync</code> - VFS fsync()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">stat</code> - VFS stat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fstat</code> - VFS fstat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lstat</code> - VFS lstat()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">unlink</code> - VFS unlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chmod</code> - VFS chmod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fchmod</code> - VFS fchmod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chown</code> - VFS chown()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">fchown</code> - VFS fchown()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">chdir</code> - VFS chdir()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">getwd</code> - VFS getwd()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">utime</code> - VFS utime()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">ftruncate</code> - VFS ftruncate()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">lock</code> - VFS lock()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">symlink</code> - VFS symlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">readlink</code> - VFS readlink()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">link</code> - VFS link()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">mknod</code> - VFS mknod()</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">realpath</code> - VFS realpath()</p></li></ul></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>GENERAL COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><code class="literal">conf &lt;smb.conf&gt;</code> - Load a different configuration file</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">help [&lt;command&gt;]</code> - Get list of commands or info about specified command</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">debuglevel &lt;level&gt;</code> - Set debug level</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">freemem</code> - Free memory currently in use</p></li><li><p><code class="literal">exit</code> - Exit vfstest</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506587"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506598"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The vfstest man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/wbinfo.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/wbinfo.1.html
index 41fba35576..d210835a0a 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/wbinfo.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/wbinfo.1.html
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>wbinfo</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="wbinfo.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>wbinfo &#8212; Query information from winbind daemon</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> [-a user%password] [--all-domains] [--allocate-gid] [--allocate-uid] [-D domain] [--domain domain] [-g] [--getdcname domain] [--get-auth-user] [-G gid] [-h] [-i user] [-I ip] [-K user%password] [-m] [-n name] [-N netbios-name] [--own-domain] [-p] [-r user] [-s sid] [--separator] [--sequence] [--set-auth-user user%password] [-S sid] [-t] [-u] [--uid-info uid] [--user-domgroups sid] [--user-sids sid] [-U uid] [-V] [-Y sid]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266849"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">wbinfo</code> program queries and returns information
- created and used by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon. </p><p>The <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be configured
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>wbinfo</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="wbinfo.1"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>wbinfo &#8212; Query information from winbind daemon</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> [-a user%password] [--all-domains] [--allocate-gid] [--allocate-uid] [-D domain] [--domain domain] [-g] [--getdcname domain] [--get-auth-user] [-G gid] [-h] [-i user] [-I ip] [-K user%password] [-m] [-n name] [-N netbios-name] [--own-domain] [-p] [-r user] [-s sid] [--separator] [--sequence] [--set-auth-user user%password] [-S sid] [-t] [-u] [--uid-info uid] [--user-domgroups sid] [--user-sids sid] [-U uid] [-V] [-Y sid] [--verbose]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507399"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <code class="literal">wbinfo</code> program queries and returns information
+ created and used by the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon. </p><p>The <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be configured
and running for the <code class="literal">wbinfo</code> program to be able
- to return information.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266924"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a|--authenticate username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd.
+ to return information.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507454"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a|--authenticate username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd.
This checks both authenticaion methods and reports its results.
</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Do not be tempted to use this
functionality for authentication in third-party
- applications. Instead use <a href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term">--allocate-gid</span></dt><dd><p>Get a new GID out of idmap
+ applications. Instead use <a class="citerefentry" href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a>.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term">--allocate-gid</span></dt><dd><p>Get a new GID out of idmap
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--allocate-uid</span></dt><dd><p>Get a new UID out of idmap
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--all-domains</span></dt><dd><p>List all domains (trusted and
own domain).
@@ -16,10 +16,10 @@
<code class="option">-u</code>, and <code class="option">-g</code> options honor this parameter.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D|--domain-info domain</span></dt><dd><p>Show most of the info we have about the domain.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g|--domain-groups</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all groups available
- in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains
will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
group ids to any groups that have not already been
- seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--get-auth-user</span></dt><dd><p>Print username and password used by winbindd
+ seen by <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--get-auth-user</span></dt><dd><p>Print username and password used by winbindd
during session setup to a domain controller. Username
and password can be set using <code class="option">--set-auth-user</code>.
Only available for root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--getdcname domain</span></dt><dd><p>Get the DC name for the specified domain.
@@ -27,23 +27,23 @@
NT SID. If the gid specified does not refer to one within
the idmap gid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i|--user-info user</span></dt><dd><p>Get user info.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I|--WINS-by-ip ip</span></dt><dd><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>-I</code></em> option
- queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to send a node status
+ queries <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to send a node status
request to get the NetBIOS name associated with the IP address
specified by the <em class="parameter"><code>ip</code></em> parameter.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-K|--krb5auth username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via Kerberos.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m|--trusted-domains</span></dt><dd><p>Produce a list of domains trusted by the
- Windows NT server <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts
+ Windows NT server <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts
when resolving names. This list does not include the Windows
NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n|--name-to-sid name</span></dt><dd><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>-n</code></em> option
- queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> for the SID
+ queries <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> for the SID
associated with the name specified. Domain names can be specified
before the user name by using the winbind separator character.
For example CWDOM1/Administrator refers to the Administrator
user in the domain CWDOM1. If no domain is specified then the
- domain used is the one specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> <em class="parameter"><code>workgroup
+ domain used is the one specified in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> <em class="parameter"><code>workgroup
</code></em> parameter. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N|--WINS-by-name name</span></dt><dd><p>The <em class="parameter"><code>-N</code></em> option
- queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to query the WINS
+ queries <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to query the WINS
server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name
specified by the <em class="parameter"><code>name</code></em> parameter.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--own-domain</span></dt><dd><p>List own domain.
@@ -64,25 +64,28 @@
Anonymous turned on (a.k.a. Permissions compatible with
Windows 2000 servers only).
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S|--sid-to-uid sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID
- does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t|--check-secret</span></dt><dd><p>Verify that the workstation trust account
+ does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t|--check-secret</span></dt><dd><p>Verify that the workstation trust account
created when the Samba server is added to the Windows NT
domain is working. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u|--domain-users</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all users available
- in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains
will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
- user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>
+ user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>
.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--uid-info UID</span></dt><dd><p>Get user info for the user conencted to
user id UID.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--user-domgroups SID</span></dt><dd><p>Get user domain groups.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">--user-sids SID</span></dt><dd><p>Get user group SIDs for user.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U|--uid-to-sid uid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT
SID. If the uid specified does not refer to one within
- the idmap uid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y|--sid-to-gid sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID
- does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then
+ the idmap uid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>
+ Print additional information about the query
+ results.
+ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y|--sid-to-gid sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID
+ does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then
the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options.
-</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308346"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation
- succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is not working <code class="literal">wbinfo</code> will always return
- failure. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308372"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308383"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308406"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506785"></a><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation
+ succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is not working <code class="literal">wbinfo</code> will always return
+ failure. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553516"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553527"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a class="citerefentry" href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a class="citerefentry" href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553550"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> and <code class="literal">winbindd</code>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/winbindd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/winbindd.8.html
index b1143c93b5..77efc01956 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/manpages/winbindd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/manpages/winbindd.8.html
@@ -1,13 +1,13 @@
-<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>winbindd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.72.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="winbindd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>winbindd &#8212; Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
- from NT servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-Y] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-n]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id299222"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> is a daemon that provides
+<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>winbindd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="../samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.73.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="winbindd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>winbindd &#8212; Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
+ from NT servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> [-D] [-F] [-S] [-i] [-Y] [-d &lt;debug level&gt;] [-s &lt;smb config file&gt;] [-n]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2507201"></a><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><code class="literal">winbindd</code> is a daemon that provides
a number of services to the Name Service Switch capability found
in most modern C libraries, to arbitrary applications via PAM
and <code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code> and to Samba itself.</p><p>Even if winbind is not used for nsswitch, it still provides a
service to <code class="literal">smbd</code>, <code class="literal">ntlm_auth</code>
and the <code class="literal">pam_winbind.so</code> PAM module, by managing connections to
domain controllers. In this configuraiton the
- <a class="indexterm" name="id299275"></a>idmap uid and
- <a class="indexterm" name="id266717"></a>idmap gid
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPUID">idmap uid</a> and
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPGID">idmap gid</a>
parameters are not required. (This is known as `netlogon proxy only mode'.)</p><p> The Name Service Switch allows user
and system information to be obtained from different databases
services such as NIS or DNS. The exact behaviour can be configured
@@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ hosts: files dns winbind
resolve hostnames from <code class="filename">/etc/hosts</code> and then from the
WINS server.</p><pre class="programlisting">
hosts: files wins
-</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id266957"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
+</pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506331"></a><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-F</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes
the main <code class="literal">winbindd</code> process to not daemonize,
i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
Child processes are still created as normal to service
@@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when
investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for
use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will
-override the <a class="indexterm" name="id307913"></a> parameter
+override the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGLEVEL">log level</a> parameter
in the <code class="filename">smb.conf</code> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the program version number.
</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. The
@@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
as a single process (the mode of operation in Samba 2.2). Winbindd's
default behavior is to launch a child process that is responsible for
updating expired cache entries.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308052"></a><h2>NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</h2><p>Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506595"></a><h2>NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</h2><p>Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned
a security id (SID) which is globally unique when the
user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group
into a unix user or group, a mapping between SIDs and unix user
@@ -124,26 +124,26 @@ log.smbd, etc...). The log file is never removed by the client.
where the user and group mappings are stored by winbindd. If this
store is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd to
determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user
- and group rids. </p><p>See the <a class="indexterm" name="id308084"></a> or the old <a class="indexterm" name="id308089"></a> parameters in
+ and group rids. </p><p>See the <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPDOMAINS">idmap domains</a> or the old <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a> parameters in
<code class="filename">smb.conf</code> for options for sharing this
- database, such as via LDAP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308104"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>Configuration of the <code class="literal">winbindd</code> daemon
- is done through configuration parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. All parameters should be specified in the
+ database, such as via LDAP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2506669"></a><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>Configuration of the <code class="literal">winbindd</code> daemon
+ is done through configuration parameters in the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. All parameters should be specified in the
[global] section of smb.conf. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308134"></a>winbind separator</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308145"></a>idmap uid</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308157"></a>idmap gid</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308168"></a>idmap backend</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308179"></a>winbind cache time</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308191"></a>winbind enum users</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308202"></a>winbind enum groups</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308213"></a>template homedir</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308225"></a>template shell</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308236"></a>winbind use default domain</p></li><li><p>
- <a class="indexterm" name="id308248"></a>winbind: rpc only
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR">winbind separator</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPUID">idmap uid</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPGID">idmap gid</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDCACHETIME">winbind cache time</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS">winbind enum users</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMGROUPS">winbind enum groups</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR">template homedir</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATESHELL">template shell</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN">winbind use default domain</a></p></li><li><p>
+ <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBIND:RPCONLY">winbind: rpc only</a>
Setting this parameter forces winbindd to use RPC
instead of LDAP to retrieve information from Domain
Controllers.
- </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308259"></a><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>
+ </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553572"></a><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>
To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus
authentication from a domain controller use something like the
following setup. This was tested on an early Red Hat Linux box.
@@ -176,7 +176,7 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_unix.so \
made from <code class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so</code> to
<code class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</code>. If you are using an
older version of glibc then the target of the link should be
- <code class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</code>.</p><p>Finally, setup a <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> containing directives like the
+ <code class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</code>.</p><p>Finally, setup a <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> containing directives like the
following:
</p><pre class="programlisting">
[global]
@@ -194,23 +194,23 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_unix.so \
and that you can login to your unix box as a domain user, using
the DOMAIN+user syntax for the username. You may wish to use the
commands <code class="literal">getent passwd</code> and <code class="literal">getent group
- </code> to confirm the correct operation of winbindd.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308450"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>The following notes are useful when configuring and
- running <code class="literal">winbindd</code>: </p><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> must be running on the local machine
+ </code> to confirm the correct operation of winbindd.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553780"></a><h2>NOTES</h2><p>The following notes are useful when configuring and
+ running <code class="literal">winbindd</code>: </p><p><a class="citerefentry" href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> must be running on the local machine
for <code class="literal">winbindd</code> to work. </p><p>PAM is really easy to misconfigure. Make sure you know what
you are doing when modifying PAM configuration files. It is possible
to set up PAM such that you can no longer log into your system. </p><p>If more than one UNIX machine is running <code class="literal">winbindd</code>,
then in general the user and groups ids allocated by winbindd will not
be the same. The user and group ids will only be valid for the local
- machine, unless a shared <a class="indexterm" name="id308497"></a> is configured.</p><p>If the the Windows NT SID to UNIX user and group id mapping
- file is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308509"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>The following signals can be used to manipulate the
- <code class="literal">winbindd</code> daemon. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SIGHUP</span></dt><dd><p>Reload the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and
+ machine, unless a shared <a class="link" href="smb.conf.5.html#IDMAPBACKEND">idmap backend</a> is configured.</p><p>If the the Windows NT SID to UNIX user and group id mapping
+ file is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553852"></a><h2>SIGNALS</h2><p>The following signals can be used to manipulate the
+ <code class="literal">winbindd</code> daemon. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SIGHUP</span></dt><dd><p>Reload the <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and
apply any parameter changes to the running
version of winbindd. This signal also clears any cached
user and group information. The list of other domains trusted
by winbindd is also reloaded. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SIGUSR2</span></dt><dd><p>The SIGUSR2 signal will cause <code class="literal">
winbindd</code> to write status information to the winbind
log file.</p><p>Log files are stored in the filename specified by the
- log file parameter.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308571"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf(5)</code></span></dt><dd><p>Name service switch configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</span></dt><dd><p>The UNIX pipe over which clients communicate with
+ log file parameter.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2553917"></a><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><code class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf(5)</code></span></dt><dd><p>Name service switch configuration file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</span></dt><dd><p>The UNIX pipe over which clients communicate with
the <code class="literal">winbindd</code> program. For security reasons, the
winbind client will only attempt to connect to the winbindd daemon
if both the <code class="filename">/tmp/.winbindd</code> directory
@@ -231,8 +231,8 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_unix.so \
compiled using the <em class="parameter"><code>--with-lockdir</code></em> option.
This directory is by default <code class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks
</code>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">$LOCKDIR/winbindd_cache.tdb</span></dt><dd><p>Storage for cached user and group information.
- </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308716"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of
- the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308726"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><code class="filename">nsswitch.conf(5)</code>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="ntlm_auth.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="pam_winbind.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">pam_winbind</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id308784"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554072"></a><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554083"></a><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><code class="filename">nsswitch.conf(5)</code>, <a class="citerefentry" href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="wbinfo.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">wbinfo</span>(1)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="ntlm_auth.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(8)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, <a class="citerefentry" href="pam_winbind.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">pam_winbind</span>(8)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="id2554141"></a><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities
were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p><code class="literal">wbinfo</code> and <code class="literal">winbindd</code> were